Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you drive off for the first time, read this
Owner's Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with your vehicle. For your own safety and a
longer vehicle life, follow the instructions and
warning notices in this manual. Disregarding
them may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a left-handdrive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the
layout of components and controls differs
accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right to
introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical features
Consequently, the description may differ from
your vehicle in some cases.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
RPrinted Owner's Manual
RService Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all
documents on to the new owner.
animations, individual language settings
and an intuitive search function.
Printed manual – in the vehicle
In addition to this manual and the aforementioned digital media, you also have the
option to obtain a comprehensive printed
version of the supplement for your multimedia system from your Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Digital – on the internet
The online Owner's Manual provides easy
access to all information regarding your
vehicle and multimedia system. It also provides helpful animations, interesting background information and a wide array of
search options.
Digital – as an app
Using the Mercedes-Benz Guides app, you
can view all the information on your vehicle
and multimedia system via mobile internet
or download it to use without internet
access. Available for smartphones or tablets.
You can also use the Mercedes-Benz Guides
app:
Please note that the Mercedes-Benz Guides app
may not yet be available in your country.
i You can find out about important features of
your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
You can also use the Mercedes-Benz Guides
app:
Your Owner's Manuals:
Digital – in the vehicle
The Digital Owner's Manual provides comprehensive and specifically adapted information on your vehicle's equipment and
multimedia system. It contains informative
1175843903Z102 É1175843903Z102MËÍ
2
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
Digital Owner's Manual ...................... 23
Introduction ........................................... 23
Operation ............................................... 23
Introduction .........................................
Environmental protection ......................
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ...............
Owner's Manual .....................................
Operating safety ....................................
QR code for rescue card ........................
Data stored in the vehicle ......................
Copyright information ............................
24
24
24
25
25
28
28
29
At a glance ...........................................
Cockpit ..................................................
Instrument cluster .................................
Multifunction steering wheel .................
Centre console ......................................
Door control panel .................................
Overhead control panel .........................
30
30
32
33
34
37
38
Safety ...................................................
Panic alarm ............................................
Occupant safety ....................................
Children in the vehicle ...........................
Pets in the vehicle .................................
Driving safety systems ...........................
Protection against theft .........................
39
39
39
54
65
65
73
Opening and closing ...........................
Key ........................................................
Doors .....................................................
Boot .......................................................
Side windows .........................................
Panorama sliding sunroof ......................
76
76
83
86
89
92
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 97
Correct driver's seat position ................ 97
Seats ..................................................... 97
Steering wheel ..................................... 102
Mirrors ................................................. 103
Memory function ................................. 106
Lights and windscreen wipers .........
Exterior lighting ...................................
Interior lighting ....................................
Replacing bulbs ...................................
Windscreen wipers ..............................
107
107
110
111
114
Climate control .................................
Overview of climate control systems ...
Operating the climate control system ..
Air vents ..............................................
117
117
120
130
Driving and parking ..........................
Running-in notes ..................................
Driving .................................................
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles
except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .........
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....................
Manual transmission ...........................
Automatic transmission .......................
Refuelling .............................................
Parking ................................................
Driving tips ..........................................
Driving systems ...................................
Towing a trailer ....................................
132
132
132
On-board computer and displays ....
Important safety notes ........................
Displays and operation ........................
Menus and submenus .........................
Display messages ................................
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ...............................
200
200
200
203
216
Multimedia system ...........................
General notes ......................................
Important safety notes ........................
Function restrictions ............................
Operating system ................................
259
259
259
259
259
Stowing and features .......................
Loading guidelines ...............................
Stowage areas .....................................
Features ..............................................
268
268
268
273
141
141
142
143
152
155
159
162
194
247
Contents
Maintenance and care ......................
Engine compartment ...........................
ASSYST PLUS ......................................
Care .....................................................
280
280
284
286
Breakdown assistance .....................
Where will I find...? ..............................
Flat tyre ...............................................
Battery (vehicle) ..................................
Jump-starting .......................................
Towing away and tow-starting .............
Electrical fuses ....................................
293
293
294
299
301
304
308
Wheels and tyres ..............................
Important safety notes ........................
Operation ............................................
Winter operation ..................................
Tyre pressure .......................................
Changing a wheel ................................
Wheel and tyre combinations ..............
Emergency spare wheel .......................
310
310
310
312
313
318
323
323
Technical data ...................................
Information on technical data ..............
Vehicle electronics ..............................
Identification plates .............................
Service products and filling capacities ......................................................
Vehicle data .........................................
Trailer tow hitch ...................................
325
325
325
326
327
333
334
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
4MATIC
Display message ............................ 244
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) .................................................. 176
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 217
Function/notes ................................ 66
Important safety notes .................... 66
Warning lamp ................................. 250
Accident
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 53
Activating media mode
General notes ................................ 266
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 124
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 121
Active Brake Assist
Activating or deactivating .............. 209
Display message ............................ 223
Function/notes ................................ 67
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 73
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 69
Adaptive Damping System
Function/notes ............................. 176
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Display message ............................ 231
Function/notes ............................. 109
Switching on/off ........................... 110
Additional speedometer ................... 210
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 331
Address book
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Adjusting the headlamp range ......... 108
Adjusting the volume
COMAND Online ............................ 260
Adjusting volume
Audio 20 ........................................ 260
Air conditioning
General notes ................................ 117
Air filter (white display message) .... 234
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Important safety notes .................. 130
Rear ............................................... 131
Setting the centre air vents ........... 131
Setting the side air vents ............... 131
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbag
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation .......................... 47
Introduction ..................................... 44
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamps ............................................... 40
Airbags
Display message ............................ 226
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 45
Important safety guidelines ............. 44
Kneebag ........................................... 46
Sidebag ............................................ 46
Triggering ......................................... 51
Windowbag ...................................... 46
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 73
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 73
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 73
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
AMG
Performance Seat .......................... 101
RIDE CONTROL sports suspension ................................................ 175
AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 213
AMG Performance exhaust system ..................................................... 139
AMG RIDE CONTROL
General Information ....................... 175
Anti-glare film .................................... 279
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Index
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 161
Ashtray ............................................... 275
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 208
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 208
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 285
Driving abroad ............................... 285
Hiding a service message .............. 285
Information about Service ............. 285
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 285
Service message ............................ 284
Special service requirements ......... 285
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 73
Function ........................................... 73
Switching off the alarm .................... 73
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 209
Display message ............................ 234
Function/notes ............................. 189
Audio 20
Switching on/off ........................... 259
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 206
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 230
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 138
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 137
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 226
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 47
Problems ......................................... 50
System self-test ............................... 49
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 107
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position .............
Changing gear ...............................
DIRECT SELECT lever .....................
Drive program display ....................
Drive programs ..............................
Driving tips ....................................
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ...............................................
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..............
Emergency running mode ..............
Engaging drive position ..................
Engaging neutral ............................
Engaging park position
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..............
Engaging park position automatically ...............................................
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Engaging the park position ............
Holding the vehicle stationary on
uphill gradients ..............................
Kickdown .......................................
Manual shifting ..............................
Oil temperature (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .....
Overview ........................................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Trailer towing .................................
Transmission position display ........
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
Auxiliary heating
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Remote control ..............................
Setting ...........................................
Auxiliary heating/ventilation
Display message ............................
147
147
144
144
148
147
141
141
152
145
145
146
144
145
144
148
148
150
213
143
152
135
146
135
150
148
146
144
147
152
127
127
127
211
245
5
6
Index
Important safety notes ..................
Problem (display message) ............
Setting the departure time .............
Auxiliary ventilation
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Remote control ..............................
Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ......................................................
126
130
128
127
127
127
334
B
Back button ....................................... 260
Ball coupling
Folding in ....................................... 197
Folding in/out ................................ 197
Folding out ..................................... 197
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 66
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 79
Important safety notes .................... 79
Replacing ......................................... 79
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 301
Display message ............................ 232
Important safety notes .................. 299
Jump starting ................................. 301
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 51
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 209
Display message ............................ 235
Notes/function .............................. 192
Trailer towing ................................. 193
Blootooth®
Connecting a different mobile
phone ............................................ 263
Bluetooth®
Searching for a mobile phone ........ 263
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Telephony ...................................... 262
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 280
Closing ........................................... 282
Display message ............................ 244
Important safety notes .................. 280
Opening ......................................... 281
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 88
Important safety notes .................... 86
Opening (automatically from outside) ................................................. 87
Opening (from outside the vehicle, HANDS-FREE ACCESS) .............. 87
Opening automatically from
inside ............................................... 88
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ............................................ 86
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 244
Opening dimensions ...................... 333
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 333
Brake
EBD .................................................. 72
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 223
Notes ............................................. 331
Brake force distribution
see EBD (electronic brake force
distribution)
Brake lamp
Replacing bulbs ............................. 113
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 69
Display message ............................ 229
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 66
BAS .................................................. 66
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 331
Braking assistance appropriate to
the situation ..................................... 68
Display message ............................ 217
Driving tips .................................... 160
Hill start assist ............................... 136
HOLD function ............................... 172
Important safety notes .................. 160
Parking brake ................................ 157
Warning lamp ................................. 249
Index
Braking assistance appropriate to
the situation
Function/notes ................................ 68
Breakdown
Where will I find...? ........................ 293
see Flat tyre
see Tow-starting
see Towing away
Buttons on the steering column ...... 201
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Car
see Vehicle
Car wash (care) .................................
Care
Automatic car wash .......................
Carpets ..........................................
Display ...........................................
Exhaust pipe ..................................
Exterior lighting .............................
Gear or selector lever ....................
High-pressure cleaner ....................
Interior ...........................................
Matt paintwork ..............................
Notes .............................................
Paint ..............................................
Plastic trim ....................................
Reversing camera ..........................
Roof lining ......................................
Seat belt ........................................
Seat cover .....................................
Sensors .........................................
Steering wheel ...............................
Trim pieces ....................................
Washing by hand ...........................
Wheels ...........................................
Windows ........................................
Wiper blades ..................................
Wooden trim ..................................
CD
See also Digital Owner's Manual ...
CD player (on-board computer) ........
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) .............................................
286
286
292
290
290
289
291
287
290
287
286
287
290
289
292
291
291
289
291
291
286
288
288
288
291
259
206
211
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 76
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 35
Upper section .................................. 34
Child
Restraint system .............................. 54
Child seat
Forward-facing restraint system ...... 59
i-Size ................................................ 55
ISOFIX .............................................. 55
On the front-passenger seat ............ 57
Rearward-facing restraint system .... 58
Recommendations ........................... 63
Suitable positions ............................ 59
Top Tether ....................................... 56
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 64
Rear doors ....................................... 65
Cigarette lighter ................................ 276
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 289
Trailer tow hitch ............................. 290
Climate control
Air conditioning ............................. 118
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 126
Controlling automatically ............... 121
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 125
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 121
Demisting the windows .................. 124
Demisting the windscreen ............. 123
Indicator lamp ................................ 121
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control .................................. 120
Notes on using the air-conditioning system ..................................... 118
Overview of systems ...................... 117
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 124
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 121
Setting the air distribution ............. 122
Setting the air vents ...................... 130
Setting the airflow ......................... 123
Setting the temperature ................ 122
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 124
7
8
Index
Switching on/off ........................... 120
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 126
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 124
Switching the ZONE function
on/off ............................................ 123
THERMOTRONIC (2-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 119
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 30
COMAND display
Cleaning ......................................... 290
COMAND Online
Switching on/off ........................... 259
Combination switch .......................... 109
Connecting a USB device
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 203
Controller ........................................... 260
Convenience closing feature .............. 90
Convenience opening feature ............ 90
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 125
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 283
Display message ............................ 231
Important safety notes .................. 332
Temperature (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Temperature gauge ........................ 201
Warning lamp ................................. 255
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright ............................................. 29
Cornering light function
Display message ............................ 228
Cruise control
Activation conditions ..................... 163
Cruise control lever ....................... 163
Deactivating ................................... 164
Display message ............................ 237
Driving system ............................... 162
Important safety notes .................. 163
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 163
Selecting ........................................ 163
Setting a speed .............................. 164
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear compartment .........................
163
274
273
274
D
Dashboard
see Instrument cluster
Data
see Technical data
Data modem mode
Telephone with Bluetooth® (SAP
profile) ........................................... 265
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 230
Function/notes ............................. 107
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 211
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Declarations of conformity ................. 26
Diagnostics connection ...................... 27
Diesel .................................................. 330
Digital Owner's Manual
Help ................................................. 23
Introduction ..................................... 23
Digital speedometer ......................... 204
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message ............................ 228
Replacing bulbs ............................. 112
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 107
Switching on/off ........................... 108
DIRECT SELECT lever
Automatic transmission ................. 144
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 234
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 284
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 216
Engine ............................................ 231
General information ....................... 216
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 216
Key ................................................ 246
Lights ............................................. 228
Index
Safety systems .............................. 217
Tyres .............................................. 239
Vehicle ........................................... 241
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
Activating ....................................... 168
Calling up the speed ...................... 169
Cruise control lever ....................... 168
Deactivating ................................... 171
Display Message ............................ 236
Displays in the instrument cluster .. 171
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 171
Driving tips .................................... 172
Function/notes ............................. 167
Important safety notes .................. 167
Selecting ........................................ 168
Setting a speed .............................. 170
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 170
Stopping ........................................ 170
Storing the speed .......................... 169
Distance warning function
Function/notes ................................ 67
Warning lamp ................................. 257
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 257
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 211
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 85
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 76
Control panel ................................... 37
Display message ............................ 244
Emergency locking ........................... 85
Emergency unlocking ....................... 85
Important safety notes .................... 83
Opening (from the inside) ................ 83
Drive program
Display ........................................... 146
Display (DIRECT SELECT lever) ...... 144
Manual transmission ...................... 143
Drive programs
Automatic transmission ................. 148
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 285
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 107
Driving on flooded roads .................. 162
Driving safety system
Active Brake Assist .......................... 67
Braking assistance appropriate to
the situation ..................................... 68
EBD (electronic brake force distribution) ............................................. 72
STEER CONTROL ............................. 73
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 66
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 73
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 69
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 66
Distance warning function ............... 67
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 69
Important safety guidelines ............. 66
Overview .......................................... 65
Driving system
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC ............. 167
Parking assist PARKTRONIC .......... 177
Parking Pilot .................................. 180
RACE START (Mercedes-AMG
vehicles) ........................................ 174
Speed limiter ................................. 165
Start-off assist ............................... 174
Driving systems
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 175
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 189
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 192
Cruise control ................................ 162
Display message ............................ 234
HOLD function ............................... 172
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 193
Lane package ................................ 191
Reversing camera .......................... 184
Traffic Sign Assist .......................... 190
Driving tips
Aquaplaning ................................... 161
Automatic transmission ................. 147
Brakes ........................................... 160
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC ............. 172
Downhill gradient ........................... 160
Driving abroad ............................... 107
Driving in winter ............................. 162
Driving on flooded roads ................ 162
Driving on wet roads ...................... 161
9
10
Index
Fuel ................................................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
The first 1500 km ..........................
Towing a trailer ..............................
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
See also Digital Owner's Manual ...
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....................................................
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .................
DYNAMIC SELECT switch
Climate control (air conditioning) ..
Climate control
(THERMOTRONIC) ..........................
159
159
162
161
161
132
313
107
132
196
161
206
259
141
141
119
120
E
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 219
Function/notes ................................ 72
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 159
On-board computer ....................... 204
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine start .................. 138
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 137
Deactivating/activating ................. 138
General information ....................... 137
Important safety notes .................. 137
Introduction ................................... 137
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 26
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 53
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 85
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 78
Inserting .......................................... 79
Locking vehicle ................................ 85
Removing ......................................... 79
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 85
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 324
Important safety notes .................. 323
Removing ....................................... 324
Emergency unlocking
Boot ................................................. 88
Vehicle ............................................. 85
Engine
Display message ............................ 231
ECO start/stop function ................ 137
Engine number ............................... 327
Jump-starting ................................. 301
Running irregularly ......................... 139
Starting (important safety notes) ... 134
Starting problems .......................... 139
Starting the engine with the key .... 135
Starting with the Start/Stop button ................................................. 135
Stopping ........................................ 156
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 307
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 255
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 325
Problem (fault) ............................... 139
Engine jump starting
see Jump starting (engine)
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 331
Checking the oil level ..................... 282
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 282
Display message ............................ 233
Filling capacity ............................... 331
Notes about oil grades ................... 330
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 282
Temperature (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Topping up ..................................... 283
Index
Entering an address
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 24
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) ... 214
Characteristics ................................. 70
Deactivating/activating (button
in Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............. 71
Deactivating/activating (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles) ................. 70
Deactivating/activating (onboard computer, except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 209
Display message ............................ 217
Function/notes ................................ 69
General notes .................................. 69
Important safety guidelines ............. 70
Trailer stabilisation .......................... 72
Warning lamp ................................. 252
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 70
Exhaust
see Exhaust pipe
Exhaust pipe
Cleaning ......................................... 290
Exterior lighting
Cleaning ......................................... 289
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 103
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 104
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 213
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 104
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 104
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 104
Parking position ............................. 105
Resetting ....................................... 104
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 106
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Favourites
Overview ........................................ 260
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ............................... 293
First-aid kit ......................................... 293
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ............................... 321
Lowering the vehicle ...................... 322
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 319
Raising the vehicle ......................... 320
Removing a wheel .......................... 321
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 319
Flat tyre
Changing a wheel/fitting the
spare wheel ................................... 318
MOExtended tyres ......................... 295
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 294
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 296
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat ............................................. 278
Frequencies
Mobile phone ................................. 325
Two-way radio ................................ 325
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 226
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 47
Problems ......................................... 50
System self-test ............................... 49
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 329
Consumption statistics .................. 203
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 204
Displaying the range ...................... 204
Driving tips .................................... 159
E10 ................................................ 328
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Grade (petrol) ................................ 328
Important safety notes .................. 328
Low outside temperatures ............. 330
Notes for CLA 250 ......................... 329
Notes for Mercedes‑AMG vehicles ................................................ 329
11
12
Index
Problem (malfunction) ................... 155
Quality (diesel) ............................... 330
Refuelling ....................................... 152
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 328
Fuel filler flap
Opening ......................................... 154
Fuel filter (white display message) .. 234
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 204
Gauge .............................................. 32
Fuel reserve
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 328
Problem (malfunction) ................... 155
Fuses
Allocation chart ............................. 309
Before changing ............................. 308
Fuse box in the engine compartment .............................................. 308
Fuse box in the front-passenger
footwell .......................................... 309
Important safety notes .................. 308
G
Gear indicator (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 213
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 214
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ........... 24
Glove compartment .......................... 269
Google™ Local Search
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
H
HANDS-FREE ACCESS .......................... 87
Hazard warning lamps
Display message ............................ 246
Switching on/off ........................... 109
Head restraints
Adjusting ......................................... 99
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 100
Adjusting (rear) .............................. 100
Fitting/removing (rear) .................. 100
Headlamp flasher .............................. 109
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 110
see Automatic headlamp mode
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 287
Hill start assist .................................. 136
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 173
Deactivating ................................... 173
Display message ............................ 234
Function/notes ............................. 172
Home address
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Horn ...................................................... 30
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 73
Indicator and warning lamp
Restraint system ............................ 254
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 255
Engine diagnostics ......................... 255
SPORT handling mode ................... 253
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 228
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 32
Settings ......................................... 210
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 32
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 200
Interior lighting
Control ........................................... 111
Overview ........................................ 110
Reading lamp ................................. 110
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 75
Function ........................................... 75
Priming ............................................ 75
Switching off .................................... 75
iPod®
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Index
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 55
J
Jack
Declaration of conformity ................ 26
Storage location ............................ 294
Using ............................................. 320
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 301
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 79
Checking the battery ....................... 79
Convenience closing feature ............ 90
Convenience opening feature .......... 90
Display message ............................ 246
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 76
Emergency key element ................... 78
Important safety notes .................... 76
KEYLESS-GO start function .............. 78
Loss ................................................. 81
Modifying the programming ............. 78
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 133
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 81
Starting the engine ........................ 135
Key positions
Start/Stop button .......................... 133
Key positions (ignition lock) ............ 133
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ........................ 90
Deactivation ..................................... 77
Locking ............................................ 77
Unlocking ......................................... 77
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 148
Manual gearshifting ....................... 152
Kneebag ............................................... 46
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 209
Display message ............................ 235
Function/information .................... 193
Lane package .....................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Lashing eyelets .................................
Licence plate lamp (display message) ...................................................
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Adaptive Highbeam Assist .............
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Hazard warning lamps ...................
Headlamp flasher ...........................
Headlamp range ............................
Light switch ...................................
Main-beam headlamps ...................
Misted up headlamps ....................
Parking lamps ................................
Rear foglamp .................................
Setting exterior lighting .................
Side lamps .....................................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) .............................................
Turn signals ...................................
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC .............
Variable limiter ..............................
Limiter
Calling up the speed ......................
Deactivating, variable ....................
Function/notes .............................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Permanent .....................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing the current speed ..............
Switching to passive ......................
Variable .........................................
Limiting the speed
Speed limiter .................................
Loading guidelines ............................
Locking
see Central locking
191
214
272
229
230
109
107
108
107
109
109
108
107
109
110
108
108
107
108
211
109
163
168
165
166
166
165
165
166
166
166
166
165
165
268
13
14
Index
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 85
Emergency locking ........................... 85
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 84
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 211
Luggage compartment enlargement ................................................... 271
Lumbar support
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 101
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
Main-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist .............
Display message ............................
Replacing bulbs .............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Manual transmission
Drive program ................................
DYNAMIC SELECT button ..............
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Gear lever ......................................
Pulling away ...................................
Shift recommendation ...................
Shifting to neutral ..........................
Starting the engine ........................
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) ..
Memory card (audio) .........................
Memory function ...............................
Mercedes-Benz emergency call
system
Switch in the overhead control
panel ..............................................
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive
Traffic Sign Assist ..........................
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) ..................................................
312
109
229
113
109
143
141
142
142
135
143
142
135
287
206
106
277
190
Messages
see Display messages
Mirror turn signal
Cleaning ......................................... 289
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mobile phone
Connecting (Bluetooth® interface) .............................................. 262
Connecting another mobile
phone ............................................ 263
Connecting the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ......... 265
Frequencies ................................... 325
Installation ..................................... 325
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 207
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 277
Transmission output (maximum) .... 325
Mobile telephone
Pre-installed bracket ...................... 278
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 78
MOExtended tyres ............................. 295
MP3
Operating ....................................... 206
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 202
Permanent display ......................... 210
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 201
Overview .......................................... 33
Music files
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
N
Navigation
Entering a destination ....................
Menu (on-board computer) ............
See also Digital Owner's Manual ...
Notes on running in a new vehicle ..
261
205
259
132
O
216
Occupant safety
Airbags ............................................ 44
Index
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation .......................... 47
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 53
Children in the vehicle ..................... 54
Important safety notes .................... 39
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator
lamp ................................................. 40
Pets in the vehicle ........................... 65
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 53
Restraint system introduction .......... 39
Restraint system warning lamp ........ 40
Seat belts ........................................ 41
Odometer ........................................... 203
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 213
Assistance graphic menu ............... 208
Assistance menu ........................... 208
Audio menu ................................... 206
Convenience submenu .................. 212
Display messages .......................... 216
Displaying a service message ........ 285
Factory settings ............................. 213
Heating submenu ........................... 211
Important safety notes .................. 200
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 210
Light submenu ............................... 211
Menu overview .............................. 203
Message memory .......................... 216
Navigation menu ............................ 205
Operating video DVD ..................... 206
Operation ....................................... 201
RACETIMER ................................... 214
Service menu ................................. 210
Settings menu ............................... 210
Standard display ............................ 203
Telephone menu ............................ 207
Trip menu ...................................... 203
Vehicle submenu ........................... 211
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 113
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 25
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 26
Important safety note ...................... 25
Operating system
see On-board computer
Operation
Digital Owner's Manual .................... 23
Outside temperature display ........... 200
Overhead control panel ...................... 38
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 65
P
Paint code .......................................... 326
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 287
Panic alarm .......................................... 39
Panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 92
Operating ......................................... 93
Operating the roller sunblinds for
the sliding sunroof ........................... 94
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 95
Rain-closing feature (when driving) .................................................. 94
Rain-closing feature (when the
engine is switched off) ..................... 94
Reversing feature ............................. 93
Parking
Important safety notes .................. 155
Parking brake ................................ 157
Parking position for the exterior
mirror on the front-passenger
side ................................................ 105
Reversing camera .......................... 184
Parking aid
see Exterior mirrors
see Reversing camera
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 179
Driving system ............................... 177
Function/notes ............................. 177
Important safety notes .................. 177
Problems (faults) ........................... 180
Sensor range ................................. 177
Warning display ............................. 178
Parking brake
Applying automatically (vehicles
with automatic transmission) ......... 158
Applying automatically (vehicles
with manual transmission) ............. 158
15
16
Index
Applying or releasing manually ...... 157
Display message ............................ 219
Electric parking brake .................... 157
Emergency braking ........................ 158
General information ....................... 157
Releasing automatically ................. 158
Warning lamp ................................. 254
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 229
Switching on/off ........................... 108
Parking Pilot
Cancelling ...................................... 184
Detecting parking spaces .............. 181
Display Message ............................ 235
Exiting a parking space .................. 183
Function/notes ............................. 180
Important safety notes .................. 180
Parking .......................................... 182
Towing a trailer .............................. 180
PASSENGER AIR BAG
Display message ............................ 226
Indicator lamps ................................ 40
Problems (malfunctions) ................ 226
Petrol .................................................. 328
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 65
Phone book
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 290
Power socket
Boot ............................................... 276
Power windows
see Side windows
Pre-Crash Safety System
see PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory
occupant protection)
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 53
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 223
Protection against theft
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 73
Immobiliser ...................................... 73
Interior motion sensor ..................... 75
Tow-away protection ........................ 74
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 24
Pulling away
Automatic transmission ................. 135
General notes ................................ 135
Hill start assist ............................... 136
Manual transmission ...................... 135
Trailer ............................................ 136
Q
QR code
Mercedes-Benz Guide App ................. 1
Rescue card ..................................... 28
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 27
R
RACE START
important safety notes ................... 174
RACE START (Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .................................................... 174
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 214
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 206
see separate operating instructions
Radio mode
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 26
Rain closing feature (panorama
sliding sunroof) ................................... 94
Reading lamp ..................................... 110
Rear bench seat
Folding the backrest forwards/
back ............................................... 271
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 131
Rear foglamp
Changing the bulb .......................... 113
Display message ............................ 229
Switching on/off ........................... 108
Rear lamps
see Lights
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 124
Switching on/off ........................... 124
Index
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 44
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 104
Dipping (manual) ........................... 103
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Important safety notes .................. 152
Notes for Mercedes‑AMG vehicles ................................................ 329
Refuelling process ......................... 153
see Fuel
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 127
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 129
Replacing bulbs
Brake lamp .................................... 113
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 112
Fitting/removing the cover (front
wheel arch) .................................... 112
Important safety notes .................. 111
Main-beam headlamps ................... 113
Overview of bulb types .................. 112
Rear fog lamp ................................ 113
Turn signals (front) ......................... 113
Turn signals (rear) .......................... 113
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) .................... 129
Rescue card ......................................... 28
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 234
Warning lamp ................................. 255
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 126
Restraint system
Display message ............................ 225
Introduction ..................................... 39
Warning lamp ................................. 254
Warning lamp (function) ................... 40
Rev counter ........................................ 200
Reverse gear
Engaging (manual transmission) .... 142
Reverse gear (selector lever) ........... 146
Reversing camera
"Reverse parking" function ............ 186
Cleaning instructions ..................... 289
Coupling up a trailer function ........ 188
Display in the multimedia system .. 185
Function/notes ............................. 184
General notes ................................ 184
Switching on/off ........................... 185
Reversing feature
Panorama sliding sunroof ................ 93
Side windows ................................... 89
Reversing function
Roller sunblind ................................. 94
Reversing lamps
Display message ............................ 230
Roller sunblind
Panorama sliding sunroof ................ 94
Roof carrier ........................................ 273
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 292
Roof load (maximum) ........................ 333
Route guidance
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 54
see Occupant safety
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
SD card
Inserting ........................................ 267
Inserting/removing ........................ 267
Removing ....................................... 267
SD memory card
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Seat
Adjusting (Performance Seat) ........ 101
Folding the backrest (rear compartment) forwards/back .............. 271
Seat belt
Correct usage .................................. 42
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 212
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 43
Adjusting the height ......................... 43
Cleaning ......................................... 291
17
18
Index
Display message ............................ 224
Fastening ......................................... 43
Important safety guidelines ............. 41
Introduction ..................................... 41
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 44
Releasing ......................................... 43
Warning lamp ................................. 248
Warning lamp (function) ................... 44
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 99
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 98
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 101
Adjusting the head restraint ............ 99
Cleaning the cover ......................... 291
Correct driver's seat position ........... 97
Important safety notes .................... 97
Seat heating problem .................... 102
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 106
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 101
Securing luggage ............................... 272
Selector lever
Cleaning ......................................... 291
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 289
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 210
Service message
see ASSYST PLUS
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 331
Coolant (engine) ............................ 332
Engine oil ....................................... 330
Fuel ................................................ 327
Important safety notes .................. 327
Washer fluid ................................... 332
Setting the air distribution ............... 122
Setting the airflow ............................ 123
Setting the date/time format
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Setting the language
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Setting the time
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 213
On-board computer ....................... 210
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 214
Shifting to neutral (manual transmission) ............................................. 142
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 108
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 90
Convenience opening ...................... 90
Important safety notes .................... 89
Opening/closing .............................. 89
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 92
Resetting ......................................... 91
Reversing feature ............................. 89
Sidebag ................................................ 46
SIM card
Inserting ........................................ 265
Sliding sunroof
see Panorama sliding sunroof
SMS
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Snow chains ...................................... 313
Sockets
Centre console .............................. 276
General notes ................................ 276
Rear compartment ......................... 276
Sound
Switching on/off ........................... 260
Specialist workshop ............................ 27
Spectacles compartment ................. 269
Speed limiter
Display message ............................ 237
Important safety notes .................. 165
Selecting ........................................ 165
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating the additional speedometer ........................ 210
Digital ............................................ 204
In the Instrument cluster ................. 32
Segments ...................................... 200
Selecting a display unit .................. 210
Index
SPORT handling mode
Deactivating/activating
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ................ 71
Warning lamp ................................. 253
Start-off assist
Activating ....................................... 174
Important safety notes .................. 174
Start/Stop button
Removing ....................................... 134
Starting the engine ........................ 135
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 134
STEER CONTROL .................................. 73
Steering
Display message ............................ 245
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL
see STEER CONTROL
Steering wheel
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 102
Button overview ............................... 33
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 201
Cleaning ......................................... 291
Gearshift paddles ........................... 150
Important safety notes .................. 102
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 150
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 214
Stowage compartment
Map pockets .................................. 270
Stowage compartments
Armrest (front) ............................... 269
Armrest (under) ............................. 270
Centre console .............................. 269
Centre console (rear) ..................... 270
Cup holder ..................................... 273
Glove compartment ....................... 269
Important safety information ......... 268
Spectacles compartment ............... 269
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 270
Stowage net ....................................... 270
Stowage space
Stowage net ................................... 270
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor .................................................... 272
Summer tyres .................................... 312
Sun visor ............................................
Suspension
Adaptive Damping System .............
Suspension settings
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension ..........................................
Switching on media mode
Via the device list ..........................
275
176
175
266
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................
see Lights
Tank
see Fuel tank
Technical data
Capacities ......................................
Information ....................................
Trailer loads ...................................
Tyres/wheels .................................
Vehicle data ...................................
Telephone
Accepting a call (multifunction
steering wheel) ..............................
Authorising a mobile phone (connecting) .........................................
Connecting a Mobile phone (general information) ............................
Display message ............................
Introduction ...................................
Menu (on-board computer) ............
Number from the phone book ........
Redialling .......................................
Rejecting/ending a call .................
See also Digital Owner's Manual ...
Switching between mobile
phones ...........................................
Telephone compartment ................
Telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile)
Activating and connecting the
module ...........................................
Charging a mobile phone ...............
Connecting the mobile phone ........
Connecting the module via a USB
cable ..............................................
Data modem mode ........................
229
327
325
334
323
333
207
263
262
246
207
207
207
208
207
259
263
270
264
266
265
264
265
19
20
Index
Installing the module ..................... 264
Introduction ................................... 263
Saving/deleting the PIN for the
SIM card ........................................ 266
Settings ......................................... 266
SIM card mode .............................. 265
Text messages ............................... 266
Transferring the phone book .......... 266
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 201
Coolant (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Engine oil (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Outside temperature ...................... 200
Setting (climate control) ................ 122
Transmission oil (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..... 213
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 162
Text messages
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ....................... 266
Through-loading ................................ 271
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 214
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 296
Declaration of conformity ................ 27
Important safety notes .................. 296
Storage location ............................ 294
Tyre pressure not reached ............. 297
Tyre pressure reached ................... 298
Top Tether ............................................ 56
Total distance recorder .................... 203
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 74
Deactivating ..................................... 74
Function ........................................... 74
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 307
Fitting the towing eye .................... 305
Important safety notes .................. 304
Removing the towing eye ............... 305
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 304
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles ............ 307
Transporting the vehicle ................ 307
Towing a trailer
Axle load, permissible .................... 334
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 72
Failure check for LEDs ................... 199
General notes ................................ 196
Parking Pilot .................................. 180
Pulling away with a trailer .............. 136
Trailer tow hitch display message .. 245
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 305
Removing the towing eye ............... 305
With both axles on the ground ....... 306
With front axle raised ..................... 306
Towing eye ......................................... 294
Traffic Sign Assist
Activating ....................................... 191
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 208
Display message ............................ 236
Function/notes ............................. 190
Important safety notes .................. 191
Instrument cluster display ............. 191
Trailer
Folding the ball coupling in/out ..... 197
Trailer coupling
see Towing a trailer
Trailer towing
7-pin connector ............................. 199
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 193
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch ......... 290
Coupling up a trailer ...................... 198
Decoupling a trailer ....................... 198
Driving tips .................................... 196
Folding in the ball coupling ............ 197
Folding out the ball coupling .......... 197
Important safety notes .................. 194
Lights display message .................. 228
Power supply ................................. 198
Trailer loads ................................... 334
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
see Manual transmission
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................... 144
Transporting the vehicle .................. 307
Index
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip meter
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
Turn signal lamp
Replacing bulbs (rear) ....................
Turn signals
Replacing bulbs (front) ...................
Switching on/off ...........................
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre inflation compressor
see TIREFIT kit
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Radio type approval for the tyre
pressure monitor ...........................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Information on driving ....................
M+S tyres ......................................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Summer tyres ................................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
see Flat tyre
291
203
203
204
113
113
109
325
325
325
315
239
297
298
313
314
315
315
316
315
315
316
317
317
258
317
318
310
319
239
323
310
310
312
312
318
311
319
312
323
311
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 85
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 84
Upshift indicator (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 213
USB devices
Connecting to the Media Interface ............................................... 267
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 275
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 28
Data acquisition ............................... 28
Display message ............................ 241
Electronics ..................................... 325
Equipment ....................................... 25
Implied warranty .............................. 28
Individual settings .......................... 210
Leaving parked up ......................... 159
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 85
Locking (key) ................................... 76
Lowering ........................................ 322
Pulling away ................................... 135
Raising ........................................... 320
Registration ..................................... 28
Securing from rolling away ............ 319
Transporting .................................. 307
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 85
Unlocking (key) ................................ 76
Vehicle data ................................... 333
Vehicle data
Boot load (maximum) ..................... 333
Roof load (maximum) ..................... 333
21
22
Index
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 333
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 85
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 326
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 294
Ventilation
Setting the vents ........................... 130
Video
Operating the DVD ......................... 206
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
VIN
Seat ............................................... 327
Type plate ...................................... 326
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 250
Active Brake Assist ........................ 257
Brakes ........................................... 249
Distance warning signal ................. 257
ESP® .............................................. 252
ESP® OFF ....................................... 253
Fuel tank ........................................ 255
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 163
LIM (Distance Pilot DISTRONIC) .... 168
LIM (variable limiter) ...................... 165
Overview .......................................... 32
PASSENGER AIR BAG ...................... 40
Reserve fuel ................................... 255
Seat belt ........................................ 248
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 258
Warning triangle ................................ 293
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 246
Weather display (COMAND Online)
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 259
Wheel and tyre combinations
Tyres .............................................. 323
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 322
Wheel chock ...................................... 319
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 318
Changing/replacing ....................... 318
Checking ........................................ 310
Cleaning ......................................... 288
Emergency spare wheel ................. 323
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 321
Important safety notes .................. 310
Information on driving .................... 310
Removing a wheel .......................... 321
Storing ........................................... 319
Tightening torque ........................... 322
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 323
Windowbag
Display message ............................ 225
Operation ......................................... 46
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 288
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 123
Windscreen washer system
Important safety notes .................. 332
Topping up ..................................... 284
Windscreen wipers
Display message ............................ 246
Problem (malfunction) ................... 116
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 115
Switching on/off ........................... 114
Winter driving
General notes ................................ 312
Winter operation
Slippery road surfaces ................... 162
Snow chains .................................. 313
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) ............................................. 211
M+S tyres ...................................... 312
Wiper blades
Cleaning ......................................... 288
Important safety notes .................. 115
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 291
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 123
Digital Owner's Manual
Introduction
The printed Owner's Manual provides information about the safe operation of your vehicle.
The Digital Owner's Manual provides comprehensive and specifically adapted information on
your vehicle's equipment and multimedia system. You can call up the Digital Owner's Manual
via the multimedia system.
i You will not incur any costs when calling up
the Digital Owner's Manual. The Digital Owner's Manual works without connecting to the
internet.
There are three ways to access the topics of the
Digital Owner's Manual:
RVisual search
The visual search allows you to explore your
vehicle "virtually". Starting from either the
vehicle exterior view or interior view, you can
access many of the different topics covered
by the Digital Owner's Manual. To access the
vehicle interior section, select the "Vehicle
interior" view.
RKeyword search
The keyword search allows you to search for a
keyword by entering characters.
RContents
You can select individual sections in the contents.
i The Digital Owner's Manual is deactivated
for safety reasons while driving.
Operation
Calling up the Digital Owner's Manual
Press the Ø button on the centre console.
The vehicle overview appears.
X Select the "Owner's Manual" menu item by
turning 3 or pressing 7 the controller.
X Acknowledge 7 the message about the
warning and safety notes.
The basic menu for the Digital Owner's Manual appears.
X
Operating the Digital Owner's Manual
General notes
Please observe the information about the operation of the controller (Y page 260).
Content pages
You can access the pages of content by means
of a visual search or a keyword search or by
using the table of contents.
To scroll forwards/backwards: turn 3
the controller.
X To display in full-screen or animation: slide
8 the controller to the left :.
X To select information text or save bookmarks: slide 9 the controller to the
right ;.
X To select a link: slide 6 the controller
downwards =.
X To exit a content page: select the %
symbol ?.
X To call up the basic menu of the Digital
Owner's Manual: select the Þ symbol
A.
X To switch functions to the multimedia
system using the buttons on the centre
console: press the $, %, Õ or Ø
button.
The selected menu appears. The Digital Owner's Manual remains open in the background.
X
23
24
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Introduction
Environmental protection
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
Ravoid
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Ravoid
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
Take-back of end-of-life vehicles
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your end-of-life
vehicle for environmentally-friendly disposal in
accordance with the European Union (EU) EndOf-Life Vehicles Directive.
A network of vehicle take-back points and dismantlers has been established for you to return
your vehicle. You can leave it at any of these
points free of charge. This makes an important
contribution to closing the recycling circle and
conserving resources.
For further information about the recycling and
disposal of end-of-life vehicles, and the takeback conditions, please visit the national
Mercedes-Benz website for your country.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well as
control units and sensors for these restraint
systems, may be installed in the following
areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor pillars
Rdoor sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Do not install accessories such as audio systems in these areas. Do not carry out repairs
or welding. You could impair the operating
efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels as
well as accessories relevant to safety that have
not been approved by Mercedes-Benz. This
could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant
systems, e.g. the brake system. Use only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of equal quality. Use only tyres, wheels and accessories that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been specifically approved for your vehicle for their reliability, safety and suitability. Despite ongoing
market research, Mercedes-Benz is unable to
assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz therefore
accepts no responsibility for the use of such
parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles, even if they
have been officially approved or independently
approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are officially approved
for installation or modification only if they comply with legal requirements. This also applies to
some other countries. All genuine MercedesBenz parts meet the approval requirements. The
use of non-approved parts may invalidate the
vehicle's general operating permit.
This is the case:
Rif they cause a change of the vehicle type from
that for which the vehicle's general operating
permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number
(VIN) (Y page 326) when ordering genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts.
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation
for your vehicle contains a list of all the systems
in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should be kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs carried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could affect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly anymore and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Z
25
Introduction
Operating safety
Introduction
26
Operating safety
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Rthe
vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb, a speed bump or a pothole in the road
Ra heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could be
damaged without the damage being visible.
Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no
longer withstand the strain they are designed
to.
If the underbody panelling is damaged, combustible materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs can gather between the underbody and
the underbody panelling. If these materials
come in contact with hot parts of the exhaust
system, they can catch fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle checked
and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop. If on continuing your journey you notice that driving safety is impaired,
pull over and stop the vehicle immediately,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions. In such cases, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information systems and communication devices integrated
into the vehicle that receive and/or transmit
radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant with
the basic requirements and all other relevant
conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC. You can
obtain further information from any MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Electromagnetic compatibility
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle
components has been checked and certified
according to the currently valid version of Regulation ECE-R 10.
Jack
Copy and translation of the original declaration
of conformity:
EC declaration of conformity
1. The signatory, as a representative
Manufacturer:
BRANO a.s.
74741 Hradec nad Moravicí, Opavská 1000,
Czech Republic
ID no.: 64-387-5933
VAT ID no.: CZ64-387-5933
declares, as our sole responsibility, that the
product:
2. Description:
a) Jack
Type, number:
A) A 164 580 02 18, A 166 580 01 18
B) A 240 580 00 18
C) A 639 580 02 18
Year of manufacture: 2015
Fulfils all relevant conditions
Directive no. 2006/42/EC
b) Description and purpose of use:
The jack is intended only for raising the
specified vehicle according to the operating
instructions affixed to the jack.
3. Reference data of the harmonised standards or specifications
A) ISO 4063, EN ISO 14341-A, DBL
7382.20, MBN 10435, AS 2693
B) ISO 4063, ISO 14341-A, DBL 7392.10,
MBN 10435
C) DBL 7392.10, DBL 8230.10
Technical documentation for the product is
held by the manufacturer. Authorised representative for the compilation of the technical documentation: director of the technical department at Brano a.s.
Operating safety
Date
Signed by:
Director of Quality
Introduction
4. Hradec nad Moravicí
City
5. 05.05.2015
TIREFIT kit
Copy and translation of the original declaration of conformity:
EC declaration of conformity
In accordance with EC directive 2006/42/EC
We hereby declare that the product
Product designation:
Daimler electric air pump
Model designation:
0852, DT/UW 200016
MB part no.:
A 000 583 22 02
complies with the following relevant regulations:
EMC 72/245/EC
Applied harmonised standards, in particular:
ISO 7637-2: 2004
Manufacturer:
Dunlop Tech GmbH
Address:
Birkenhainerstrasse 77, 63450
Hanau, Germany
Authorised representative:
IMS department
Date:
June 2011
Signature:
IMS-AM, IMS-AE-L
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is used for connecting diagnostic equipment at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it may affect the
operation of vehicle systems. As a result, the
operating safety of the vehicle could be affected. There is a risk of an accident.
Only connect equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle, which is approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
27
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment
on the diagnostics connection is used, the
starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics connection can lead to emissions monitoring information being reset, for example. This may lead
to the vehicle failing to meet the requirements of
the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications to
correctly carry out any necessary work on your
Z
Introduction
28
Data stored in the vehicle
vehicle. This particularly applies to work relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork relevant to safety
Rservice and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Rmodifications, installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres to
carry out technical inspections on certain vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet been
registered in your name in the following cases:
Rif your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer
Rif your vehicle has not yet been inspected at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving
your vehicle:
Rthe safety notes in this manual
Rtechnical data for the vehicle
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to motor
vehicles
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual about
the proper operation of your vehicle as well as
about possible vehicle damage. Damage to
your vehicle that arises from culpable contraventions against these instructions are not
covered either by Mercedes-Benz implied
warranty or by the New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
QR code for rescue card
The QR code is secured in the fuel filler flap and
on the opposite side on the B-pillar. In the event
of an accident, rescue services can use the QR
code to quickly find the appropriate rescue card
for your vehicle. The current rescue card contains, in a compact form, the most important
information about your vehicle, e.g. the routing
of the electric cables.
You can find more information under
www.mercedes-benz.de/qr-code.
Data stored in the vehicle
Many of the electronic components in your vehicle can store data.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
This includes, for example:
Roperating conditions of system components,
e.g. fluid levels
Rstatus messages concerning the vehicle and
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator
pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system
components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions in
special driving situations, e.g. airbag deploy-
ment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
These data are of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist in detecting and rectifying faults and
defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an accident
Roptimise vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory
and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair services
Rservice processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
The information is read out by employees of the
service network (including the manufacturer)
using special diagnostic testers. You can obtain
more information there, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information
is deleted from the fault memory or is continually overwritten.
During vehicle operation, certain situations may
arise in which these technical data – in conjunction with other information and, if applicable,
after consultation with an approved assessor –
may be linked to an individual person.
Examples include:
Raccident reports
Rdamage to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been contractually agreed upon with the customer allow
certain vehicle data to be conveyed by the vehicle as well. The additional functions include, for
example, vehicle location in the event of an
emergency.
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/opensource
Copyright information
General information
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
Z
29
Introduction
Copyright information
30
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
150
;
Combination switch
109
=
Instrument cluster
32
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
144
B
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
warning display
C
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
D
Climate control systems
117
E
Ignition lock
133
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
102
G
Cruise control lever
163
H
Electric parking brake
157
I
Light switch
107
178
J
Diagnostics connection
38
K
Opens the bonnet
27
281
31
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
warning display
178
=
Combination switch
109
?
Instrument cluster
32
A
Horn
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
144
C
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
150
38
Function
Page
D
Light switch
107
E
Electric parking brake
157
F
Opens the bonnet
281
G
Diagnostics connection
H
Ignition lock
133
I
Adjusts the steering wheel
102
J
Cruise control lever
163
K
Climate control systems
117
27
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Function
:
Page
Speedometer with segments
Indicator and warning lamps:
L Dipped-beam headlamps
T Side lamps
K Main-beam headlamps
÷ ESP®
! Electric parking brake
applied (red)
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
· Distance warning
å ESP® OFF
! ABS malfunctioning
J Brakes
200
;
#! Turn signals
109
=
Multifunction display
202
Function
?
108
108
109
252
254
254
257
252
250
249
A
B
Page
Rev counter
Indicator and warning lamps:
6 Restraint system
ü Seat belt not fastened
% Diesel engine: preglow
M SPORT handling mode
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
R Rear foglamp
; Engine diagnostics
h Tyre pressure monitor
200
Coolant temperature gauge
Indicator and warning lamps:
? Coolant too hot/cold
201
Fuel gauge display
Indicator and warning lamps:
æ Reserve fuel
40
248
135
253
108
255
258
255
255
Multifunction steering wheel
33
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Multimedia system display
=
~ Rejects or ends a call
6 Makes or accepts a call
Further telephone functions
W X Adjusts the volume
8 Mute
? Switches on voiceoperated control for navigation or LINGUATRONIC
Page
202
207
i You can find further information in vehicles
with an Audio 20 multimedia system:
Ron the multimedia system in the Digital
Owner's Manual
Ron voice-controlled navigation in the manufacturer's operating instructions
Function
?
ò Opens the menu list
9 : Selects a menu
a Confirms the selection
% Back
Operates the on-board computer
? Switches off voiceoperated control for navigation or LINGUATRONIC
Page
201
i You can find further information in vehicles
with a COMAND Online multimedia system:
Ron the multimedia system in the Digital
Owner's Manual
Ron the DVD changer or single DVD drive in
the Digital Owner's Manual
Ron LINGUATRONIC in the separate operating instructions
34
Centre console
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, upper section
Function
:
Multimedia system; see the
separate operating instructions
;
c Seat heating
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:
AMG RIDE CONTROL (left
side)
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:
adjusts the exhaust flap of
the AMG performance
exhaust system (right side)
=
c Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
Page
101
175
139
179
Function
Page
?
è ECO start/stop function
137
A
£ Hazard warning lamps
109
B
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamps
40
C
DYNAMIC SELECT button
å Mercedes-AMG vehicles: ESP®
141
& Auxiliary heating
126
D
71
Centre console
35
At a glance
Centre console, lower section
i Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
Function
:
;
Function
Page
Page
=
Cup holders
273
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Stowage compartment
275
276
276
268
?
Stowage space with Media
Interface
268
A
Stowage compartment
Cup holders
268
273
Multimedia system controller; see the separate operating instructions
Centre console
At a glance
36
i Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Function
Function
Page
Page
?
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
141
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Stowage compartment
275
276
276
268
A
Cup holders
273
B
Stowage space with Media
Interface
268
;
Selector lever
146
C
=
Manual gearshifting (permanent setting)
Multimedia system controller; see the separate operating instructions
150
:
Door control panel
37
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
83
B
;
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
W Opens/closes the side
windows
89
84
C
=
r45= Saves
the seat and exterior mirror
settings
106
n Activates/deactivates
the override feature for the
side windows in the rear
compartment
65
?
Adjusts the seats electrically
99
q Opens the boot
88
A
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior
mirrors in/out electrically
103
D
38
Overhead control panel
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
u Switches the rear interior lighting on/off
110
;
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
110
=
| Switches the front interior lighting/automatic interior lighting control off
110
?
ë Primes/deactivates
tow-away protection
A
Rear-view mirror
B
ê Primes/deactivates
the interior motion sensor
74
104
75
Function
C
Page
G SOS button (MercedesBenz emergency call system), only available for certain countries
277
D
Spectacles compartment
269
E
3 Opens/closes the panorama sliding sunroof with
roller sunblinds
93
F
c Switches the front interior lighting on
110
G
p Switches the left-hand
reading lamp on/off
110
Panic alarm
To activate: press and hold
! button : for approx. one second.
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed.
X To deactivate: press ! button : again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or, on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS‑GO:
X Press the Start/Stop button.
The key must be in the vehicle.
The panic alarm function is only available in certain countries.
X
Occupant safety
The various components of the restraint system
work complementary to one another. They can
only perform their intended protective function
if all vehicle occupants:
Rhave correctly fastened their seat belt
(Y page 42)
Rhave correctly adjusted their seat and head
restraint (Y page 97).
As the driver, you must also ensure that the
steering wheel is correctly adjusted. Observe
the information relating to the correct driver's
seat position (Y page 97).
Additionally, you must ensure that an airbag can
deploy freely (Y page 44).
The airbag is supplementary to a correctly fastened seat belt. As an additional safety device,
the airbag increases the level of protection for
vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. If
the protection provided by the seat belt is sufficient, the airbags do not deploy. Furthermore,
in the event of an accident, only airbags which
provide greater protection in the given accident
situation deploy. However, seat belts and airbags generally do not protect against objects
penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
Information on how the restraint system operates can be found in "Deployment of the seat
belt tensioner and airbags" (Y page 51).
See "Children in the vehicle" for information on
infants and children traveling with you in the
vehicle restraint systems for infants and children(Y page 54).
Introduction to the restraint system
The restraint system can reduce the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts of
the vehicle's interior in the event of an accident.
Furthermore, the restraint system can also
reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants
are subjected during an accident.
The restraint system includes:
RSeat belt system
RAirbags
RChild restraint system
RChild seat securing system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the restraint system is modified, it may no
longer work as intended. The restraint system
may then not perform its intended protective
function by failing in an accident or triggering
unexpectedly, for example. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Never modify parts of the restraint system. Do
not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
If the vehicle needs to be adapted to accommodate a person with disabilities, please contact a
specialist workshop.
Z
39
Safety
Occupant safety
40
Occupant safety
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use only
driving aids that have been approved specifically for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp
Safety
Restraint system warning lamp
The functions of the restraint system are
checked after the ignition is switched on and at
regular intervals while the engine is running.
Therefore, malfunctions can be detected in
good time.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp on the
instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is
switched on. It goes out no later than a few seconds after the vehicle is started. The components of the restraint system are in operational
readiness.
A malfunction has occurred if the 6 restraint
system warning lamp:
Rdoes not light up after the ignition is switched
on
Rdoes not go out after a few seconds with the
engine running
Rlights up again while the engine is running
G WARNING
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or may not deploy as
intended during an accident. This may affect
the seat belt tensioner or airbag, for example.
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp : and
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp ; are
part of the automatic deactivation system of the
front-passenger front airbag.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG ON lights up for 60 seconds, then both indicator lamps are off
(PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and OFF): the frontpassenger front airbag is able to deploy in the
event of an accident.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up: the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It will then
not be deployed in the event of an accident.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is
off, only the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp shows the status of the front-passenger
front airbag. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp may be lit continuously or be off.
Depending on the person in the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger front airbag must be
either disabled or enabled; see the following
points. You must make sure of this both before
and during a journey.
RChildren in a rearward-facing child
restraint system: the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It is imperative to observe the notes on the "Automatic
front-passenger front airbag deactivation system" (Y page 47) and on "Children in the
vehicle" (Y page 54).
RChildren in a forward-facing child
restraint system: depending on the installed
child restraint system and the age and size of
the child, the front-passenger front airbag is
either disabled or enabled. Therefore, it is
imperative to observe the notes on the "Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactiva-
Occupant safety
Seat belts
Introduction
A correctly worn seat belt is the most effective
means of restraining the movement of vehicle
occupants in the event of a collision or if the
vehicle overturns. This reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts of
the vehicle interior or being ejected from it. The
seat belt also helps to keep the vehicle occupants in the best position in relation to the airbag being deployed.
The seat belt system consists of:
Rseat belts
Rbelt tensioners for the front seat belts and the
outer seat belts in the rear
Rbelt force limiters for the front seat belts and
the outer seat belts in the rear
If the seat belt is pulled quickly or sharply from
the belt outlet, the inertia reel locks. The belt
strap cannot be pulled out any further.
The belt tensioner tightens the seat belt in the
event of a collision so that it fits tightly across
your body. However, it does not pull the vehicle
occupants back in the direction of the seat
backrest.
The belt tensioner does not, however, correct an
incorrect seat position or correct the routing of
a seat belt that is worn incorrectly.
When triggered, seat belt force limiters help to
reduce the peak force exerted by the seat belt
on the vehicle occupant.
The belt force limiters on the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags, which take
on a part of the deceleration force. This can
reduce the forces to which the vehicle occupants are subjected during an accident.
! If the co-driver's seat is not occupied, do not
engage the seat belt tongue in the buckle on
the co-driver's seat. Otherwise, the belt tensioner could be triggered in the event of an
accident and would have to be replaced.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the seat belt is worn incorrectly, it cannot
perform its intended protective function. Furthermore, an incorrectly worn seat belt can
cause additional injuries, e.g. in the event of
an accident, heavy braking or sudden
changes of direction. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting properly.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
G WARNING
Persons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly without an additional suitable restraint system. If the seat belt is worn
incorrectly, it cannot perform its intended
protective function. Furthermore, an incorrectly worn seat belt can cause additional
injuries, e.g. in the event of an accident, heavy
Z
Safety
tion system" (Y page 47) and on "Children in
the vehicle" (Y page 54).
RAll other persons: the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must be off. The frontpassenger front airbag is enabled. Depending
on the stature of the person on the frontpassenger seat, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp may light up. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It will then
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger seat should not
be used.
It is imperative to observe the notes on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 47) as well as
on "Seat belts" (Y page 41) and "Airbags"
(Y page 44). There, you can also find information on the correct seat position.
41
42
Occupant safety
Safety
braking or sudden changes of direction. There
is an increased risk of injury, possibly even
fatal.
Always secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in
additional suitable restraint systems.
If a child younger than twelve years old and
under 1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Ralways secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz vehicle. The child restraint system must be appropriate to the age, weight and size of the child.
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the "Automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 47)
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 54) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot protect as intended, if:
Rthey are damaged, have been modified, are
extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or inertia reels
Seat belts may sustain non-visible damage in
an accident, e.g. due to glass splinters. Modified or damaged seat belts can tear or fail, for
example in the event of an accident. Modified
seat belt tensioners may be deployed unintentionally or not function as intended. There
is an increased risk of injury, possibly even
fatal.
Never modify seat belts, seat belt tensioners,
seat belt anchorages and inertia reels. Ensure
that seat belts are not damaged or worn and
are clean. After an accident, have the seat
belts checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthe
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use
seat belts which have been approved specifically for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Other-
wise, your vehicle's general operating permit
could be invalidated.
Sports seat or AMG Performance seat: this
seat is designed for the standard three-point
seat belt. If you fit another multipoint seat belt,
e.g. sport or racing seat belts, the restraint system cannot provide the best level of protection.
G WARNING
If you feed seat belts through the opening in
the seat backrest, the seat backrest may be
damaged or may even break in the event of an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Only use the standard three-point seat belt.
Never modify the seat belt system.
Correct seat belt use
Pay attention to the safety notes about the seat
belt (Y page 41).
All vehicle occupants must fasten their seat
belts correctly before you start driving. You
must also make sure that all vehicle occupants
have fastened their seat belts correctly during
the journey.
When fastening your seat belt, always make
sure that:
Rthe seat belt tongue is inserted into the belt
buckle that belongs to the seat.
Rthe seat belt is tightened across your body.
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
Rthe seat belt is not twisted.
Only then can the forces which occur be distributed over the area of the belt.
Rthe shoulder section of the belt is always
routed across the centre of your shoulder.
The shoulder section of the belt must not
come into contact with your neck or be routed
under your arm. Adjust the seat belt to the
appropriate height as necessary.
RThe lap belt must be taut and as low as possible over your lap.
The lap belt must always be routed across
your hip joints and not across your abdomen.
Pregnant women must take particular care
with this. If necessary, push the lap belt down
to your hip joint and pull it tight using the
shoulder section of the belt.
Occupant safety
or fragile objects.
If such objects are located on or in your clothing, e.g. pens, keys, spectacles, etc. stow
these in a suitable location.
ROnly one person should use each seat belt at
any one time.
Babies and children must never travel sitting
on the lap of another vehicle occupant. In the
event of an accident, they could be crushed
between the vehicle occupant and seat belt.
RDo not secure any objects with a seat belt if
the seat belt is being used by one of the vehicle's occupants.
You must also make sure that objects, e.g.
cushions, are never placed between a person
and the seat.
Seat belts are solely intended to secure and
restrain persons. To secure objects, luggage or
loads, always observe the "Loading guidelines"
(Y page 268).
Fastening and adjusting the seat belts
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 41) and the information on the correct
use of the seat belt (Y page 42).
matically; see "Belt adjustment"
(Y page 43).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
The shoulder section of the seat belt must
always be routed across the centre of the shoulder. Adjust the belt outlet if necessary.
X To raise: slide the belt outlet upwards.
The belt outlet will engage in various positions.
X To lower: hold belt outlet release = and slide
belt outlet downwards.
X Let go of belt outlet release = in the desired
position and make sure that the belt outlet
engages.
Releasing seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled up.
Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue will be
trapped in the door or in the seat mechanism.
This could damage the door, the door trim
panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts
can no longer fulfil their protective function
and must be replaced. Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Press release button in belt buckle, hold belt
tongue firmly and guide the seat belt back.
Seat belt adjustment
Basic illustration
Adjust the seat (Y page 97).
The seat backrest must be in an almost vertical position.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the belt outlet.
X Engage seat belt tongue ; in belt buckle :.
The seat belt on the driver's seat and the
front-passenger seat may be tightened autoX
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. This function adjusts the driver's and front-passenger
seat belt to the upper body of the occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Rthe seat belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle and
Rthe ignition is switched on
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected between
the vehicle occupant and the seat belt. Do not
hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is adjusting.
You can switch the seat-belt adjustment on and
off in the on-board computer (Y page 212).
Z
Safety
RThe seat belt is not routed over sharp, pointed
43
44
Occupant safety
Safety
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster reminds you that all vehicle occupants must fasten their seat belts. It may light up
continuously or flash. A warning tone may also
sound.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone stops as soon as the driver's
and the co-driver's seat belts have been fastened.
Rear seat belt status indicator
The seat belts on the left and centre rear seats,
when viewed in the direction of travel, are not
fastened. (Example)
The rear seat belt status indicator is available
only in certain countries.
The rear seat belt status indicator informs you
which rear seat belt is not fastened.
Cancelling the rear seat belt status indicator
immediately (Y page 216).
Airbags
Introduction
The airbag installation location is identified by
the label AIRBAG.
An airbag supplements a correctly fastened seat
belt. It is not a substitute for seat belts. The airbag provides additional protection in the corresponding accident situations.
Not all airbags are deployed in an accident. The
various airbag systems work independently of
one another (Y page 51).
However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
Due to the required speed of the airbag after
deployment, it is also not possible to entirely
rule out the risk of injuries caused by the airbag.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the airbag cannot perform its intended protective function and can even cause additional injuries when deployed. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
In order to avoid such risks, always ensure
that all vehicle occupants:
Rfasten
their seatbelts correctly, including
pregnant women
Rare seated correctly and maintain the furthest possible distance from the airbags
Robserve the following notes
Always ensure that there are no objects located between the airbag and the vehicle occupant.
RAdjust
the seats properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the seat
is in an almost upright position. The centre of
the head restraint must support the head at
about eye level.
RMove the driver's and front-passenger seats
as far back as possible. The driver's seat position must allow the vehicle to be driven safely.
ROnly hold the steering wheel on the outside.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
RAlways lean against the backrest while driving. Do not lean forwards or lean against the
door or side window. You may otherwise be in
the deployment area of the airbags.
RAlways keep your feet in the footwell in front
of the seat. Do not put your feet on the dashboard, for example. Your feet may otherwise
be in the deployment area of the airbag.
RAlways secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in
suitable restraint systems. Up to this height,
the seat belt cannot be worn correctly.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, also
observe the following notes:
RAlways secure children under twelve years of
age and less than 1.50 m tall in suitable child
restraint systems.
RChild restraint systems should be fitted to the
rear seats.
ROnly secure a child to the front-passenger
seat when the front-passenger front airbag is
Occupant safety
G WARNING
If you modify an airbag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the airbag can no longer
function correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify an airbag cover or affix objects
to it.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door panelling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. This could cause the system
to identify the seat as being occupied. In the
event of an accident, the restraint systems on
the front-passenger side may be triggered
and have to be replaced.
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the steering wheel. Front-passenger front airbag ;
deploys in front of and above the glove compartment.
When deployed, the front airbags offer additional head and thorax protection for the occupants in the front seats.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
informs you about the status of the frontpassenger front airbag (Y page 40).
The front-passenger front airbag will deploy only
if:
Rthe automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system has detected that the
front-passenger seat is occupied
(Y page 47). The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp is not lit (Y page 47)
Rthe restraint system control unit predicts a
high accident severity
Z
Safety
disabled, and only then in a rearward-facing
child restraint system. If the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp is permanently lit, the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled
(Y page 40).
RAlways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the "Automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 47) and on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 54) in addition to the manufacturer's operating and installation instructions for
the child restraint system.
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent
the airbag from functioning correctly. Before
starting your journey and to avoid risks resulting
from the speed of the airbag as it deploys, make
sure that:
Rthere are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an airbag.
Rthere are no objects between the seat, door
and B-pillar.
Rno hard objects, e.g. coat hangers, are hanging on the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rno accessories, such as cup holders, are
attached to the vehicle within the deployment
area of an airbag, e.g. to doors, side windows,
rear side trim or side walls.
Rno heavy, sharp-edged or fragile objects are in
the pockets of your clothing. Store such
objects in a suitable place.
45
46
Occupant safety
Safety
Driver's kneebag
Driver's knee airbag : deploys under the steering column. The driver's knee airbag is triggered
together with the front airbags.
The driver's knee airbag offers additional thigh,
knee and lower leg protection for the occupant
in the driver's seat.
i The driver's knee airbag is available only in
certain countries.
Sidebags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Operation of the automatic co-driver's front
airbag deactivation system may also be
impaired. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ; deploy
next to the outer bolster of the seat backrest.
When deployed, the sidebag offers additional
thorax protection. It also offers additional pelvis
protection for occupants in the front seats.
However, it does not protect the:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
In the event of a side impact, the sidebag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: the sidebag on
the front-passenger side deploys under the following conditions:
Ran occupant is detected in the frontpassenger seat or
Rthe seat belt buckle tongue is engaged in the
belt buckle of the front-passenger seat
If the belt tongue is engaged in the belt buckle,
the sidebag on the front-passenger side deploys
if an appropriate accident situation occurs. In
this case, deployment is independent of
whether the front-passenger seat is occupied or
not.
Windowbags
Windowbags : are integrated into the side of
the roof frame and deployed in the area from the
A-pillar to the C-pillar.
When deployed, the windowbag offers additional head protection. However, it does not
protect the thorax or arms.
In the event of a side impact, the windowbag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
If the system determines that it can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat
Occupant safety
belt, a windowbag may be deployed in other
accident situations (Y page 51).
47
Operation of automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation
Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
In order to recognise a child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat, the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system categorises the person in the front-passenger seat.
Depending on that result, the front-passenger
front airbag is either enabled or disabled. If a
rearward-facing child restraint system is fitted
to the front-passenger seat, the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must light up after
the system self-test and remain lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
The system does not disable:
Rthe sidebag
Rthe windowbag
Rthe seat belt tensioner
Make sure that your vehicle is equipped with the
automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system (Y page 57). If this is not the
case, always install a child restraint system on a
suitable rear seat (Y page 59).
If it is absolutely necessary to install a child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat, be
sure to observe the correct positioning of the
child restraint system. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system, e.g. a
cushion. Fully retract the seat cushion length.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion of the
front-passenger seat. The backrest of a forwardfacing child restraint system must, as far as
possible, rest flat against the backrest of the
front-passenger seat. The child restraint system
must not touch the roof or be put under strain by
the head restraint. Adjust the angle of the seat
backrest and the head restraint position accordingly. Only then is the correct function of the
automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system guaranteed. Always observe the
information on suitable positioning of the child
restraint system (Y page 59) in addition to the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Safety
Introduction
: PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
; PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
The indicator lamps inform you whether the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled or enabled.
X Press the Start/Stop button once or twice, or
turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
The system carries out a self-diagnosis.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON indicator lamps must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag:
RPASSENGER AIR BAG ON lights up for 60 seconds, then both indicator lamps are off
(PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and OFF): the frontpassenger front airbag is able to deploy in the
event of an accident.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up: the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It will then
not be deployed in the event of an accident.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is
off, only the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp shows the status of the front-passenger
front airbag. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp may be lit continuously or be off.
If the status of the front-passenger front airbag
changes while the vehicle is in motion, an airbag
display message appears on the instrument
cluster (Y page 226). When the front-passenger
seat is occupied, always pay attention to the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp. Be
aware of the status of the front-passenger front
airbag both before and during the journey.
Z
Safety
48
Occupant safety
If a person sits in the passenger seat, he/she
must be:
Rseated with the seat belt fastened correctly
Rin an almost upright position with his/her
back against the seat backrest
Rwith his/her feet resting on the floor, if possible
If the front passenger does not observe these
conditions, the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system may be influenced,
e.g. because the front passenger:
Rtransfers his/her weight by supporting himself/herself on a vehicle armrest
Rsits in such a way that his/her weight is raised
from the seat cushion
The front-passenger front airbag may be disabled by mistake as a result of these or similar
actions. In this case, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp lights up permanently. The
front-passenger front airbag then does not
deploy during an accident.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will not be deployed in the event of an
accident and cannot perform its intended protective function. A person in the frontpassenger seat could then, for example, come
into contact with the vehicle's interior, especially if the person is sitting too close to the
dashboard. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always make sure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and that the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
back as far back as possible.
Rthe person is seated correctly.
Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front-passenger
front airbag is correct.
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the co-driver's seat and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
is off, the co-driver's front airbag can deploy in
the event of an accident. The child could be
struck by the airbag. There is an increased risk
of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always make sure that the codriver's front airbag has been disabled. The
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
must be lit.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
stays off, do not install a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat.
Further information can be found under "Problems with the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system" (Y page 50).
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and you position the front-passenger seat too
close to the dashboard, in the event of an
accident, the child could:
Rcome
into contact with the vehicle's interior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit, for example
Rbe struck by the airbag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is off
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Always move the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible and fully retract the seat
cushion length. Always make sure that the
shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from
the vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system. The shoulder belt strap must be routed forwards and
downwards from the vehicle belt outlet. If
necessary, adjust the vehicle belt outlet and
the front-passenger seat accordingly. Always
observe the information about suitable positioning of the child restraint system in this
Owner's Manual as well as the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Always observe the vehicle-specific information
for the correct positioning of the child restraint
system (Y page 59).
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system detects that:
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a rearward-facing child restraint system, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
But in the case of a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint system, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp can also go out after
the system self-test. This indicates that the
front-passenger front airbag is enabled. The
result of the classification is dependent on,
among other factors, the child restraint system and the child's stature. It is recommended that you fit the child restraint system to a
suitable rear seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a forward-facing child restraint system, either the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp lights up and remains lit after
the system self-test depending on the result
of the classification, or it goes out. The result
of the classification is dependent on, among
other factors, the child restraint system and
the child's stature.
Move the front-passenger seat as far back as
possible. Always observe the information in
"Child restraint systems on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 57) and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system"
(Y page 59). Alternatively, you can fit the
child restraint system to a suitable rear seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a person of smaller stature (e.g. a teenager or
small adult), the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp lights up and remains lit after
the system self-test depending on the result
of the classification or, alternatively, goes out.
- If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is off, move the front-passenger seat
as far back as possible. Alternatively, a person with a small stature can sit on a rear
seat.
- If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, a person with a smaller stature
should not use the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by an
adult or a person with the stature of an adult,
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
goes out after the system self-test. This indicates that the front-passenger front airbag is
enabled.
If children are travelling in the vehicle, be sure to
observe the notes on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 54).
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system is malfunctioning, the red
6 restraint system warning lamp on the
instrument cluster and the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp light up simultaneously.
The front-passenger front airbag is disabled in
this case and does not deploy during an accident. Have the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
If the front-passenger seat, the seat cover or the
seat cushion are damaged, have the necessary
repair work carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use only a child restraint system
that has been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz in combination with the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
system.
System self-test
G DANGER
If both the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps do
not light up during the system self-test, the
system is malfunctioning. The frontpassenger front airbag might be triggered
unintentionally or might not be triggered at all
in the event of an accident with high decelerZ
49
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
50
Occupant safety
ation. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
In this case the front-passenger seat may not
be used. Do not install a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat. Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
remains lit after the system self-test, the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger front airbag
cannot perform its intended protective function, e.g. when a person is seated in the frontpassenger seat.
That person could, for example, come into
contact with the vehicle's interior, especially
if the person is sitting too close to the dashboard. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe person is seated properly with a correctly fastened seat belt.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit when it should not, the frontpassenger seat may not be used. Do not
install a child restraint system on the front-
passenger seat. Have the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Objects between the seat surface and the
child restraint system could affect the function of the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system. This could result
in the front-passenger front airbag not functioning as intended during an accident. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Do not place any objects between the seat
surface and the child restraint system. The
entire base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the forwardsfacing child restraint system must, as far as
possible, be resting on the backrest of the
rear reclining seat. Always comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
After the system self-test, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF or PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp shows the status of the front-passenger
front airbag (Y page 47). If the front-passenger
front airbag is enabled, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up for 60 seconds
and then goes out.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is
off, only the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp shows the status of the front-passenger
front airbag. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp may be lit continuously or be off.
Further information can be found under "Problems with the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system" (Y page 50).
Problems with automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Be sure to observe the notes on "System self-test" (Y page 49).
Occupant safety
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIR
The classification of the person on the front-passenger seat is false.
BAG OFF indicator lamp X Make sure the conditions for a correct classification of the person
lights up and remains lit,
on the front-passenger seat are met (Y page 47).
even though the frontX If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains lit, the frontpassenger seat is occupassenger seat may not be used.
pied by an adult or a perX
Have
the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation sysson with a build corretem checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
sponding to that of an
adult.
The PASSENGER AIR
The automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system is
BAG OFF indicator lamp malfunctioning.
does not light up and/or X Make sure there is nothing between the seat and the child restraint
does not stay on.
system.
The front-passenger seat X Make sure that the entire base of the child restraint system rests on
is:
the seat cushion of the front-passenger seat.
Rempty
X Make sure that the seat cushion length is fully retracted.
Roccupied with a rearX When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the seat
ward-facing child
belt is tight. Do not pull the seat belt tight with the front-passenger
restraint system
seat adjustment. This could result in the seat belt and the child
restraint system being pulled too tightly.
X Check that the child restraint system is installed correctly.
X Make sure that no objects are applying additional weight to the
seat.
X If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains off and/or
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not install
a rearward-facing child restraint system on the front-passenger
seat. It is recommended that you fit the child restraint system to a
suitable rear seat.
X Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Deployment of belt tensioners and airbags
Important safety notes
G WARNING
After the airbag deploys, the airbag parts are
hot. There is a risk of injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have a
deployed airbag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.
G WARNING
Pyrotechnical belt tensioners which have
been triggered are no longer operational and
therefore cannot protect as intended. There is
an increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Have pyrotechnic belt tensioners which have
been triggered replaced at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop
after an accident. Take this into account, particularly if a seat belt tensioner was triggered or
an airbag was deployed.
An electric motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to trigger the tightening of the seat belt in hazardous
situations. This procedure is reversible.
If the belt tensioners are triggered or an airbag is
deployed, you will hear a bang, and a small
Z
Safety
Problem
51
Safety
52
Occupant safety
amount of powder may also be released. The
6 restraint system warning lamp lights up.
Only in rare cases will the bang affect your hearing. In general, the powder released is not hazardous to health but may cause short-term
breathing difficulties to persons suffering from
asthma or other pulmonary conditions. Provided
it is safe to do so, you should leave the vehicle
immediately or open the window in order to prevent breathing difficulties.
Operation
During the first stage of a collision, the restraint
system control unit evaluates important physical data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rintensity
Based on the evaluation of this data, the
restraint system control unit triggers the seat
belt tensioners in the event of a head-on or rear
collision.
A seat belt tensioner can be triggered only if:
Rthe ignition is switched on
Rthe components of the restraint system are
operational. You can find further information
under: "Restraint system warning lamp"
(Y page 40)
Rthe seat belt buckle tongue has engaged in
the belt buckle of the respective front seat
The seat belt tensioners in the rear compartment are triggered independently of the lock
status of the seat belts.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
high-severity accident, in certain head-on collisions, additional components of the restraint
system are deployed independently of each
other:
RFront airbags and driver's kneebag
RWindowbag, if the system determines that
deployment can offer additional protection to
that provided by the seat belt
On vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: depending on
the person in the front-passenger seat, the
front-passenger front airbag is either disabled or
enabled. The front-passenger front airbag can
be deployed in an accident only if the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is off.
Observe the information on the PASSENGER AIR
BAG indicator lamps (Y page 40).
Your vehicle has two-stage front airbags. In the
first deployment stage, the front airbag is filled
with propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries.
The front airbag is fully deployed if the second
deployment stage is activated within a few milliseconds.
The activation threshold for the seat belt tensioners and airbags is determined based on the
evaluation of the vehicle's rate of deceleration
or acceleration at various points in the vehicle.
This process is pre-emptive in nature. The triggering/deployment process should take place
in good time at the start of the collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration
and the direction of the force are essentially
determined by:
Rthe distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors that can be seen and measured only
after a collision has occurred do not play a decisive role in the deployment of an airbag, nor do
they provide an indication of airbag deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly without an airbag being deployed. This is the case if
only parts that are relatively easily deformed are
affected and the rate of deceleration is not high.
Conversely, an airbag may be deployed even
though the vehicle suffers only minor deformation. This is the case if, for example, very rigid
vehicle parts such as longitudinal body members are hit, and sufficient deceleration occurs
as a result.
If the restraint system control unit detects a side
impact, the applicable components of the
restraint system are activated independently of
each other.
RSidebags on the side on which an impact
occurs, independently of the seat belt tensioner and seat belt usage
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: the sidebag
Occupant safety
i Not all airbags are deployed in an accident.
The different airbag systems work independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined
by the severity of the accident detected,
especially the vehicle deceleration or acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal collision
Rside impact
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Introduction
In certain hazardous situations, PRE-SAFE®
takes pre-emptive measures to protect the vehicle occupants.
Important safety notes
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats. There is a risk
that the seats and/or the objects could be
damaged when PRE-SAFE® is activated.
Although your vehicle is equipped with PRESAFE®, the possibility of injury in the event of an
accident cannot be ruled out. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
Function
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. when
BAS is activated
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when physical limits are exceeded and the vehicle understeers or oversteers severely
Rwhen active Brake Assist intervenes powerfully
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
Rif the vehicle skids, the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
Rvehicles with the memory function: the frontpassenger seat is adjusted if it is in an unfavourable position.
If the hazardous situation passes without resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens the belt
pre-tensioning. All settings made by PRE-SAFE®
can then be reversed.
If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced:
X Move the seat backrest or seat back slightly
when the vehicle is stationary.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. Information about the convenience function can be
found under "Belt adjustment" (Y page 43).
Automatic measures after an accident
Immediately after an accident, the following
measures may be implemented, depending on
the type and severity of the impact:
Rthe hazard warning lamps are activated
Rthe emergency lighting is activated
Rthe vehicle doors are unlocked
Rthe front side windows are lowered
Rthe engine is switched off and the fuel supply
is cut off
Rvehicles with the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call system: automatic emergency call
Z
Safety
on the front-passenger side deploys under the
following conditions:
- an occupant is detected in the frontpassenger seat or
- the seat belt buckle tongue is engaged in
the belt buckle of the front-passenger seat
RWindowbag on the side on which an impact
occurs, independently of seat belt usage and
regardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
RSeat belt tensioners, if the system determines
that deployment can offer additional protection for the vehicle occupants in this situation
53
54
Children in the vehicle
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Important safety notes
Accident statistics show that children secured
in the rear seats are safer than children secured
in the front seats. For this reason, MercedesBenz strongly advises that you fit a child
restraint system on a rear seat. Children are
generally better protected there.
If a child younger than twelve years old and
under 1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Ralways secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The child restraint system must be appropriate to the age, weight and size of the child.
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and safety
notes in this section in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation
instructions
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and safety
notes on the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system (Y page 47).
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting
properly. Particular attention must be paid to
children.
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 41) and the notes on how to use the seat
belt properly (Y page 42).
Child restraint system
If you fit a rearward-facing child restraint system
on the centre rear seat, the rear seat armrest
must be folded back as far as it will go.
Be sure to observe the correct use of the child
restraint system (Y page 59).
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system
recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(Y page 63).
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this purpose, it cannot perform its intended protective function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
Children in the vehicle
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
You will find further information on stowing
objects, luggage and loads securely under
"Loading guidelines" (Y page 268).
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
observe the notes on "Child restraint systems
on the co-driver's seat" (Y page 57).
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior and on the child restraint system.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems recommended by Mercedes-Benz. You can
obtain information at a qualified specialist
workshop.
ISOFIX and i-Size child seat securing
systems
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems or i-Size child
restraint systems do not offer sufficient protection for children whose weight is greater
than 22 kg, who are secured using the safety
belt integrated in the child restraint system.
The child could, for example, not be restrained
correctly in the event of an accident. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems or i-Size child
restraint systems with which the child is also
secured with the vehicle seat belt. Also secure
the child restraint system with the Top Tether
belt, if available.
Observe the instructions for correct use of the
child restraint system (Y page 59) and the
installation and operating instructions for the
child restraint system used as provided by the
manufacturer .
Before every trip, make sure that the ISOFIX
child restraint system or the i-Size child restraint
system is engaged correctly in both ISOFIX or iSize securing rings.
Securing systems for child restraint systems
include:
Rthe seat belt system
Rthe ISOFIX or i-Size securing rings
RTop Tether anchorage points
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a child restraint
system on the co-driver's seat, be sure to
Z
Safety
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
55
Safety
56
Children in the vehicle
This symbol indicates an ISOFIX position that is
suitable for attaching an ISOFIX child restraint
system. A similar symbol can be found on the
ISOFIX child restraint system.
; i-Size securing rings
X
or
X
This symbol indicates an i‑Size position that is
suitable for attaching an i-Size child restraint
system. A similar symbol can be found on the iSize child restraint system.
! When fitting the child restraint system,
make sure that the seat belt for the centre
seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the
seat belt could be damaged.
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing rings : or i-Size securing rings ;.
Install the i-Size child restraint system on both
i-Size securing rings ;.
ISOFIX and i-Size are standardised securing systems for special child restraint systems. ISOFIX
child restraint systems are approved in accordance with ECE R-44. i-Size child restraint systems are approved in accordance with ECE
R-129.
Only child restraint systems that have been
approved in accordance with ECE R-44 may be
attached to ISOFIX securing rings. ISOFIX child
restraint systems in accordance with ECE R-44
and i‑Size child restraint systems that have been
approved in accordance with ECE R-129 may be
attached to i-Size securing rings. ISOFIX securing ring : or i-Size securing ring ; are installed on the left and right sides of the rear seats.
Top Tether
Introduction
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured with
ISOFIX and the vehicle. It helps reduce the risk
of injury even further. If the child restraint system is fitted with a Top Tether belt, this should
always be used.
Important safety notes
: ISOFIX securing rings
G WARNING
If the rear seat backrests are not locked, they
could fold forwards in the event of an acci-
Children in the vehicle
If the rear backrest is not engaged and locked,
the red lock verification indicator will be visible
(Y page 271).
Top Tether anchorages
Vehicles with adjustable head restraints:
X
X
Move head restraint : upwards.
Route Top Tether belt A under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
Vehicles without adjustable head restraints:
X
or
X
Top Tether belt with one belt strap: route
Top Tether belt A centrally over head
restraint :.
Top Tether belt with two belt straps: route
one Top Tether belt A to the left and one to
the right past the side of head restraint :.
All vehicles:
Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with Top
Tether. Always comply with the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? of Top Tether belt
A into Top Tether anchorage =.
Ensure that:
RTop Tether hook ? is hooked into Top
Tether anchorage = as shown
RTop Tether belt A is not twisted
RTop Tether belt A is routed between the
rear seat backrest and the luggage compartment cover if the luggage compartment cover is fitted
X
X
Tension Top Tether belt A. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
Vehicles with adjustable head restraints:
X
The Top Tether anchorage points are fitted in the
rear compartment behind the outer head
restraints on the parcel shelf.
X Press down the rear of cover ; in the direction of the arrow.
Cover ; is raised slightly at the front.
X Fold cover ; upwards.
If necessary, move head restraint : back
down again slightly. Make sure that you do
not interfere with the correct routing of Top
Tether belt A.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
General notes
Accident statistics show that children secured
in the rear seats are safer than children secured
in the front-passenger seat. For this reason,
Mercedes-Benz strongly advises that you install
a child restraint system on a rear seat.
Z
Safety
dent, heavy braking or sudden changes of
direction. As a result, child restraint systems
cannot perform their intended protective
function. Rear seat backrests that are not
locked can also cause additional injuries, e.g.
in the event of an accident. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always lock rear seat backrests after fitting a
Top Tether belt. Observe the lock verification
indicator. Adjust the rear seat backrests so
that they are in an upright position.
57
Safety
58
Children in the vehicle
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: if it is absolutely necessary to fit a child restraint system to
the front-passenger seat, always observe the
information on the "Automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system" (Y page 47).
You can thus avoid the risks that could arise as
a result of:
Ra child restraint system that is not detected
by the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system
Runintentional disabling of the front-passenger
front airbag
Runsuitable positioning of the child restraint
system, e.g. too close to the dashboard
Please observe the warning notice on the
front-passenger sun visor; see illustration.
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the co-driver's seat and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
is off, the co-driver's front airbag can deploy in
the event of an accident. The child could be
struck by the airbag. There is an increased risk
of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always make sure that the codriver's front airbag has been disabled. The
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
must be lit.
NEVER use a rearward-facing child restraint on a
seat protected by an ACTIVE FRONT AIRBAG;
DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the child can
occur.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
is not lit, the front-passenger front airbag is enabled (Y page 40).
Vehicles without the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation
system
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle is not
equipped with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system, this is indicated by a special sticker. The sticker is affixed to
the side of the dashboard on the frontpassenger side. The sticker is visible when you
open the front-passenger door.
If you turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps light
up briefly. However, they have no function and
do not indicate that there is an automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system.
In this case, never fit a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger seat
(Y page 59).
Observe the following information under "Rearward-facing child restraint system"
(Y page 58) and "Forward-facing child
restraint system" (Y page 59) as well as information on the suitable positioning of the child
restraint system (Y page 59).
Rearward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a rearwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always make sure that the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. Only if
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
lit continuously (Y page 40) is the frontpassenger front airbag disabled.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 59) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Children in the vehicle
59
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a forwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always move the frontpassenger seat as far back as possible. Fully
retract the seat cushion length. The entire base
of the child restraint system must always rest on
the seat cushion of the front-passenger seat.
The backrest of the child restraint system must,
as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of
the front-passenger seat. The child restraint system must not touch the roof or be put under
strain by the head restraint. Adjust the angle of
the seat backrest and the head restraint position accordingly. Always make sure that the
shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from the
vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt guide on
the child restraint system. The shoulder belt
strap must be routed forwards and downwards
from the vehicle belt outlet. If necessary, adjust
the vehicle belt outlet and the front-passenger
seat accordingly.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 59) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint system
Introduction
Only child restraint systems approved in accordance with ECE standards ECE R44 or ECE R129
(i-Size child restraint systems) are permitted for
use in the vehicle.
For certain child restraint systems in weight categories II or III, this can mean that the area of
use is restricted. The maximum size setting of
the child restraint system may not be possible
due to possible contact with the roof.
"Universal" category child restraint systems can
be recognised by their orange approval label and
the text "Universal" or an "i-Size" label.
Safety
Forward-facing child restraint system
Example: approval label on the child restraint
system
ISOFIX or i-Size child restraint systems of the
“Universal“ category can be used on seats labelled U, UF, IUF or i-U in accordance with the following tables:
RSuitability of the seats for attaching beltsecured child restraint systems
RSuitability of the seats for attaching ISOFIX
child restraint systems
RSuitability of the seats for attaching an i-Size
child restraint system
Semi-universal child restraint systems are indicated by the text "semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehicle
and the seat are listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For more
information, contact the child restraint system
manufacturer or visit their website.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat – if it is absolutely necessary to
secure a child in a child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat:
X Always pay attention to the instructions under
"Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 57).
There you will find instructions on how to correctly route the shoulder belt strap from the
Z
Safety
60
Children in the vehicle
vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt guide
on the child restraint system (Y page 59).
X Move the front-passenger seat as far back as
possible and fully retract the seat cushion
length.
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
you must also move the front-passenger seat
to the highest position.
X Move the backrest to an almost vertical position.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion of the
front-passenger seat. The backrest of the
forward-facing child restraint system must, as
far as possible, be resting on the backrest of
the front-passenger seat. The child restraint
system must not touch the roof or be put
under strain by the head restraint. Adjust the
angle of the seat backrest and the head
restraint position accordingly. Also observe
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions.
X If possible, move the seat cushion angle to the
highest, most vertical position (Y page 98).
Suitability of the seats for attaching a belt-secured child restraint system
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system of category
I on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat does not touch
the child restraint system.
If you use a category I, forward-facing child restraint system, you should remove the head restraint
from the respective seat, if possible (Y page 100). The backrest of the child restraint system must,
as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Make sure that the child's feet do not touch the front seat. If necessary, move the front seat forward
slightly.
For certain child restraint systems in weight categories II or III, this can mean that the area of use
is restricted. The maximum size setting of the child restraint system may not be possible due to
possible contact with the roof.
Always observe the notes in the "Child restraint system" section (Y page 54) and the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system, you must replace the head restraints again immediately (Y page 99). All vehicle occupants must adjust their head restraints correctly before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X Seat that is unsuitable for children in this weight category.
U Suitable for child restraint systems in the "Universal" category that are approved for use in this
weight category.
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category and
are approved for use in this weight category.
L Suitable for child restraint systems as recommended; see the "Recommended child restraint
systems" table (Y page 63). Suitable for semi-universal child restraint systems if the vehicle
and the seat are listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's vehicle model list.
Children in the vehicle
Front-passenger seat
Rear seat
Frontpassenger
front airbag
enabled
Frontpassenger
front airbag
disabled1
Left, right
Centre2
0
up to 10 kg
X
U, L
U, L
U, L
0+
up to 13 kg
X
U, L
U, L
U, L
I
9 kg to 18 kg
UF, L
U, L
U, L
U, L
II
15 kg to 25 kg
U, L
U, L
U, L
X
III
22 kg to 36 kg
U, L
U, L
U, L
X
Safety
Weight category
61
Suitability of the seats for attaching ISOFIX child restraint systems
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system of category
I on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat does not touch
the child restraint system.
If you use a category I, forward-facing child restraint system, you should remove the head restraint
from the respective seat, if possible (Y page 100). The backrest of the child restraint system must,
as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Make sure that the child's feet do not touch the front seat. If necessary, move the front seat forward
slightly.
For certain child restraint systems in weight categories II or III, this can mean that the area of use
is restricted. The maximum size setting of the child restraint system may not be possible due to
possible contact with the roof.
Always observe the notes in the "Child restraint system" section (Y page 54) and the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system, you must replace the head restraints again immediately (Y page 99). All vehicle occupants must adjust their head restraints correctly before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X ISOFIX position that is not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this weight category
and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child seat securing systems that belong to the "Universal"
category and are approved for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the "Recommended child
restraint systems" table (Y page 63).
The manufacturer will also recommend a suitable ISOFIX child restraint system. For this, your
vehicle and the seat must be listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's model list. For
more information, contact the child restraint system manufacturer or visit their website.
The vehicle is equipped with an automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system. The PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
2 Child restraint systems with a supporting bracket are not suitable for this seat.
1
Z
Children in the vehicle
62
Weight category
Safety
Carry cot
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat left,
right
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
0
up to 10 kg
up to approximately 6 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
0+
up to 13 kg
up to approximately 15 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL3
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL3
B
ISO/F2
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
IUF
I
9 kg to 18 kg
between approximately 9 months
and 4 years
The child restraint system must not touch the roof or be put under strain by the head restraints.
Adjust the head restraint position accordingly. Also observe the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Suitability of the seats for attaching an i-Size child restraint system
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system of category
I on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat does not touch
the child restraint system.
If you use a category I, forward-facing child restraint system, you should remove the head restraint
from the respective seat, if possible (Y page 100). The backrest of the child restraint system must,
as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Make sure that the child's feet do not touch the front seat. If necessary, move the front seat forward
slightly.
Always observe the notes in the "Child restraint system" section (Y page 54) and the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system, you must replace the head restraints again immediately (Y page 99). All vehicle occupants must adjust their head restraints correctly before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X Seat that is unsuitable for i-Size child restraint systems in the "Universal" category.
i‑U Suitable for a forward or rearward-facing i-Size child restraint system in the "Universal" category.
3
If you are using a child restraint system of size category C (ISO/R3), make sure that the front seat backrest
does not rest against the child restraint system.
Children in the vehicle
63
Seat
Left
Centre
Right
X
i‑U
X
i‑U
i‑Size child restraint systems
Rear seat
Safety
Frontpassenger
seat
Recommended child restraint systems
General notes
Always observe the information in "Child restraint systems on the front-passenger seat" (Y page 57)
and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system" (Y page 59).
You can obtain further information about the correct child restraint system from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Recommended child restraint systems for attaching with the vehicle seat belt
4
Weight category
Manufacturer
Type
Approval number(E1 ...)
Order number
(A 000 ...)4
Category 0: up
to10 kg
up to approximately6 months
Britax Römer
BABY SAFE
plus II
04 301146
970 20 00
970 36 00
Category 0+: up
to13 kg
up to approximately15 months
Britax Römer
BABY SAFE
plus II
04 301146
970 20 00
970 36 00
Group I:
9 kgto18 kg
between approximately
9 monthsand
4 years
Britax Römer
DUO plus
03 301133
970 16 00
970 37 00
Group II/III:
15 kgto36 kg
between approximately4and
12 years
Britax Römer
KIDFIX
04 301198
970 19 00
970 38 00
Britax Römer
KIDFIX XP
04 301304
970 61 00
Colour code 9H95.
Z
Children in the vehicle
64
Safety
Recommended "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint systems
Weight category
Size cat- Manufacturer Type
egory
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order number4
Category
0+:
up to13 kg
E
Category I:
B1
9 kgto18 kg
Britax Römer
BABY SAFE
plus
04 301146
B6 6 86 8224
Britax Römer
DUO plus
04 301133
A 000 970 16 00
A 000 970 37 00
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are travelling in the vehicle, they
could:
Ropen doors, thus endangering other people
or road users
Rexit the vehicle and be caught by oncoming
traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Always activate the child-proof locks and
override feature if children are travelling in the
vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Override feature for:
rear doors (Y page 65)
Rthe rear side windows (Y page 65)
Rthe
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
4
Colour code 9H95.
Driving safety systems
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
X
To enable/disable: press button :.
If indicator lamp ; is lit, operation of the rear
side windows is disabled. Operation is only
possible using the switches in the driver's
door. If indicator lamp ; is off, operation is
possible using the switches in the rear compartment.
Pets in the vehicle
G WARNING
If you leave animals unsupervised or unsecured in the vehicle, they may push a button
or a switch, for example.
They could:
Ractivate
You can secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened from the
outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock lever
up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof lock is working
properly.
X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Override feature for the rear side windows
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
Rswitch vehicle systems on or off, thus
endangering other road users
In the event of an accident, sudden braking or
abrupt changes of direction, unsecured animals could be flung around the vehicle, injuring the vehicle occupants. There is a risk of an
accident and injury.
Never leave animals unattended in the vehicle. Always secure animals correctly during a
journey, e.g. in an animal transport box.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 66)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 66)
RActive Brake Assist (Y page 67)
RAdaptive brake lights (Y page 69)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 69)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 72)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 73)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 73)
Z
Safety
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
65
66
Driving safety systems
Safety
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you are
inattentive, the driving safety systems can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override
the laws of physics. Driving safety systems are
merely aids designed to assist driving. You are
responsible for maintaining the distance to the
vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in
good time and for staying in lane. Always adapt
your driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
The driving safety systems described work as
effectively as possible only when there is adequate contact between the tyres and the road
surface. Please pay special attention to the
notes on tyres, recommended minimum tyre
tread depths etc. (Y page 310).
In wintry driving conditions, always use winter
tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary, snow
chains. Only in this way will the driving safety
systems described in this section work as effectively as possible.
tivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems, including driving safety systems, will also become
inoperative. Observe the information on the ABS
warning lamp (Y page 250) and display messages which may be shown in the instrument
cluster (Y page 217).
Braking
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application: depress
the brake pedal with full force.
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication
of hazardous road conditions; this serves as a
reminder to take extra care while driving.
X
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way that
the wheels do not lock when you brake. This
allows you to continue steering the vehicle when
braking.
The ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out when the engine is running.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h,
regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS
works on slippery surfaces, even when you only
brake gently.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 66).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deac-
BAS (Brake Assist)
General notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations.
If you depress the brake pedal quickly, BAS
automatically boosts the braking force, thus
shortening the stopping distance.
Important safety notes
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 66).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
Driving safety systems
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
X
Active Brake Assist
General information
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 66).
Active Brake Assist consists of a distance warning function with an autonomous braking function and braking assistance appropriate to the
situation.
Active Brake Assist can help you to minimise the
risk of a collision with the vehicle travelling in
front or reduce the effects of such a collision.
If Active Brake Assist detects that there is a risk
of collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. If you do not react to the visual and
audible collision warning, autonomous braking
can be initiated in critical situations. If you apply
the brake yourself in a critical situation, Adaptive Brake Assist supports you with braking
assistance appropriate to the situation.
Important safety notes
Detection of hazardous situations can be particularly impaired by:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in multistorey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different line
Rnew vehicles or after servicing is carried out
on the Active Brake Assist system
Read the important safety notes in the "Running-in notes" section (Y page 132).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle,
have the configuration and operation of the
radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. This also applies to collisions at low
speeds where no visible damage to the front of
the vehicle is apparent.
Activating/deactivating
Active Brake Assist is active after every ignition
cycle.
You can activate or deactivate Active Brake
Assist (Y page 209) in the on-board computer.
When the system is deactivated, the distance
warning function and the autonomous braking
function are also deactivated.
If Active Brake Assist is deactivated, the æ
symbol appears in the assistance graphic display.
Distance warning function
General information
The distance warning function can help you to
minimise the risk of collision with the vehicle in
front or reduce the effects of such a collision. If
the distance warning function detects a risk of
collision with the vehicle in front, you will be
warned visually and audibly.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 66).
G WARNING
The distance warning function does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Thus, the distance warning function cannot
provide a warning in all critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
G WARNING
The distance warning function cannot always
clearly identify objects and complex traffic
situations.
Z
Safety
Braking
67
68
Driving safety systems
In such cases, the distance warning function
may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation; do not rely on the distance warning
function alone.
Safety
Rnot
Function
The distance warning function issues a warning
at speeds:
Rof approximately 30 km/h or more if, over
several seconds, the distance to the vehicle
travelling in front is insufficient for the driving
speed. The · distance warning lamp will
then light up on the instrument cluster.
Rof approximately 7 km/h or more if you rapidly approach a vehicle in front. An intermittent warning tone will then sound and the
· distance warning lamp will light up on
the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately to increase the distance
from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Due to the nature of the system, certain complex but non-critical driving conditions may also
cause the system to display a warning.
With the help of the radar sensor system, the
distance warning function can detect obstacles
that are in the path of your vehicle for an extended period of time.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, the
distance warning function can also react to stationary obstacles, such as stopped or parked
vehicles.
Autonomous braking function
If the driver does not react to the distance warning signal in a critical situation, Active Brake
Assist can assist the driver with the autonomous
braking function.
The autonomous braking function:
Rgives the driver more time to react to critical
driving situations
Rcan help the driver to avoid an accident or
Rreduces the effects of an accident
Vehicles without Distance Pilot DISTRONIC:
the autonomous braking function is available in
the following speed ranges:
R7–105 km/h for moving objects
R7 - 50 km/h for stationary objects
Vehicles with Distance Pilot DISTRONIC: the
autonomous braking function is available in the
following speed ranges:
R7 - 200 km/h for moving objects
R7 - 50 km/h for stationary objects
Due to the nature of the system, complex but
non-critical driving conditions may also cause
the autonomous braking function to engage.
If the autonomous braking function demands
particularly high braking force, preventative
passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®)
are activated simultaneously (Y page 53).
Braking assistance appropriate to the
situation
General information
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 66).
With the help of the radar sensor system, Adaptive Brake Assist can detect obstacles that are in
the path of your vehicle for an extended period
of time.
If Adaptive Brake Assist detects a risk of collision with the vehicle in front, it calculates the
brake pressure necessary to avoid a collision. If
you apply the brakes forcefully, the braking
assistance adapts to the situation and automatically increases the brake pressure to a degree
appropriate to the traffic situation.
Braking assistance appropriate to the situation
provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds above 7 km/h. It uses the radar
sensor system to assess the traffic situation.
Braking assistance appropriate to the situation
is capable of reacting to moving objects which
have already been recognised as such at least
once over the period of observation, up to vehicle speeds of around 250 km/h.
Driving safety systems
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 66).
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, Adaptive Brake Assist may not
intervene in all critical conditions. The risk of
an accident remains.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Adaptive Brake Assist might:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
The risk of an accident remains.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
Due to the nature of the system, complex but
non-critical driving conditions may also cause
Active Brake Assist to intervene.
Even if Active Brake Assist is not available due to
a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the
brake system is still available with full brake
boosting effect and BAS.
Adaptive brake lights
The adaptive brake lights warn following traffic
in an emergency braking situation by:
Rflashing brake lamps
Rthe hazard warning lamps are activated
If you brake sharply from a speed of more than
50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS or BAS
PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In this way,
traffic travelling behind you is warned in an even
more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more than
70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning
lamps are activated automatically. If the brakes
are applied again, the brake lamps light up continuously. The hazard warning lamps switch off
automatically if you travel faster than 10 km/h.
You can also switch off the hazard warning
lamps using the hazard warning button
(Y page 109).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 66).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction, i.e.
power transmission between the tyres and the
road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating from
the direction desired by the driver, one or more
wheels are braked to stabilise the vehicle. The
engine output is also modified to keep the vehicle on the desired course within physical limits.
ESP® assists the driver when pulling away on
wet or slippery roads. ESP® can also stabilise
the vehicle during braking.
Z
Safety
Braking assistance appropriate to the situation
can also detect stationary objects, up to vehicle
speeds of around 70 km/h.
If braking assistance appropriate to the situation demands particularly high brake pressure,
preventative passenger protection measures
(PRE-SAFE®) are triggered simultaneously
(Y page 53).
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou release the brake pedal
Ra danger of collision with the vehicle in front
no longer exists
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your vehicle
Braking assistance appropriate to the situation
is then deactivated.
69
70
Driving safety systems
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
Safety
tion (Y page 66).
ETS traction control is part of ESP®. On vehicles
with 4MATIC, 4ETS is part of ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, e.g. if
the road surface is slippery on one side. In addition, more drive torque is transferred to the
wheel or wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate
ESP®.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 66).
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
ESP®
Drive on carefully. Have
checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles without 4MATIC: when towing your
vehicle with the front axle raised, it is important
that you observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 306).
If the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
continuously, ESP® is deactivated.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp and the å
warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Read the information on warning lamps
(Y page 252) and display messages that may be
shown in the instrument cluster (Y page 217).
Use only wheels with the recommended tyre
sizes. Only then will ESP® function properly.
Characteristics of ESP®
General information
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
you begin the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp
flashes on the instrument cluster.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, depress the accelerator
pedal only as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road and weather conditions.
X
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP® was
deactivated before the engine was switched off,
ESP® remains deactivated when the engine is
switched on again.
Activating/deactivating ESP® (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 66).
You can select between the following ESP® statuses:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated
is deactivated
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
The spinning of the wheels results in a cut for
better traction on loose surfaces.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen snow chains are used
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
Driving safety systems
Activating/deactivating ESP®
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
You can deactivate or activate ESP® via the onboard computer (Y page 209).
ESP®deactivated:
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp on the instrument cluster lights up.
ESP®activated:
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp on the instrument cluster goes out.
G WARNING
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in the
instrument cluster flashes. In such situations,
ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels may start to spin
Rtraction control is still activated
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; it is not
activated even if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RSTEER CONTROL is no longer active
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
Rengine
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
In the following situations, it may be better to
activate SPORT handling mode or deactivate
ESP®:
Rwhen snow chains are used
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Ron specially designated roads when the vehicle's own oversteering and understeering
characteristics are desired
Driving in SPORT handling mode or without
ESP® requires a highly qualified and experienced driver.
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to
spin.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
(Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
Activating/deactivating ESP®
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 66).
You can select between the following ESP® statuses:
RESP®
is activated
handling mode is activated
RESP® is deactivated
ESP® is activated every time the engine is started, regardless of whether ESP® was deactivated before the engine was switched off.
RSPORT
X
To activate SPORT handling mode: briefly
press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp on the instrument cluster lights up. The
Z
Safety
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to
spin.
71
Driving safety systems
72
SPORT handling mode message appears in
the multifunction display.
X To deactivate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp on the instrument cluster goes out.
To deactivate ESP®: press button : until
the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
The ÷ OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
X To activate ESP®: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp on the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷ ESP®
ON message appears in the multifunction display.
Safety
X
Characteristics when SPORT handling
mode is activated
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one or
more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp on the instrument cluster flashes. In
such situations, ESP® will stabilise the vehicle
only to a limited degree.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
improves driving stability only to a limited degree
Rtraction control is still activated
Rthe engine's torque is only restricted to a limited degree and the drive wheels may start to
spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cut for
better traction on loose surfaces.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in the
instrument cluster does not flash. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels may start to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cut for
better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated
Rengine
RActive Brake Assist is no longer available; it is
not activated even if you brake firmly with
assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; it is not
activated even if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
ESP® trailer stabilisation
General notes
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, ESP® assists you in this situation. ESP®
slows the vehicle down by braking and limiting
the engine output until the vehicle/trailer combination has stabilised.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If road and weather conditions are poor,
trailer stabilisation will not be able to prevent
the vehicle/trailer combination from swerving. Trailers with a high centre of gravity can
tip over before ESP® can detect this. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, you can only stabilise the vehicle/trailer
combination by depressing the brake firmly.
ESP® trailer stabilisation is active above speeds
of approximately 65 km/h.
ESP® trailer stabilisation does not work if ESP®
is deactivated or disabled because of a malfunction.
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure
on the rear wheels to improve driving stability
while braking.
Important safety notes
Protection against theft
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
Immobiliser
(Y page 66).
G WARNING
If EBD is malfunctioning, the rear wheels can
lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the
risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 250) as well as display
messages (Y page 219).
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
X To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS-GO: switch the ignition off
and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can start
the engine if a valid key has been left inside the
vehicle.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated when
you start the engine.
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety and
offers increased braking comfort. In addition to
the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE also has
the HOLD function (Y page 172) and hill start
assist (Y page 136).
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
STEER CONTROL
General information
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering wheel
in the direction required for vehicle stabilisation.
This steering support is provided in particular if:
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on a
wet or slippery road surface when you brake
Rthe vehicle begins to skid
Important safety notes
i Read the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 66).
No steering support is provided from STEER
CONTROL, if:
RESP®
is malfunctioning
steering is malfunctioning
If ESP® is malfunctioning, you will be assisted
further by the electrical power steering.
Rthe
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system
is primed after approximately 15 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra door
Rthe vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
Z
73
Safety
Protection against theft
Protection against theft
74
X
or
To stop the alarm with the key: press the
% or & button on the key.
The alarm stops.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock (Y page 133).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm stops.
Safety
X
X
or
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key must
be outside the vehicle.
The alarm stops.
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm stops.
The alarm does not switch off, even if you close
the open door that has triggered it, for example.
Rthe
doors are closed
boot lid is closed
Only then is tow-away protection activated.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is activated after
approximately 60 seconds.
Rthe
Switching off
X
or
X
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
i If the alarm stays on for more than
30 seconds, the Mercedes‑Benz emergency
call system automatically sends a message to
the Customer Centre. This is done by means
of a text message or a data connection.
The emergency call system sends a message
or establishes a data connection provided
that:
Ryou have subscribed to the Mercedes‑Benz
emergency call system
Rthe Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system
has been activated properly
Rthe necessary mobile phone network is
available
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur if
the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for example.
Switching on
X
Make sure that:
X
or
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS-GO: switch off the engine using
the Start/Stop button and open the driver's
door.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
Tow-away protection remains deactivated until:
Rthe vehicle is unlocked again
Ra door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
X
Protection against theft
Deactivating
Safety
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate tow-away
protection if you lock your vehicle and it:
Ris being transported
Ris being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter,
for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a splitlevel garage
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is switched on,
a visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This can
occur if someone reaches into the vehicle interior, for example.
Switching on
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging
on the rear-view mirror or on the grab handles on the roof trim
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor activated.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Switching off
X
or
X
or
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
Press the Start/Stop button.
The key must be in the vehicle.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
switched off.
75
X
or
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS-GO: switch off the engine using
the Start/Stop button and open the driver's
door.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes several times in
rapid succession.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated
until:
Rthe vehicle is unlocked again and
Ra door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior
motion sensor if you lock your vehicle and:
Rpeople or animals remain in the vehicle
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof remains open
Rthe side windows remain open
X
i UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a
double-lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle has been
locked with the key (Y page 83). Deactivate
the interior motion sensor before you lock the
vehicle with the key. The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside with the key.
Observe the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 83).
Z
76
Key
Key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Opening and closing
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
may not be detected, e.g. when starting the
engine using the Start/Stop button.
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the
double lock function by deactivating the interior
motion sensor (Y page 75). The doors can then
be opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. You can open the
rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not
secured by the child-proof locks (Y page 65).
The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the
door is opened from the inside. Switch off the
alarm (Y page 73).
Key functions
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function
could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Do not keep the key:
Rwith electronic devices, e.g. a mobile phone
or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal foil
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function: do
not keep the key in the boot. Otherwise, the key
: & Locks the vehicle
; F Opens the boot lid
= % Unlocks the vehicle
If you do not open the vehicle within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe vehicle locks again
Rprotection against theft is reactivated
Key
To lock: press the & button.
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe doors
Rthe boot lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
During unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
During locking, they flash three times.
When the locator lighting is activated via the
multimedia system, it also lights up when it is
dark after the vehicle is unlocked with the
remote control (see the separate operating
instructions).
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated or deactivated using the
on-board computer (Y page 211).
X To open the boot lid automatically: press
and hold the F button until the boot lid
opens (Y page 87).
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a key in
the vehicle.
Rwhen
using HANDS-FREE ACCESS
the external door handles are touched
Rduring convenience closing
Rwhen
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :
or ;.
Make sure that you do not touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended
period.
Further information on the convenience closing feature (Y page 90).
X
Locking and unlocking
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you need to carry the
key with you. You can combine the KEYLESS-GO
functions with the functions of a conventional
key. Unlock the vehicle using KEYLESS-GO, for
instance, and lock it using the & button on
the key.
The driver's door and the door at which the handle is used must both be closed. The key must be
outside the vehicle. When locking or unlocking
with KEYLESS-GO, the distance between the key
and the corresponding door handle must not be
greater than 1 m.
A check that periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in or in the
direct vicinity of the vehicle. This occurs, for
example:
Rduring engine start
Rduring driving
X
To unlock the boot lid: pull boot lid handle :.
Deactivating and activating
If you do not intend to use the vehicle for an
extended period of time, you can deactivate
KEYLESS-GO. The key will then use very little
power, thereby conserving battery power. For
the purposes of activation or deactivation, the
vehicle does not have to be nearby.
Z
Opening and closing
X
77
Key
78
To deactivate: press the & button on the
key twice in rapid succession.
The battery check lamp of the key flashes
twice briefly and lights up once; KEYLESS-GO
is deactivated (Y page 79).
X To activate: press any button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
KEYLESS-GO and all its associated features
are available again.
Opening and closing
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
X To unlock the driver's door: touch the inner
surface of the door handle on the driver's
door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface
of the door handle on the front-passenger
door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
KEYLESS-GO start function
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a key in
the vehicle.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking system. This means that only the driver's door and
the fuel filler flap are unlocked when the vehicle
is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel
alone.
X To change the setting: press and hold down
the % and & buttons simultaneously
for about six seconds until the battery indicator lamp flashes twice (Y page 79).
If the setting of the locking system is changed
within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing
the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
X To unlock: press the % button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button
twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
To restore the factory settings: press and
hold down the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp flashes twice
(Y page 79).
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with the
key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to unlock
and open the driver's door or the boot lid, the
anti-theft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 73).
There are several ways to deactivate the alarm:
X To deactivate the alarm with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESS-GO:
press the Start/Stop button in the ignition
lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
or
X Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the key
into the ignition lock.
Key
Removing the emergency key element
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
battery replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Checking the battery
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely
into the key until it engages and release
catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 79).
i If the key battery is checked within the signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing
the & or % button:
X
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified
specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
X
Z
Opening and closing
Push release catch : in the direction of the
arrow and, at the same time, remove emergency key element ; from the key.
Further information about:
RUnlocking the driver's door (Y page 85)
RUnlocking the boot (Y page 88)
RLocking the vehicle (Y page 85)
X
79
Key
80
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm until
battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to
do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X Insert the front tabs of battery tray cover :
and then press to close it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 79).
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
Opening and closing
X
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the arrow
until battery tray cover : opens. When doing
so, do not hold cover : shut.
X Remove battery tray cover :.
X
Key
81
Problems with the key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle using
the key.
X
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery (Y page 79) and replace if necessary
(Y page 79).
X Unlock (Y page 85) or lock (Y page 85) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function:
try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle
from close range and press the % or & button.
X
If this does not work:
Unlock (Y page 85) or lock (Y page 85) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
The key is faulty.
Unlock (Y page 85) or lock (Y page 85) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
You can no longer lock or The key battery is weak or discharged.
unlock the vehicle using X Check the key battery (Y page 79) and replace if necessary
KEYLESS-GO.
(Y page 79).
If this does not work:
X Unlock (Y page 85) or lock (Y page 85) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Unlock (Y page 85) or lock (Y page 85) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
Z
Opening and closing
The key battery is weak or discharged.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function:
try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle
from close range and press the % or & button.
82
Key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
Lock or unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the
key.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked even using the remote
control function:
X Unlock (Y page 85) or lock (Y page 85) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Opening and closing
X
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
The on-board voltage is too low.
Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary (Y page 301).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 301).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The engine cannot be
The vehicle is locked.
started using the Start/ X Unlock the vehicle and try to start the vehicle again.
Stop button. The key is in
the vehicle.
The key battery is weak or discharged.
X Check the key battery (Y page 79) and replace if necessary
(Y page 79).
If this does not work:
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
X
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the luggage
compartment. Observe the loading guidelines
(Y page 268).
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked with the key, the
double lock function is activated as standard. It
is then not possible to open the doors from
inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior
motion sensor (Y page 75). The doors can then
be opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. You can open the
rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not
secured by the child-proof locks (Y page 65).
The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the
door is opened from the inside. Switch off the
alarm (Y page 73).
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
! The side windows will not open/close if the
battery is discharged or if the side windows
have iced up. It will then not be possible to
close the door. Do not attempt to force the
door to close. You could otherwise damage
the door or the side window.
When a door is opened, the side window on that
side opens slightly. When the door is closed, the
side window is raised again.
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops up.
The door is unlocked and opens.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked. You can only open the
rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not
secured by the child-proof locks (Y page 65).
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key from the outside, opening a door from
the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 73).
United Kingdom only:
X
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
Z
Opening and closing
Doors
83
Doors
84
Opening and closing
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the
double lock function by deactivating the interior
motion sensor (Y page 75). The doors can then
be opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. You can open the
rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not
secured by the child-proof locks (Y page 65).
The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the
door is opened from the inside. Switch off the
alarm (Y page 73).
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle from
the inside. This can be useful if you wish to lock
the vehicle before pulling away, for example.
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
If all the doors and the boot lid are closed, the
vehicle locks.
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from the
inside if the vehicle has been locked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
X
X
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key from the outside, opening a door from
the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 73).
You can open the rear doors from inside the
vehicle if they are not secured by the child-proof
locks (Y page 65).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will be
observed if the vehicle has been:
Rlocked with the locking button for the central
locking or
Rlocked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. Only the door that has
been opened from the inside is unlocked if only
the driver's door had previously been unlocked.
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function
by deactivating the interior motion sensor
(Y page 75). The doors can then be opened from
the inside after the vehicle has been locked from
the outside. You can open the rear doors from
inside the vehicle if they are not secured by the
child-proof locks (Y page 65). The anti-theft
alarm system is triggered if the door is opened
from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 73).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will be
observed if the vehicle has been:
Rlocked with the locking button for the central
locking or
Rlocked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. Only the door that has
been opened from the inside is unlocked if only
the driver's door had previously been unlocked.
Doors
85
Turn the emergency key element anti-clockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the emergency key element clockwise.
The door is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 79).
X
To deactivate: press and hold button : for
approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
If you press one of the two buttons and do not
hear a tone, the relevant setting has already
been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are turning.
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe vehicle is being pushed
Rthe vehicle is being towed
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer
You can also activate and deactivate the automatic locking function using the on-board computer (Y page 211).
X
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with the
key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to unlock
and open the driver's door, the anti-theft alarm
system will be triggered (Y page 73).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the boot lid.
X Press the locking button on the driver’s door
(Y page 84).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors are
still visible. Press the locking knobs down by
hand if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Z
Opening and closing
Automatic locking feature
Boot
86
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
Opening and closing
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Turn the emergency key element clockwise as
far as it will go to position 1.
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the emergency key element anti-clockwise.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid are
locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 79).
X
i If you lock the vehicle as described above,
the fuel filler flap is not locked. The anti-theft
alarm system is not primed.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 333).
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 268).
Do not leave the key in the boot. If you do so, you
could lock yourself out.
The boot lid can be:
Ropened and closed manually from outside
Ropened automatically from outside
Ropened automatically from inside
Remergency released from the inside.
Opening/closing from outside
Opening
Boot
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk
of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid. Never drive with the boot lid
open.
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Press the % button on the key.
Pull handle :.
X Raise the boot lid.
X
X
Boot
Closing
87
ensure that you only make a leg movement
within the detection range of sensors.
of KEYLESS-GO, the following situations, for
example, could lead to the boot lid opening
unintentionally:
Rusing a car wash
Rusing a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 3 m away
from the vehicle.
i You can also deactivate KEYLESS-GO. FurPull down the boot lid using handle :.
X Let the boot lid drop into the lock.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the &
button on the key or with KEYLESS-GO.
X
Opening automatically from outside
General notes
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
i The opening dimensions of the boot lid can
be found under "Vehicle data" (Y page 333).
Opening automatically
You can open the boot lid automatically using
the key or the handle in the boot lid.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
or
X If the boot lid is unlocked, pull the boot lid
handle and release it again immediately.
ther information on deactivating and activating KEYLESS-GO (Y page 77).
General notes
With KEYLESS-GO and HANDS-FREE ACCESS,
you can open the boot lid without using your
hands. This is useful if you have your hands full.
To do this, make a kicking movement under the
bumper with your foot.
Observe the following points:
RCarry your KEYLESS-GO key with you. The key
must be in the KEYLESS-GO detection range
to the rear of the vehicle.
RWhen making the kicking movement, make
sure that you are standing firmly on the
ground and that there is sufficient clearance
to the rear of the vehicle. You could otherwise
lose your balance, e.g. on ice.
HANDS-FREE ACCESS
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The vehicle exhaust system can become very
hot. If you use HANDS-FREE ACCESS, you
could burn yourself by touching the exhaust
system. There is a risk of injury. Always
RAlways
ensure that you only make a kicking
movement within the detection range of sensors :.
RStand at least 30 cm away from the rear area
while doing so.
RDo not come into contact with the bumper
while making the kicking movement. Otherwise, the sensors may not function correctly.
Z
Opening and closing
! If the key is within the rear detection range
Boot
88
Opening and closing
RHANDS-FREE ACCESS does not function dur-
ing engine start.
RDirt caused by road salt around sensors :
may restrict functionality.
Using HANDS-FREE ACCESS with a prosthetic leg may restrict functionality.
RIf a KEYLESS-GO key is in the KEYLESS-GO
detection range to the rear of the vehicle,
HANDS-FREE ACCESS could be triggered.
The boot lid could thus be opened unintentionally, for example, when you:
- fold the ball coupling in or out
- couple or uncouple a trailer
- fit or remove a rear-mounted bicycle rack
- load/unload bicycles on/from a rearmounted bicycle rack
- set down or lift up an object behind the
vehicle
- polish the rear of the vehicle
Do not carry the KEYLESS-GO key with you in
such situations. This will prevent the unintentional opening of the boot lid.
Opening automatically from inside
General notes
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found under "Vehicle data" (Y page 333).
Opening
You can open the boot lid from the driver's seat
when the vehicle is stationary and unlocked.
Operation
X
To open: pull remote operating switch : for
the boot lid until the boot lid opens.
Boot emergency release
General notes
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
X
To open: kick into sensor detection range :
below the bumper with your foot.
If the boot lid does not open after several
attempts: wait at least ten seconds then kick
under the bumper once again.
If you hold your foot under the bumper for too
long, the boot lid does not open. Repeat the
kicking movement more quickly if this occurs.
X
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 333).
If the boot lid can no longer be unlocked:
Rusing the key, or
Rusing the remote operating switch in the door
control panel:
Use the emergency release on the inside of the
boot lid.
You can reach the emergency release via the
boot.
Side windows
Opening
89
Activate the override feature for the rear side
windows. When leaving the vehicle, always
take the key with you and lock the vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Fold the rear seat backrest forwards
(Y page 271).
X Insert a suitable tool ;, e.g. a screwdriver,
into opening : in the cover.
The boot lid is released.
X Open the boot lid.
X
Side windows
The side windows are equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If a solid object blocks
or restricts a side window from travelling
upwards during the automatic closing process,
the side window opens again automatically. During the manual closing process, the side window
only opens again automatically after the corresponding switch is released. The automatic
reversing feature is only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing a side window.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Important safety notes
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
G WARNING
Rwhile
While opening the side windows, body parts
could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window
moves. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or
pull the switch to close the side window again.
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
gers
resetting
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing, make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
Opening and closing the side windows
The switches for all side windows are located on
the driver's door. There is also a switch on each
door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
G WARNING
If children operate the side windows they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
Z
Opening and closing
Side window reversing feature
Side windows
Opening and closing
90
:
;
=
?
Front left
Front right
Rear right
Rear left
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding button.
X To open fully: press the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close manually: pull the corresponding
button and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation: press/
pull the corresponding switch again.
i If you press/pull the switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling again.
X
i You can continue to operate the side win-
dows after switching off the engine or removing the key. This function remains active for
five minutes or until the driver's or frontpassenger door is opened.
i The side windows cannot be operated from
the rear when the override feature for the side
windows is activated (Y page 65).
Convenience opening feature
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, the KEYLESSGO start function, Exclusive package or
AMG Exclusive package: you can ventilate the
vehicle before you start driving.
The key can also be used to carry out the following functions simultaneously:
Runlock the vehicle
Ropen the side windows
Ropen the panorama sliding sunroof and the
roller sunblind
The convenience opening feature can only be
operated using the key.
The "Convenience opening" feature is also available when the vehicle is unlocked.
X Vehicles with Exclusive package or AMG
Exclusive package but without KEYLESSGO and the KEYLESS-GO start function: for
the following operations, point the tip of the
key at the door handle on the driver's door.
The key must be close to the driver's door
handle.
i Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESS-GO start function: the key must be in
close proximity to the vehicle.
X Press and hold the % button until the side
windows and the panorama sunroof are in the
desired position.
If the roller sunblind of the panorama sliding
sunroof is closed, the roller sunblind is
opened first.
X Press and hold the % button once more
until the panorama sliding sunroof reaches
the desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening: release
the % button.
Convenience closing feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
Side windows
91
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, the KEYLESSGO start function, Exclusive package or
AMG Exclusive package: at the same time you
can:
Rlock the vehicle
Rclose the side windows
Rclose the panorama sliding sunroof
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof,
you can then close the roller sunblind.
for:
Rthe
side windows (Y page 89)
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof
(Y page 93)
Rthe roller sunblind (Y page 94)
Using the key
Vehicles with Exclusive package or AMG
Exclusive package but without KEYLESSGO and the KEYLESS-GO start function: for
the following operations, point the tip of the
key at the door handle on the driver's door.
The key must be close to the driver's door
handle.
i Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESS-GO start function: the key must be in
close proximity to the vehicle.
X Press and hold the & button until the side
windows and the panorama sliding sunroof
are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
X
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
X Press and hold the & button again until the
roller sunblind of the panorama sliding sunroof closes.
X
To interrupt convenience closing: release
the & button.
Using KEYLESS-GO
The driver's door and the door at which the handle is used must both be closed. The key must be
outside the vehicle. The gap between the key
and the corresponding door handle should not
be greater than 1 m.
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are fully closed.
i Make sure you touch only recessed sensor
surface :.
X
Make sure that all the side windows are
closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
X
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
X Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle again until the roller sunblind of
the panorama sliding sunroof closes.
X
To interrupt convenience closing: release
recessed sensor surface : on the door handle.
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 89).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch on
the door control panel until the side window is
completely closed (Y page 89).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released, the
X
Z
Opening and closing
i Notes on the automatic reversing function
92
Panorama sliding sunroof
side window has been reset correctly. If this is
not the case, repeat the steps above again.
Problems with the side windows
Opening and closing
G WARNING
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot be
closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
X
X
Remove the objects.
Close the side window.
A side window cannot be If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
closed and you cannot
slightly:
see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding switch
again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens again
slightly:
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding switch
again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the automatic reversing feature.
Panorama sliding sunroof
If somebody becomes trapped:
Important safety notes
Rrelease
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
G WARNING
While opening and closing the sliding sunroof,
body parts in close proximity could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that no body parts are in close
proximity during the opening and closing procedures.
the switch immediately, or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening or closing procedure will be stopped.
Rduring
G WARNING
If children operate the sliding sunroof they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Panorama sliding sunroof
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof if it
is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could be
damaged.
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
Rpress the switch in any direction during the
automatic closing process
The closing process is stopped.
Operating the panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
i Resonance noises can occur in addition to
the usual airflow noises when the sliding sunroof is open. They are caused by minor pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Change the position of the sliding sunroof or
open a side window slightly to reduce or eliminate these noises.
Reversing feature of the sliding sunroof
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
The sliding sunroof is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the sliding sunroof during the closing
process, the sliding sunroof opens again automatically. The automatic reversing feature is,
however, only an aid and is no substitute for your
attention when closing the sliding roof.
G WARNING
The reversing feature does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Rduring
resetting
Rwhen closing the sliding sunroof again man-
ually immediately after automatic reversing
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
The panorama sliding sunroof can only be operated when the roller sunblind is open.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
If you press/pull the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop
automatic operation by pressing/pulling again.
After opening the sliding sunroof, the roller sunblind automatically closes slightly. This reduces
drafts in the vehicle interior.
If the sliding sunroof is raised at the rear, it
automatically lowers slightly at higher speeds.
The noise level in the vehicle interior is reduced
as a result.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
At high speeds the raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers slightly at the rear. This could
trap you or other persons. There is a risk of
injury. Make sure that nobody reaches into
the sweep of the sliding sunroof whilst the
vehicle is in motion.
If somebody becomes trapped, immediately
pull back the sliding sunroof switch. The sliding sunroof lifts during opening.
93
Opening and closing
94
Panorama sliding sunroof
At low speeds it raises again automatically.
You can also temporarily deactivate automatic
lowering. To do so, press the 3 switch. The
sliding sunroof raises again automatically.
You can continue to operate the sliding sunroof
after switching off the engine or removing the
key. This function remains active for five
minutes or until you open a front door.
The sliding sunroof cannot be opened if a roof
carrier is fitted. In order to allow ventilation of
the vehicle interior, you can raise the sliding
sunroof.
If contact is made with a roof carrier approved
by Mercedes-Benz, the sliding sunroof lowers
slightly but remains raised at the rear.
Rain-closing feature when the engine is
switched off
The rain-closing feature is only available for vehicles with a rain sensor.
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition lock
or is removed, the panorama sliding sunroof
closes automatically:
Rif it starts to rain
Rat extreme outside temperatures
Rafter six hours
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply
The panorama sliding sunroof remains raised at
the rear in order to allow ventilation of the vehicle interior.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed
when being closed by the rain-closing feature, it
opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature is
then deactivated.
The panorama sliding sunroof does not close if:
Rit is raised at the rear.
Rit is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen
being monitored by the rain sensor. If, for
example, the vehicle is under a bridge or in a
carport, the field of the sensor may be covered.
Rain-closing feature when driving
The raised panorama sliding sunroof automatically lowers when driving if it starts to rain. The
sliding sunroof is lowered depending on:
Rthe road speed and
Rthe intensity of the rain
You can manually cancel the automatic closing
procedure. Press or pull the 3 switch in any
direction.
To raise the panorama sliding sunroof again,
press the 3 button in direction :. The rainclosing feature remains activated.
Operating the roller sunblind for the
panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped
between the roller sunblind and frame or sliding sunroof during automatic opening or closing. There is a risk of injury.
When opening or closing, make sure that no
body parts are in the sweep of the roller sunblind.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
Rpress the switch in any direction during the
automatic opening/closing process
The opening/closing process is stopped.
The roller sunblind shields the vehicle interior
from sunlight. The roller sunblind can only be
opened and closed when the panorama sliding
sunroof is closed.
Roller sunblind reversing feature
The roller sunblind is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the roller sunblind during the closing
process, the roller sunblind opens again automatically. The automatic reversing feature is,
however, only an aid and is no substitute for your
attention when closing the roller sunblind.
G WARNING
The reversing feature does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rwhen closing the roller sunblind again man-
ually immediately after automatic reversing
Panorama sliding sunroof
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing the roller sunblind, make sure
that no body parts are in the sweep.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
95
Resetting the panorama sliding sunroof
or the roller sunblind
the switch immediately or
automatic closing process
The closing process is stopped.
Opening and closing
: To open
; To open
= To close
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
If you press/pull the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop
automatic operation by pressing/pulling again.
After opening the panorama sliding sunroof, the
roller sunblind automatically closes slightly. This
reduces drafts in the vehicle interior.
X
Reset the panorama sliding sunroof or the roller
sunblind if the panorama sliding sunroof or the
roller sunblind does not move smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point of
resistance in the direction of arrow : until
the panorama sliding sunroof is fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional
second.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point of
resistance in the direction of arrow : until
the roller sunblind is fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional
second.
X Make sure that the panorama sliding sunroof
and the roller sunblind can be fully opened
and closed again.
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps above
again.
Problems with the panorama sliding sunroof
G WARNING
If you do not reset the sliding sunroof after a malfunction or voltage supply interruption, then the
reversing function will malfunction or not work. The sliding sunroof closes with increased or
maximum force. Parts of the body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses
an increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Z
Opening and closing
Rpress the switch in any direction during the
96
Panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
In such or similar situations always make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
Always reset the sliding sunroof after a malfunction or voltage supply interruption.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The panorama sliding
sunroof cannot be
closed and you cannot
see the cause.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and
reopens again slightly:
X Immediately after it blocks, pull the 3 switch down again to the
point of resistance until the panorama sliding sunroof is closed.
The panorama sliding sunroof is closed with more force.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and
reopens again slightly:
X Immediately after it blocks, pull the 3 switch down again to the
point of resistance until the panorama sliding sunroof is closed.
The panorama sliding sunroof is closed without the automatic
reversing feature.
Seats
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Ryou have a good overview of traffic conditions
Rthe seat belt is pulled snugly against the body
and must be routed across the centre of your
shoulder and across your hips in the pelvic
area
Further related subjects:
RAdjusting the seats manually (Y page 98)
RAdjusting the seats electrically
(Y page 99)
RAdjusting the steering wheel manually
(Y page 102)
RFastening the seat belt correctly
(Y page 43)
RAdjusting the rear-view mirror and exterior
mirrors (Y page 103)
RVehicles with a memory function: save the
seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror settings using the memory function
(Y page 106)
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Observe the following when adjusting steering
wheel :, seat belt ; and driver's seat =:
Ryou are as far away from the driver's airbag as
possible
are sitting in an upright position
Ryour thighs are slightly supported by the seat
cushion
Ryour legs are not entirely stretched and you
can depress the pedals properly
Rthe back of your head is supported at eye level
by the centre of the head restraint
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
Ryou can move your legs freely
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument
cluster clearly
Ryou
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The seats can still be adjusted when there is no
key in the ignition lock.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
Observe the safety notes on "Airbags"
(Y page 44) and "Children in the Vehicle"
(Y page 54).
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Correct driver's seat position
97
98
Seats
G WARNING
If the driver's seat is not correctly engaged, it
could unexpectedly move while driving. This
could cause you to lose control of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always ensure that the driver's seat is
engaged before starting the vehicle.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo not spill any liquids on the seats. If liquid
is spilled on the seats, dry them as soon as
possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat heating should also not be used to dry the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the seats.
Do not place sharp objects on the seat
cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools. The
seats should only be occupied by passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers,
child seats or booster seats.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when moving the seats back. There is a risk that the
seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
i Further related subjects:
RLuggage
compartment enlargement (folding down the rear seats) (Y page 271)
Adjusting the seats manually
Vehicles without the seating comfort
package
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment:
X Lift handle : and slide the seat forwards or
backwards.
X Release lever : again.
Ensure that the seat engages audibly.
Backrest angle:
X Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
X Turn handwheel = forwards or backwards.
Seat height:
X Pull handle ; upwards or push it down
repeatedly until the seat has reached the
desired height.
Seats
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment:
X Lift handle : and slide the seat forwards or
rearwards.
X Release lever : again.
Ensure that the seat engages audibly.
Backrest angle:
X Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
X Turn handwheel A forwards or backwards.
Seat height:
X Pull handle ? upwards or push it down
repeatedly until the seat has reached the
desired height.
Seat cushion angle:
X Adjust the angle so that your thighs have gentle support.
X Turn handwheel = forwards or backwards.
Seat cushion length:
X Lift handle ; and slide the front part of the
seat cushion forwards or backwards.
X Release lever ; again.
The seat cushion engages.
Adjusting the seats electrically
:
;
=
?
Seat height
Seat cushion angle
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Backrest angle
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 106).
Adjusting the head restraints
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Vehicles with the seating comfort package
99
Seats
100
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position
so that it is as close as possible to the back of
your head.
General notes
For vehicles with sports seats you cannot adjust
the front head restraints or the outer rear head
restraints.
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the head restraint height
This function allows you to adjust the distance
between the head restraint and the back of the
head.
X To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards in the direction of the arrow until it
engages.
There are a number of detents.
X To move backwards: press and hold release
button : and push the head restraint backwards.
X When the head restraint is in the desired position, release the button and make sure that
the head restraint is engaged in position.
Rear seat head restraints
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
height
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the direction of the arrow and push the head restraint
down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the head restraint fore-and-aft
position
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired height.
X To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
X
Removing and fitting the rear seat head
restraints
The rear head restraints on the outer seats can
be removed and refitted. For vehicles with
sports seats the rear head restraints cannot be
removed and refitted.
Seats
101
AMG Performance Seat
Vehicles with electrically adjustable seats: to
adjust the contour of the seat and for improved
lateral support, you can individually adjust the
front seats.
Fold the seat backrest slightly forwards in
order to remove the head restraint
(Y page 271).
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to the
stop.
X Press release button : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that the
notches on the bar are on the left-hand side
when viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear it
engage in position.
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum support for your back.
Adjusting the side bolsters of the seat cushion
X To set the side bolsters of the seat cushion narrower: press button :.
X To set the side bolsters of the seat cushion wider: press button ;.
Adjusting the side bolsters of the seat backrest
X To set the side bolsters of the seat backrest narrower: press button =.
X To set the side bolsters of the seat backrest wider: press button ?.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Switching on/off
:
;
=
?
Raises the backrest contour
Softens the backrest contour
Lowers the backrest contour
Hardens the backrest contour
G WARNING
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
102
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The system automatically switches down from
level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten
minutes.
The system automatically switches off approximately 20 minutes after it is set to level 1.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
The three red indicator lamps in the button indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches down from
level 3 to level 2 after approximately eight
minutes.
i If the vehicle battery voltage is too low, the
seat heating may switch off.
Problems with the seat heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The seat heating has
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumswitched off prematurely ers are switched on.
or cannot be switched
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as the
on.
rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat heating will switch
back on automatically.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Adjusting the steering wheel
Radjust
G WARNING
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped by the steering wheel if they adjust it. There is a risk of
injury.
The steering wheel may move unexpectedly if
you adjust it while driving. This could cause
you to lose control of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Make sure that the steering wheel is locked
before driving off. Never unlock the steering
wheel when the vehicle is in motion.
Mirrors
103
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position (fore-
and-aft adjustment)
X Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired position.
X Push release lever : up as far as it will go.
The steering column is locked.
X Check that the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering wheel
up or down or try to move it in the fore-and-aft
direction.
Mirrors
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
Rear-view mirror
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Exterior mirror on the front-passenger side:
press button ;.
Exterior mirror on the driver's side: press button :.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after some
time. You can adjust the selected exterior
X
X
Anti-dazzle mode: pivot anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Radjust
Mirrors
104
mirror using button = as long as the indicator
lamp is lit.
X Press button = up, down, or to the right or
left until you have adjusted the exterior mirror
to the correct position. You should have a
good overview of traffic conditions.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger field
of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior
mirrors are automatically heated at low outside
temperatures. Heating takes a maximum of ten
minutes.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i The exterior mirrors can also be heated
manually by switching on the rear window
heating.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Briefly press button :.
X
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function is
activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 213):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door
i If the exterior mirrors have been folded in
manually, they do not fold out.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. Otherwise, they could vibrate.
i If you are driving faster than 47 km/h, you
can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must be
reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise not
fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when
locking" function in the on-board computer
(Y page 213).
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position (forwards or backwards), proceed as
follows:
X Vehicles without electrically folding exterior mirrors: manually move the exterior mirror into the correct position.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior
mirrors: press and hold mirror-folding button
(Y page 104) until you hear a click and the
mirror engages audibly into position.
The mirror housing is engaged again and you
can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 103).
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
G WARNING
Electrolyte may escape if the glass of an automatic anti-dazzle mirror breaks. Electrolyte is
harmful and causes irritation. It must not
come into contact with your skin, eyes, respiratory organs or clothing or be swallowed.
There is a risk of injury.
Mirrors
105
If you come into contact with electrolyte,
observe the following:
Rimmediately
The "Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors" function is
only available if the vehicle is equipped with the
"Mirror package".
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror on
the driver's side automatically go into anti-dazzle mode if:
Rthe ignition is switched on and
Rincident light from headlamps strikes the sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not dip if reverse gear is engaged
or if the interior lighting is switched on.
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
Setting and storing the parking position
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror such that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driver's
side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the front-
passenger side
= Button for the exterior mirror setting
? Memory button M
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Press button ;.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the default parking position.
X Use button = to adjust the exterior mirror to
a position that allows you to see the rear
wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another position, the front-passenger side exterior mirror
returns to the driving position.
X
X
Calling up a stored parking position
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Adjust the front-passenger side exterior mirror using the corresponding button
(Y page 103).
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side
moves back to its original position:
Ras soon as you exceed a speed of 15 km/h
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged
reverse gear
Rwhen you use button : to select the exterior
mirror on the driver's side
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
rinse off electrolyte from your
skin with water.
Rimmediately and thoroughly rinse electrolyte out of eyes using clean water.
Rif electrolyte is swallowed, immediately
rinse out your mouth thoroughly. Do not
induce vomiting.
Rif electrolyte comes into contact with skin
or eyes or is swallowed, seek medical attention immediately.
Rimmediately change out of clothing that has
been in contact with electrolyte.
Rif an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
106
Memory function
Memory function
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
If the memory function adjusts the seat, you
and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any part of
their body within the sweep of the seat. If
someone becomes trapped, immediately
release the memory function position button.
The adjustment is stopped.
G WARNING
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The memory function can be used at any time,
e.g. even when the key is not in the ignition lock.
Storing settings
Using the memory function, you can store up to
three different settings, e.g. for three different
people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rseat and backrest position
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors
on the driver's and front-passenger sides
Adjust the seat (Y page 99).
Adjust the exterior mirror on the driver's side
(Y page 103).
X Briefly press the M memory button and then
press preset position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected memory position. A tone sounds when the settings
have been completed.
X
X
Calling up a stored setting
X
Press and hold the relevant preset position
button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat and exterior
mirrors are in the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as soon
as you release the storage position button.
Exterior lighting
Exterior lighting
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
General notes
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, controlled
Driving abroad
Symmetrical dipped beam
It is not necessary to switch your headlamps to
symmetrical dipped beam when driving in countries where vehicles are driven on the opposite
side of the road to the country in which the vehicle is registered. Legal requirements are fulfilled
without switching the headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam.
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set using the:
Rlight switch
Rcombination switch (Y page 109)
Rheadlamp range adjustment (only vehicles
with halogen headlamps) (Y page 108)
Ron-board computer (Y page 211)
Light switch
Operation
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
ment cluster lighting
by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
B R Rear foglamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X Turn the light switch to the à position.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps or
parking lamps) switches off automatically if you:
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
Ropen the driver's door with the key in position 0 in the ignition lock
Automatic headlamp mode
à is the preferred light switch position. The
light setting is automatically selected according
to the brightness of the ambient light (exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions
such as fog, snow or spray):
RKey in position 1 in the ignition lock: the side
lamps are switched on or off automatically
depending on light conditions.
RWith the engine running: depending on the
ambient light conditions, the daytime driving
lights or the side lamps and dipped-beam
headlamps are switched on or off automatically
X To switch on automatic headlamp mode:
turn the light switch to the à position.
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an aid.
The driver is responsible for the vehicle lighting
at all times.
The daytime driving lights improve the visibility
of your vehicle during the day.
If the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps
are switched on, the green indicator lamps T
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched on
even during the daytime. In some countries,
operation of the headlamps varies due to legal
requirements and self-imposed obligations.
107
108
Exterior lighting
(side lamps) and L (dipped-beam headlamps) in the instrument cluster light up.
Dipped-beam headlamps
Lights and windscreen wipers
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in the L position, the side lamps
and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous
when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps:
turn the key in the ignition lock to position 2
or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp on the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that the
corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key
should not be in the ignition lock or it should
be in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side of
the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of the
vehicle).
Adjusting the headlamp range (halogen
headlamps)
Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of your
vehicle in heavy fog for the following traffic.
Please observe the country-specific laws on the
use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the key
in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the
engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp:press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
i When the rear foglamp is switched on, the
centre brake lamp in the tail lamp switches off
due to a legal requirement.
Side lamps
! When the battery is discharged heavily, the
side lamps or parking lamps are automatically
switched off to facilitate an engine start.
Always park your vehicle safely and in a well lit
area, in accordance with the relevant legal
stipulations. Avoid using the T side lamps
for periods lasting several hours. Where possible, switch on the right X or left W
parking lamp.
X To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
g Driver's seat and front-passenger seat
occupied
1 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and rear
seats occupied
2 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and rear
seats occupied, luggage compartment
laden
3 Driver's and front-passenger seat occupied
and maximum permissible rear axle load utilised, e.g. when towing a trailer
The headlamp range controller allows you to
adjust the cone of light from the headlamps to
suit the vehicle load.
X Start the engine.
X Turn the headlamp range controller to the
position that corresponds to the load in your
vehicle.
Exterior lighting
To indicate briefly:press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction of
arrow ; or ?.
X To switch on the main-beam headlamps:
turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The main-beam headlamps only switch on in
the à position if the dipped-beam headlamps are on.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps:
move the combination switch back to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Vehicles with Adaptive Highbeam Assist:
when Adaptive Highbeam Assist is active, it
controls activation and deactivation of the
main-beam headlamps (Y page 109).
X To switch on the headlamp flasher: pull the
combination switch in the direction of
arrow =.
X
Hazard warning lamps
To switch on the hazard warning
lamps:press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch, only
the turn signal lamp on the corresponding
side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning
lamps:press button :.
X
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
Ran airbag has been triggered or
Rthe vehicle decelerates rapidly from a speed
of above 70 km/h and comes to a standstill
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of above
10 km/h again after a full brake application.
The hazard warning lamps continue to operate
even if the ignition is switched off.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
General notes
You can use this function to set the headlamps
to switch automatically between dipped beam
and main beam. The system recognises vehicles
with their lights on, either approaching from the
opposite direction or travelling in front of your
vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main beam to dipped beam. Once
the system no longer detects any other vehicles,
it switches on the main-beam headlamps again.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Combination switch
109
Interior lighting
110
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not recognise
road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
On very rare occasions, Adaptive Highbeam
Assist may fail to recognise other road users
that have lights, or may recognise them too
late. In this, or in similar situations, the automatic main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated or will be activated despite the presence of other road users. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Rwho
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You are
responsible for adjusting the vehicle's lighting
to the prevailing light, visibility and traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can be
restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
Rdirt on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
If you are driving at speeds below 25 km/h or
other road users are recognised or the roads
are adequately lit:
the main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically The K indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To deactivate:move the combination switch
back to its normal position.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction
display goes out.
Headlamps misted up on the inside
Certain climatic and physical conditions may
cause moisture to form in the headlamp. This
moisture does not affect the functionality of the
headlamp.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Front overhead control panel
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
on/off
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction
display lights up when it is dark and the light
sensor switches on the dipped-beam headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 30 km/h and no other road users are
recognised:
The main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster also lights up.
X
: p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on or off
; c Switches the front interior lighting on
= v Switches the rear interior lighting on/
off
? | Switches the front interior lighting/
automatic interior lighting control off
A p Switches the right-hand front reading
lamp on or off
B Switches the automatic interior lighting con-
trol on
Replacing bulbs
Rear compartment control panel
111
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes
: p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
; p Switches the right-hand reading lamp
on/off
Interior lighting control
General notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
The colour and brightness for the ambient lighting may be set via the multimedia system (see
the separate operating instructions).
Automatic interior lighting control
To switch on: set the switch to centre position B.
X To switch off: set the switch to the |
position.
The interior lighting automatically switches on if
you:
Runlock the vehicle
Ropen a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior lighting is activated for a short time
when the key is removed from the ignition lock.
This delayed switch-off can be adjusted via the
multimedia system (see separate Owner's Manual).
X
Do not use a bulb if it has been dropped or if its
glass tube has been scratched.
The bulb may explode if:
Ryou touch it
Rit is hot
Ryou drop it
Ryou scratch it
Use bulbs only in closed lamps that have been
designed for this purpose. Fit only spare bulbs of
the same type and the specified voltage.
Marks on the glass tube reduce the service life
of the bulb. Do not touch the glass tube with
your bare hands. If necessary, clean the glass
tube when cold with alcohol or spirit and rub it
off with a lint-free cloth.
Protect bulbs from moisture during operation.
Do not allow bulbs to come into contact with
liquids.
Replace only the bulbs listed (Y page 112).
Have the bulbs that you cannot change yourself
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance replacing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the new bulb does not light up either, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Headlamps and lamps are an important aspect
of vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times. Have
the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Vehicles with LED headlamps: the light clusters of your vehicle are equipped with LED light
bulbs. Do not replace your vehicle's bulbs yourself. Contact a qualified specialist workshop
with the necessary specialist knowledge and
tools to carry out the work required.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
G WARNING
Bulbs, lamps and plug connectors can
become very hot during use. When replacing a
bulb, you could burn yourself on these components. There is a risk of injury.
Allow these components to cool down before
replacing the bulb.
112
Replacing bulbs
Overview of bulb types
Lights and windscreen wipers
You can replace the following bulbs. The details
for the bulb types can be found in the legend.
Vehicles with halogen headlamps
: Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W
; Main-beam headlamp/daytime driving
lamp/side lamp/parking lamp: H15 55 W/
15 W
= Dipped-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
Replacing front bulbs
Fitting/removing the cover on the front
wheel arch
You must remove the cover in the front wheel
arch before you can change the front turn signal
lamp.
X To remove: switch off the lights.
X Turn the front wheels inwards.
X Turn rotary knob : through 90°.
Cover ; is released.
X Push cover ; down.
X To fit:push cover ; up.
X Turn rotary knob : through 90°.
Cover ; is locked.
Dipped-beam headlamps (halogen
headlamps)
Tail lamps (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
: Rear foglamp: P 21 W
; Brake lamp: W 16 W
= Brake lamp: W 16 W
? Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W
A Reversing lamp: W 16 W
Remove the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 112).
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
out.
X Pull the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X
Replacing bulbs
X
Main-beam headlamps/daytime driving
lights/side lamps and parking lamps
(vehicles with halogen headlamps)
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
out.
X Insert the new bulb and engage it to the stop.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X
X
Turn signal lamp (halogen headlamps)
Turn the bulb anti-clockwise and pull it out of
bulb holder :.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder :.
X Insert bulb holder : and turn it clockwise
until it engages.
X
Replacing rear bulbs
Opening and closing the side trim panels
View of right-hand side trim panel
You must open the side trim panel in the boot
before you can replace the bulbs in the tail
lamps.
X To open: release right or left side trim
panel : at the top and fold it down in the
direction of the arrow.
X To close: insert side panel :.
Tail lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 113).
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn bulb holder : anticlockwise and pull
out.
X
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
Insert bulb holder ; and turn it clockwise.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X Replace the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 112).
X
113
Windscreen wipers
114
Lights and windscreen wipers
Press retaining clips : at the same time in
the direction of the arrows.
X Carefully remove the bulb holder together
with the connected plug and the bulbs.
X
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
Bulb holder
; Brake lamp
= Brake lamp
? Rear fog lamp
A Reversing light
B Turn signal
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor set
Brake lamp and reversing lamp: remove
the corresponding bulb from the bulb holder.
X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder.
X Rear foglamp and turn signal: press the
bulb gently into the bulb holder, turn it anticlockwise and remove it from the bulb holder.
X
Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and
turn it clockwise.
X Reinsert the bulb holder and engage on
retaining clips :.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 113).
X
Windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers when
the windscreen is dry, as this could damage
the wiper blades. Moreover, dust that has collected on the windscreen can scratch the
glass if wiping takes place when the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen
wipers in dry weather conditions, always
operate them using washer fluid.
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may be
due to wax or other residue. Clean the windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic
car wash.
to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î wipes the wind-
screen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 133).
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
! Vehicles with a rain sensor: if the wind-
screen becomes dirty in dry weather conditions, the windscreen wipers may be activated inadvertently. This could damage the
windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch off
the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or Å
position, the appropriate wiping frequency is
automatically set according to the intensity of
the rain. In the Å position, the rain sensor is
more sensitive than in the Ä position, causing the windscreen wiper to wipe more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen will
no longer be wiped properly. This could mean
you are unable to observe the traffic conditions.
Windscreen wipers
115
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without a
wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release the
windscreen wiper arm without a wiper blade
and it falls onto the windscreen, the windscreen may be damaged by the force of the
impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESSGO start function: switch off the engine.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
X
Hold on to the wiper arm with one hand. With
the other hand, turn the wiper blade in the
direction of arrow : away from the wiper arm
as far as it will go.
X Slide catch ; in the direction of arrow =
until it engages in the removal position with a
noticeable click.
X
X
Remove the wiper blade in the direction of
arrow ? away from the wiper arm.
Fitting the wiper blades
X
Insert the new wiper blade into the wiper arm
in the direction of arrow :.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
Windscreen wipers
116
Slide catch ; in the direction of arrow =
until it engages in the locking position with a
noticeable click.
X Make sure that the wiper blade sits correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Remove protective film : of the service indicator on the tip of the wiper blade.
If the colour of the service indicator changes
from black to yellow, the wiper blades should be
replaced.
X
i The duration of the colour change varies
depending on the usage conditions.
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The windscreen wipers
are jammed.
Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing windscreen wiper
movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers
fail completely.
The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The windscreen washer The spray nozzles are misaligned.
fluid from the spray noz- X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist workshop.
zles no longer hits the
centre of the windscreen.
Overview of climate control systems
General notes
Observe the settings recommended on the following pages. Otherwise, the windows could
mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch off climate control only briefly
Ractivate air-recirculation mode only briefly
Rswitch on "Cooling with air dehumidification"
Ractivate the "Windscreen demisting" function
briefly, if required
The air-conditioning system or THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control regulates the temperature and the humidity of the vehicle interior and
filters undesirable substances from the air.
The air-conditioning system or THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control can only be operated
when the engine is running. Optimum operation
is only achieved with the side windows and panorama sliding sunroof closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated
or deactivated with the ignition switched off
(Y page 126).
Always keep the ventilation flaps behind the
side panelling clear (Y page 113). Otherwise the
vehicle will not be ventilated correctly.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period during
warm weather, e.g. using the convenience
opening feature (Y page 90). This will speed
up the cooling process and the desired interior temperature will be reached more
quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most parti-
cles of dust and soot and completely filters
out pollen. With THERMOTRONIC automatic
climate control, gaseous pollutants and
odours will also be reduced. A clogged filter
reduces the amount of air supplied to the
vehicle interior. For this reason, you should
always observe the interval for replacing the
filter, which is specified in the Service Booklet. As this depends on environmental conditions, e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may
be shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
i Vehicles with auxiliary heating: Under
certain environmental conditions, the residual heat function may be activated automatically an hour after the ignition key has been
removed in order to dry the automatic climate
control. The blue LED on the rocker switch in
the centre console lights up when the active
function to dry the automatic climate control
is on. The vehicle is then ventilated for
30 minutes.
Vehicles without auxiliary heating: Under
certain environmental conditions, the residual heat function may be activated automatically an hour after the ignition key has been
removed in order to dry the automatic climate
control. The vehicle is then ventilated for
30 minutes.
Climate control
Overview of climate control systems
117
118
Overview of climate control systems
Climate control
Control panel for air-conditioning system
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
To set the temperature (Y page 122)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 123)
To set the air distribution (Y page 122)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 124)
To set the airflow (Y page 123)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 121)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 124)
Notes on using the air-conditioning
system
Air-conditioning system
Below, you can find a number of tips and recommendations for optimum use of the air-conditioning system.
RSwitch on the air-conditioning system by turning control knob A clockwise to the desired
position (except position 0).
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
RRecommendation for avoiding misted
windows at low exterior temperatures or
in rain: switch on the ¿ cooling with dehumidification function (Y page 121).
Set air distribution to ¯ and if possible
switch off P and O (Y page 122).
Deactivate air-recirculation mode e
(Y page 124).
Set airflow control A to a setting between 3
and 6 (Y page 123).
RRecommendation
for rapid cooling or
heating of the vehicle interior: briefly set
airflow control A to a setting between 3 and
6 (Y page 123).
RRecommendation for a constant vehicle
interior temperature: set airflow control A
to a setting between 1 and 3 (Y page 123).
RRecommendation for air distribution in
winter: select the O and ¯ settings
(Y page 122).
Recommendation for air distribution in
summer: select the P or P and ¯
settings (Y page 122).
RUse the "Windscreen demisting" function only
briefly until the windscreen is clear again.
RUse air-recirculation mode only briefly, e.g. if
there are unpleasant outside odours or when
in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist
up as no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle in
air-recirculation mode.
RIf you change the settings of the climate control system, the climate status display
appears for approximately three seconds at
Overview of climate control systems
DYNAMIC SELECT button (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
You can choose between various drive programs
with the DYNAMIC SELECT button
(Y page 141).
If you have selected drive program E:
Depending on the configuration, the climate settings can also be influenced in drive program I.
If you have selected drive program C or S, the
climate settings are not affected.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate
control operates only at a reduced capacity. If
you require the full climate control output, you
can switch off the ECO start/stop function by
pressing the ECO button (Y page 138).
Rwhen heating, the electrical heater booster is
deactivated and in the warming-up phase
heat output is reduced
Rthe rear window heating running time is
reduced
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
To set the temperature, left (Y page 122)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 121)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 123)
To increase the airflow (Y page 123)
To set the air distribution (Y page 122)
Display
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 124)
To switch the climate control on/off (Y page 120)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 122)
To switch the residual heat on/off (Y page 126)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 121)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 123)
Climate control
the bottom of the screen in the multimedia
system display (see separate operating
instructions). You will see the current settings
of the various climate control functions.
119
120
Operating the climate control system
I To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 124)
J To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 123)
Climate control
Information on using THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most out of
your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the
à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
RUse the "Windscreen demisting" function only
briefly until the windscreen is clear again.
RUse air-recirculation mode only briefly, e.g. if
there are unpleasant outside odours or when
in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist
up as no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle in
air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for the
front-passenger side as well. The indicator
lamp in the á button goes out.
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when the
ignition is switched off. The residual heat
function can be activated or deactivated only
with the ignition switched off.
RIf you change the settings of the climate control system, the climate status display
appears for approximately three seconds at
the bottom of the screen in the multimedia
system display (see separate operating
instructions). You will see the current settings
of the various climate control functions.
DYNAMIC SELECT button (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
You can choose between various drive programs
with the DYNAMIC SELECT button
(Y page 141).
If you have selected drive program E:
Rwhen heating, the electrical heater booster is
deactivated and in the warming-up phase
heat output is reduced
Rthe rear window heating running time is
reduced
Depending on the configuration, the climate settings can also be influenced in drive program I.
If you have selected drive program C or S, the
climate settings are not affected.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate
control operates only at a reduced capacity. If
you require the full climate control output, you
can switch off the ECO start/stop function by
pressing the ECO button (Y page 138).
Operating the climate control system
Switching the climate control on/off
General notes
When climate control is switched off, the air
supply and air circulation are also switched off.
The windows could mist up. Therefore, switch
off climate control only briefly.
Air-conditioning system
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To switch on: turn control A clockwise to
the desired position (except position 0)
(Y page 118).
X To switch off: turn control A anti-clockwise
to position 0 (Y page 118).
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
i THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control:
switch on climate control primarily using the
à button.
Activating/deactivating cooling with
dehumidification
not be cooled during warm weather. The air
inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified.
The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore, only deactivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function briefly.
The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
is available only when the engine is running. The
air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified
according to the temperature selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This is
normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Activating/deactivating
X
Press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up or goes out.
The indicator lamp in the button indicates that
the respective function is activated. The cooling with air dehumidification function has a
delayed switch-off feature.
General notes
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in the The cooling with air dehumidification function has been deactivated
¿ button flashes
due to a malfunction.
three times or remains
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
off. The cooling with air
dehumidification function cannot be activated.
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
Only THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control features the "Control climate control automatically" function.
In automatic mode, the set temperature is maintained automatically at a constant level. The
system automatically regulates the temperature
of the dispensed air, the airflow and the air distribution.
The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
is activated automatically in automatic mode.
121
Climate control
Operating the climate control system
Operating the climate control system
122
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow are
activated.
X To switch to manual mode: press the É
or Ë button.
or
X Press the K or I button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic air distribution and airflow are
deactivated.
Climate control
X
Setting the air distribution
Air-conditioning system
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister
vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell
air vents
i You can also activate several of the air dis-
tribution settings simultaneously. In order to
do this, press several of the air distribution
buttons. The air is then routed through different air vents.
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side air
vents. The side air vents can only be closed if
the adjusters are turned clockwise until they
engage.
Setting the temperature
Air-conditioning system
You can set the temperature for the entire vehicle. The set temperature is automatically maintained at a constant level.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To increase or reduce: turn control : anticlockwise or clockwise (Y page 118). Change
the temperature setting only in small increments. Start at 22 †.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Different temperatures can be set for the driver's and front-passenger sides. The set temperature is automatically maintained at a constant
level.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To increase or decrease: turn control : or
E anti-clockwise or clockwise (Y page 119).
Change the temperature setting only in small
increments. Start at 22 †.
Setting the air distribution
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Press one or more of the P, O, ¯
buttons.
The corresponding indicator lamp comes on.
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister
vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell
air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell
air vents
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister
vents
a Directs the airflow through the footwell
and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister
vents, the centre and side air vents as
well as the footwell air vents
Operating the climate control system
airflow is always directed through the side air
vents. The side air vents can only be closed if
the adjusters are turned clockwise until they
engage.
Setting the air distribution
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Press the É or Ë button repeatedly
until the desired symbol appears in the display.
X
Setting the airflow
Air-conditioning system
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To increase or reduce: turn control A anticlockwise or clockwise (Y page 118).
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To increase or reduce:press the K or
I button.
X
Switching the ZONE function on/off
This function is only available with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
X To activate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up.
The temperature setting for the driver's side
is not adopted for the front-passenger side.
X
To deactivate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
The temperature setting for the driver's side
is adopted for the front-passenger side.
Demisting the windscreen
General notes
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen
and the side windows.
i You should only select the "Windscreen
demisting" function until the windscreen is
clear again.
Switching the "Windscreen demisting"
function on or off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
Rhigh airflow
Rhigh temperature
Rair distribution to the windscreen and front
side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
i The "Windscreen demisting" function automatically sets the blower output to the optimum demisting effect. As a result, the airflow
may increase or decrease automatically after
the ¬ button is pressed.
X
i You can adjust the blower output manually
while the "Windscreen demisting" function is
in operation:
RAir-conditioning system: turn airflow control A anti-clockwise or clockwise
(Y page 118).
RTHERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: press the ó or ô button.
X To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
X THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control:
press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
Climate control
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
123
Operating the climate control system
124
or
Climate control
X
Air-conditioning system: turn temperature
control : anti-clockwise or clockwise
(Y page 118).
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control:
turn temperature control : or E anti-clockwise or clockwise (Y page 119).
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Air-conditioning system
Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until the
windscreen is clear again.
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until the
windscreen is clear again.
X
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Set the air distribution to P or O.
i You should only select this setting until the
windscreen is clear again.
X
X
Rear window heating
General notes
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as soon
as the window is clear. The rear window heating
otherwise switches off automatically after several minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window
heating may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
X
Problems with the rear window heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating The battery has not been sufficiently charged.
has switched off prema- X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading lamps,
turely or cannot be
interior lighting or the seat heating.
switched on.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating
can be switched on again.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
General notes
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air temporarily if unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
If you activate air-recirculation mode, the windows can mist up more quickly, particularly at
low temperatures. Use air-recirculation mode
only briefly to prevent the windows from misting
up.
The operation of air-recirculation mode is the
same for all control panels.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X To activate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up.
Air-recirculation mode is activated automatically:
Rat high outside temperatures
Rat high levels of pollution
When air-recirculation mode is activated automatically, the indicator lamp in the e button
is not lit. Outside air is added after about
30 minutes.
X To deactivate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out.
X
i Air-recirculation mode is deactivated auto-
matically:
Rafter approximately five minutes at outside
temperatures below approximately 7 †
Rafter approximately five minutes if the
"Cooling with air dehumidification" function is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside
temperatures above approximately 7 † if
the cooling with air dehumidification function is activated
Convenience opening or closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, immediately press
the W switch in the door to stop the movement of the side windows. To continue closing
the side window, pull on the W switch.
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the e button until the side windows
start to close automatically.
Vehicles with panorama sliding sunroof:
the sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof closes simultaneously.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
If parts of the body are in the closing area during
convenience closing, proceed as follows:
X Press the W button to stop the side windows.
The side windows stop.
X To then open the side window, press the W
button again.
or
X Press and hold the e button again for at
least two seconds.
The side windows move in the opposite direction.
X Only vehicles with panorama sliding sunroof: press the 3 switch to stop the panorama sliding sunroof.
The panorama sliding sunroof stops.
X To then open the panorama sliding sunroof,
pull back on the 3 switch.
i Observe the notes on the automatic reversing feature for:
Rthe side windows (Y page 89)
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof (Y page 93)
X Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the e button until the side windows
start to open automatically.
Vehicles with panorama sliding sunroof:
the panorama sliding sunroof opens simultaneously.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows or the panorama sliding sunroof manually after closing
Z
125
Climate control
Operating the climate control system
Operating the climate control system
126
with the convenience closing feature, they
will remain in this position when opened using
the convenience opening feature.
Climate control
Switching the residual heat on/off
General notes
The residual heat function is only available with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat of
the engine to continue heating the vehicle for
approximately 30 minutes after the engine has
been switched off. The heating time depends on
the set interior temperature.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless
of the airflow setting.
i If you switch on the residual heat function at
high temperatures, only the ventilation will be
activated. The blower runs at medium speed.
i You cannot use the ventilation to cool the
vehicle interior to a temperature lower than
the outside temperature.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock
or remove it (Y page 133).
X Press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up or goes out.
The indicator lamp in the button indicates that
the respective function is activated.
X
i Residual heat is switched off automatically:
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
Rwhen the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rwhen the auxiliary heating is switched on
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially car-
bon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rthe
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
The auxiliary heating and the exhaust gas outlet
are situated in front of the right-hand front
wheel.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventilation
draws on the vehicle battery. After you have
heated or ventilated the vehicle a maximum of
two times, drive for a longer distance.
Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly once a
month for about ten minutes.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates
the switch-on time according to the outside
temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by
the departure time. When the departure time is
reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat
for a further five minutes and then switches off.
Operating the climate control system
Before switching on
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Set the desired temperature.
Auxiliary heating or ventilation can also be
switched on if the manually set climate control is
activated. Optimum comfort is attained by setting the system to automatic mode. Set the temperature to 22 †.
The auxiliary heating or auxiliary ventilation can
be switched on/off using the button on the
centre console or the remote control.
The on-board computer can be used to specify
up to three departure times, one of which may
be preselected (Y page 211).
X
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on or off using the button on the
centre console
General notes
Climate control
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle
interior to the set temperature. This occurs without using the heat of the running engine. The
auxiliary heating is operated directly using the
vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the fuel tank must
be at least Õ full to ensure that the auxiliary
heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically
adjusts to changes in temperature and weather
conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating
could switch from ventilation mode to heating
mode or from heating mode to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off when the
engine is switched off. The auxiliary ventilation
switches off when you turn the key to key position 2 (Y page 133).
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically
after 50 minutes.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to cool
the vehicle interior to a temperature lower than
the outside temperature.
127
The colours of the indicator lamps on button :
signify the following:
RBlue: auxiliary ventilation activated
RRed: auxiliary heating activated
RYellow: departure time preselected
(Y page 211)
Activating/deactivating the auxiliary
heating or auxiliary ventilation
X
Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
lights up or goes out.
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on or off using the remote control
General notes
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls for
your vehicle. For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Store the remote control for the auxiliary heating so that the auxiliary heating cannot be
switched on unintentionally. In particular,
ensure that the remote control for the auxiliary
heating is kept out of the reach of children.
The remote control has a range of approximately
300 metres. This range is reduced by:
Rsources of radio interference
Rsolid objects between the remote control and
the vehicle
Z
Operating the climate control system
128
Climate control
Rthe
remote control being in an unfavourable
position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
If the remote control battery is low, the battery
symbol on the left of the display is shown as
empty. Replace the remote control battery and
observe the important safety notes when doing
so (Y page 129).
Activating/deactivating the auxiliary
heating or auxiliary ventilation
The auxiliary ventilation is
activated. The number on
the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
The auxiliary heating is
activated. The number on
the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
A departure time has been
activated. The departure
time appears on the display.
Remote control
: Display
; u Switches the auxiliary heating or aux-
iliary ventilation on
Checks the status
= . Sets the departure time
? ^ Switches the auxiliary heating or auxiliary ventilation off
A , Sets the departure time
To switch on: press and hold the u button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
X To switch off: press and hold the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating or auxiliary ventilation
X
Briefly press the u button.
The following messages may appear on the display:
Display
Meaning
The auxiliary heating or
auxiliary ventilation is
deactivated.
A departure time has been
activated. The auxiliary
ventilation is currently
activated. The number on
the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation. If the vehicle is
not started after this time,
the running time is
increased by five minutes.
A departure time has been
activated. The auxiliary
heating is currently activated. The number on the
display shows the remaining time (in minutes) for
the auxiliary heating. If the
vehicle is not started after
this time, the running time
is increased by five
minutes.
If the engine has not yet reached operating temperature when it is started, the auxiliary heating
running time is increased. The auxiliary heating
continues to run until the operating temperature
is reached. If this is the case, the y symbol
appears in the remote control display and the
running time is zero minutes.
Setting the departure time
Make sure that the time set in the vehicle is
correct before setting the departure time (see
the separate operating instructions). Otherwise,
the auxiliary heating may activate at the wrong
Operating the climate control system
Activating the set departure time
Briefly press the u button.
Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol, the departure time and,
depending on the selected departure time,
the letter A, B or C appear in the display.
X
X
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Climate control
time and at an unsuitable location. When setting
the departure time, observe the important
safety notes (Y page 126).
X Briefly press the u button.
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons at the same
time.
The Î symbol in the remote control display
flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or . button, the faster the time changes.
X Press the u and ^ buttons at the same
time.
The new departure time is stored.
Replacing the battery
Deactivating the set departure time
Briefly press the u button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown on
the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears on the
display.
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Replacing the remote control battery
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
129
A CR2450 lithium battery is required when
replacing the battery.
X Press a pointed object into recess :.
X Slide battery cover ; backwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Insert new battery = with the lettering facing
upwards.
X Slide battery cover ; in the opposite direction to the arrow on the remote control until it
engages.
Z
130
Air vents
Climate control
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
FAIL¨
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle is
faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating/ventilation on
or off using the remote control.
FAIL
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself off.
The starter battery is not sufficiently charged.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating/ventilation
using the remote control.
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself off.
The fuel tank content is below the reserve fuel level.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using the
remote control.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation cannot be switched on or has
switched itself off.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation is malfunctioning.
X Have the auxiliary heating/ventilation checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep the air inlet between the windscreen and
the bonnet free of blockages, such as ice,
snow or leaves
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles in
the vehicle interior
i Optimal climate control function is achieved
by opening the air vents fully and setting the
adjusters to the middle position.
Air vents
131
Climate control
Adjusting the air vents
: Side window demister vent
; Side air vent
To open a side air vent: turn the adjuster in
side air vent ; to the left.
X To close a side air vent: turn the adjuster in
side air vent ; clockwise as far as it will go.
X
i The centre and rear air vents are adjusted in
the same way.
Z
Driving and parking
132
Driving
Running-in notes
Driving
Important safety notes
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems, the
sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle has been
delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end of this teach-in
process.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either new
or have been replaced only achieve optimum
braking effect after several hundred kilometres
of driving. Compensate for the reduced braking
effect by applying greater force to the brake
pedal.
The first 1500 km
The more you treat the engine with sufficient
care at the start, the more satisfied you will be
with the engine performance later on.
RDrive at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red area
of the rev counter.
RDo not shift down a gear manually in order to
brake.
RVehicles with automatic transmission: try
to avoid depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
Additional notes on running in Mercedes-AMG
vehicles:
Rfor the first 1,500 km do not drive at speeds
above 140 km/h.
Ronly allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4,500 rpm briefly.
After 1,500 km, you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
You should also observe these notes on runningin if the engine or parts of the drive train on your
vehicle have been replaced.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Rshoes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
Rlose
Driving
is stationary. Drive off immediately. Avoid
high engine speeds and driving at full throttle
until the engine has reached its operating
temperature.
Only shift the automatic transmission to the
desired drive position when the vehicle is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery roads.
You could otherwise damage the drive train.
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles: avoid full-load
operation and engine speeds greater than
5000 rpm when the engine is cold. This will
help to protect the engine and maintain
smooth engine operation.
Key positions
Key
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such as
the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the vehicle
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
steering is locked when the key is taken out of
the ignition lock.
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on. The
engine cannot be started.
Start/Stop button
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
keys featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
A check that periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle.
This occurs, for example, when the engine is
started.
When you insert the Start/Stop button in the
ignition lock, the system needs approximately
two seconds of recognition time. You can then
use the Start/Stop button.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times in
succession corresponds to the different key
positions in the ignition lock. Pre-requisite for
this is that:
Ryou do not depress the brake pedal (vehicles
with automatic transmission)
Ryou do not depress the clutch pedal (vehicles
with manual transmission)
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately (vehicles with automatic transmission).
If you depress the clutch pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately (vehicles with manual transmission).
To start the vehicle without actively using the
key:
Rthe Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock
Rthe key must be in the vehicle
Rthe vehicle must not be locked with the key or
KEYLESS-GO (Y page 77)
Do not keep the KEYLESS-GO key:
Rwith electronic devices, e.g. a mobile phone
or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal foil
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the functionality of KEYLESS-GO.
If you lock the vehicle with the key's remote
control or with KEYLESS-GO, after a short time:
Ryou will no longer be able to switch on the
ignition with the Start/Stop button
Ryou will no longer be able to start the engine
with the Start/Stop button until the vehicle is
unlocked again
Z
Driving and parking
! Do not warm up the engine when the vehicle
133
134
Driving
Driving and parking
If you lock the vehicle centrally using the button
on the front door (Y page 84), you can continue
to start the engine with the Start/Stop button.
You can switch off the engine while the vehicle is
in motion by pressing and holding the Start/
Stop button for around three seconds. This function operates independently of the ECO start/
stop automatic engine switch-off function.
Key positions with the Start/Stop button
Removing the Start/Stop button
You can remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal
using the key.
You can only switch between Start/Stop button
mode and key operation when the vehicle is stationary.
You must also engage park position P (vehicles
with automatic transmission).
X Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
You do not have to remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock when you leave the
vehicle. You should, however, always take the
key with you when leaving the vehicle. As long as
the key is in the vehicle:
Rthe vehicle can be started using the Start/
Stop button
Rthe electrically powered equipment can be
operated
: Start/Stop button
; Ignition lock
When you switch on the ignition, all of the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light up.
For further information on situations in which an
indicator lamp either fails to go out after the
engine is started or lights up while driving,
please refer to "Warning and indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster" (Y page 249).
If Start/Stop button : has not yet been
pressed, this corresponds to the key being
removed from the ignition.
X To switch on the power supply: press
Start/Stop button : once.
The power supply is switched on. You can now
activate the windscreen wipers, for example.
The power supply is switched off again if:
Rthe driver's door is opened and
Ryou press Start/Stop button : twice when in
this position
X To switch on the ignition: press Start/Stop
button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
If you press Start/Stop button : once when
in this position, the ignition is deactivated
again.
Starting the vehicle
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
Starting procedure using the key
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
To start the engine using the key instead of the
Start/Stop button, pull the Start/Stop button
out of the ignition lock.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 133).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X Turn the key to position 3 (Y page 133) in the
ignition lock and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
G WARNING
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
General notes
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the engine runs
at a higher engine speed during the cold start
procedure so that the catalytic converter can
reach operating temperature more quickly. The
sound of the engine may change as a result.
Manual transmission
You can only start the engine when the clutch
pedal is fully depressed.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Shift to neutral N.
Automatic transmission
X
Shift the transmission to position
P (Y page 144).
The transmission position indicator in the
multifunction display shows P (Y page 144).
i You can start the engine in transmission
position P and N.
Starting procedure using the Start/
Stop button
The Start/Stop button can be used to start the
vehicle manually without inserting the key in the
ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle and
the Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock. This mode for starting the engine
manually operates independently of the ECO
start/stop automatic engine start function.
You can start the engine if a valid key is in the
vehicle. Switch off the engine and always take
the key with you when leaving the vehicle, even
if you only leave it for a short time. Pay attention
to the important safety notes.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Press the Start/Stop button once
(Y page 133).
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the engine
starts.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: preglow is
activated and the engine starts.
Pulling away
General notes
G WARNING
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
If the engine speed is above the engine idling
speed and you then engage transmission
Z
135
Driving and parking
Driving
136
Driving
Driving and parking
position D or R, the vehicle may accelerate
suddenly. There is a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always keep the brake pedal firmly depressed
and do not depress the accelerator pedal at
the same time.
Pulling away with a trailer
! Vehicles with manual transmission:
change gear in good time and avoid spinning
the wheels. You could otherwise damage the
vehicle.
Depress the accelerator carefully when pulling
away.
The vehicle automatically locks centrally once
you have pulled away. The locking knobs in the
doors drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at any
time.
You can also deactivate the automatic door
locking system (Y page 211).
Vehicles with automatic transmission: it is
only possible to shift the transmission from position P to the desired position if you depress the
brake pedal. Only then can the parking lock be
deactivated.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): if you do not depress the brake pedal, the
DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved but the
parking lock remains engaged.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: if you do not depress
the brake pedal, the selector lever can still be
moved but the parking lock remains engaged.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: at
transmission fluid temperatures below Ò20 †,
you can only shift out of position P into another
transmission position when the engine is running.
i Vehicles with automatic transmission:
upshifts take place at higher engine speeds
after a cold start. This helps the catalytic converter to reach its operating temperature
more quickly.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: information on automatically releasing the electric
parking brake (Y page 158).
To ensure that you do not roll backwards when
pulling away on an uphill slope, apply the electric
parking brake.
X Press and hold handle :.
The electric parking brake continues to brake
and prevents the vehicle from rolling backwards.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster remains lit.
X Depress the accelerator pedal.
X As soon as the vehicle/trailer combination is
held by the driving force of the engine, release
handle :.
The electric parking brake is released
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Further information on the electric parking
brake (Y page 157).
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It holds
the vehicle for a short time after you have
removed your foot from the brake pedal. This
gives you enough time to move your foot from
the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal and
depress it before the vehicle begins to roll.
G WARNING
After a while, hill start assist no longer holds
the vehicle and it may roll away. There is a risk
of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Driving
ECO start/stop function
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped
under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts automatically. The ECO start/stop function thereby
helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and
emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
the engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 138) or a malfunction
has caused the system to be deactivated, the
è or ç ECO symbol is not displayed.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop
function is only available in drive program C.
Automatic engine switch-off
General notes
The ECO start/stop function is operational and
the è ECO symbol is displayed on the multifunction display if:
Rthe indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe system does not detect moisture on the
windscreen when the air-conditioning system
is switched on
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If all conditions for automatic engine switch-off
are not fulfilled, the ç ECO symbol is shown.
All the vehicle's systems remain active when the
engine is switched off automatically.
The engine can be switched off automatically a
maximum of four times (initial stop, then three
subsequent stops) in succession. The ç ECO
symbol is shown on the multifunction display
after the engine has been started automatically
for the fourth time. When the è ECO symbol
is shown on the multifunction display, automatic
engine switch-off is possible again.
Vehicles with manual transmission
: ECO start/stop display
The ECO start/stop function is activated whenever you start the engine using the key or the
Start/Stop button.
If the è symbol is shown on the multifunction
display, the ECO start/stop function switches
Z
Driving and parking
Hill start assist is not active if:
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, the
transmission is in position N
Rthe electric parking brake is applied
RESP® is malfunctioning
Further information on holding the vehicle stationary on uphill gradients (Y page 148).
Ryou
137
Driving and parking
138
Driving
The ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically at low speeds.
X Brake the vehicle.
X Shift to neutral N (Y page 142), (follow gearshift instructions : to shift into neutral N, if
necessary).
X Release the clutch pedal.
The engine is switched off automatically.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill with the
transmission in D or N, the ECO start/stop function switches off the engine automatically.
The HOLD function can be activated if the
engine has been switched off automatically. It is
then not necessary to continue applying the
brakes during the automatic stop phase. When
you depress the accelerator pedal, the engine
starts automatically and the braking effect of
the HOLD function is deactivated.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rrelease the brake pedal in transmission position D or N when the HOLD function is not
active
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
Rmove the transmission out of position P
Shifting the transmission to position P does not
start the engine.
If you shift the transmission from R to D, the
ECO start/stop function is available again as
soon as the è symbol reappears on the multifunction display.
Switching the ECO start/stop function
off/on
Automatic engine start
General notes
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou deactivate the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
Vehicles with manual transmission
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rdepress the clutch pedal fully
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
X
To deactivate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the è or ç ECO
symbol on the multifunction display go out.
To activate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
If all conditions for the automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 137) are fulfilled, the è
ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display.
If all conditions for the automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 137) are not fulfilled, the
ç ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO start/
stop function is not available.
If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/stop
function has been deactivated manually or as
the result of a malfunction. The engine will then
not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
X
Driving
You can choose between different AMG Performance exhaust system volumes using the
position of the exhaust flap.
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected setting is activated when the engine is next started. If the ignition is switched off for more than four hours, the
quietest setting is activated when the engine is
next started.
Setting the volume:
X Press button :.
If you select the loudest setting, indicator
lamp ; lights up.
Driving and parking
AMG performance exhaust system
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
139
Problems with the engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 172) or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC (Y page 171).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
is turning audibly.
RThe
engine electronics are malfunctioning.
fuel supply is malfunctioning.
Before attempting to start the engine again:
X Turn the key back to position 0 in the ignition lock.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until all indicator lamps on
the instrument cluster go out.
X Start the engine again (Y page 134). Avoid excessively long and
frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain the battery.
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
RThe
Z
140
Driving
Problem
Driving and parking
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
is turning audibly. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
is not turning audibly.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The fuel tank is empty.
Refuel the vehicle.
X
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 301).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to excessively high thermal load.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a petrol
The engine electronics or a mechanical component of the engine
engine:
management system are/is malfunctioning.
The engine is not running X Depress the accelerator pedal only slightly.
smoothly and is misfirOtherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter
ing.
and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
The coolant temperature The coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine is not
display is showing more being cooled sufficiently.
than 120 †. The coolant X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
warning lamp may also
cool down.
be on and a warning tone
X Check the coolant level (Y page 283). Observe the warning notes
may sound.
as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty. The
coolant is too hot and the engine is not being cooled sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue driving
to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Mercedes-AMG vehicles) 141
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to change the
drive program. Depending on the drive program
selected, the following vehicle characteristics
will change:
RThe drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension (vehicles with adjustable
damping or AMG RIDE CONTROL)
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe climate control
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
drive program C is activated when the engine is
next started.
Press DYNAMIC SELECT controller : as
many times as necessary until the desired
drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds the
display goes out and the status icon of the
selected drive program appears.
In addition, the current drive program settings
are shown briefly on the display of the multimedia system.
i In a few countries, the ECO start/stop function is deactivated at the factory due to the
quality of the available fuel. In this case, the
ECO start/stop function is not available in any
drive program, regardless of what is shown on
the multimedia system display.
X
Available drive programs:
C Comfort
Comfortable and economical driving characteristics
S Sport
Sporty driving characteristics
I Individual
Individual settings
E Economy
Particularly economical
driving characteristics
Additional information on drive programs
(Y page 148).
You can also change gear yourself using the
steering wheel gearshift paddles. Further information on manual gearshifting (Y page 150).
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT controller to change
the drive program. Depending on the drive program selected, the following vehicle characteristics will change:
Rthe drive
Rthe transmission management
RESP®
Rthe suspension (vehicles with AMG RIDE
CONTROL)
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe availability of gliding mode
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
drive program C is activated when the engine is
next started.
Z
Driving and parking
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles
except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Manual transmission
142
you must shift into gear 1, 2 or 3 in good time.
This uses the engine's braking effect. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
Turn DYNAMIC SELECT controller : as many
times as necessary until the desired drive
program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds the
display goes out and the status icon of the
selected drive program appears.
The drive program indicator on DYNAMIC
SELECT controller : lights up in red.
Available drive programs:
Driving and parking
X
I Individual
Individual settings
C Comfort
Comfort-orientated, engine
and transmission settings
optimised for economy
S Sport
Sporty engine and transmission settings
S+ Sport Plus
Particularly sporty transmission settings
RACE
Maximum sportiness and
engine and transmission
settings suitable for the
racetrack
k
Reverse gear
1 - 6 Forward gears
Shifting to neutral N
Additional information on drive programs
(Y page 148).
You can also change gear yourself using the
steering wheel gearshift paddles. Further information on manual gearshifting (Y page 150).
Manual transmission
Gear lever
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
X
X
Depress the clutch pedal fully.
Shift the gear lever to position N :.
depressed.
! When shifting to 5th and 6th gear, you must
press the shift lever to the right. Otherwise,
you could shift unintentionally into 3rd or 4th
gear and damage the engine or transmission.
If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine to
overrev, leading to engine damage.
Do not use the clutch bite point to keep the
vehicle stationary on uphill gradients. There is
otherwise a risk of damaging the clutch.
! On long and steep downhill gradients, espe-
cially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer,
Engaging reverse gear
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the vehi-
cle is stationary. Otherwise, you could damage the transmission.
X Pull the gear lever up, push it to the left and
then pull it back.
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. For further information on the ECO start/stop function, see
(Y page 137).
Automatic transmission
The gearshift recommendation assists you in
adopting a fuel-efficient driving style. The recommended gear is shown on the multifunction
display.
X Shift gear according to gearshift recommendation : when shown in the multifunction
display of the instrument cluster.
Drive programs
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle has improved driving stability, e.g.
on slippery road surfaces.
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rsporty engine settings.
Drive program I (Individual)
Drive program E (Economy)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle has improved driving stability, e.g.
on slippery road surfaces.
Rthe performance of the air-conditioning and
heating systems is reduced.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
In drive program I, the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension (vehicles with adjustable
damping)
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe climate control
Information on configuring drive program I with
the multimedia system can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Z
Driving and parking
Gearshift recommendation
143
144
Automatic transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
away carefully to check whether the desired
transmission position is engaged. Ideally, you
should select transmission position D and drive
program E or S.
Engaging park position P
Driving and parking
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): the DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of
the steering column.
For information on the selector lever in
Mercedes-AMG vehicles (Y page 146).
The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns to its
original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears on the transmission
position readout on the multifunction display
(Y page 144).
j
k
i
h
Transmission position and drive program display
The current transmission position and drive program appear on the multifunction display.
the automatic transmission directly from D to
R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise, the
automatic transmission could be damaged.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction
of arrow P.
Transmission position display P is shown in
the multifunction display.
When you have engaged park position P, make
sure that the transmission position display
shows P in the multifunction display.
You can only engage park position P when the
vehicle is stationary.
Depressing the brake and pushing the DIRECT
SELECT lever up or down disengages the parking lock. The transmission is in neutral N.
At transmission fluid temperatures below
Ò20 †, you can only shift out of park position P
into another transmission position when the
engine is running.
In order to shift from park position P directly into
R or D:
Rdepress
the brake pedal and
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
past the first point of resistance
Rpush
Engaging park position P automatically
Park position P is automatically engaged if:
Ryou
: Transmission position
; Gear
= Drive program display
The arrows in the transmission position display
show how and into which transmission positions
you can shift using the DIRECT SELECT lever.
If the transmission position display on the multifunction display is not working, you should pull
switch off the engine using the key and
remove the key
Ryou switch off the engine using the key or
using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door or front-passenger door
Ryou open the driver's door when the vehicle is
stationary or when driving at a very low speed
and the transmission is in position D or R
Under certain conditions, the automatic transmission shifts automatically to transmission
position P if the HOLD function or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is activated. Observe the information on the HOLD function (Y page 173) and on
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 170).
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. Further information on the ECO start/stop function
(Y page 137).
X
Shifting to neutral N
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
from the ignition, the automatic transmission
shifts to P automatically.
With the Start/Stop button: if you then open
the driver's door or the front-passenger door,
the automatic transmission shifts to P automatically.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the vehicle
cleaned in an automatic car wash with a towing
system:
X Vehicles with the Start-Stop button:
remove the Start-Stop button from the ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X All vehicles: switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Engage neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in the
ignition lock.
Engaging drive position D
If the transmission is in position R or N: push
the DIRECT SELECT lever down past the first
point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT SELECT
lever down past the first point of resistance.
X
If the transmission is in position D or R: push
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down to the
first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT SELECT
lever up or down to the first point of resistance.
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open the driver's door
or the front-passenger door or remove the key
X
Z
145
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
146
Automatic transmission
Selector lever (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Engaging park position P
Driving and parking
Overview of transmission positions
X
j
k
i
h
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
Transmission position and drive program display
The current transmission position and drive program appear on the multifunction display.
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
If the transmission position display on the multifunction display is not working, you should pull
away carefully to check whether the desired
transmission position is engaged. Ideally, you
should select transmission position D and drive
program C or S.
When the vehicle is stationary, press button :.
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Push the selector lever forwards past the first
point of resistance.
B
C
Park position
This safeguards the vehicle against
rolling away when stopped.
Only shift the transmission into position P when the vehicle is stationary.
The parking lock should not be used
as a brake when parking. In order to
secure the vehicle, always apply the
electric parking brake in addition to
the parking lock.
In the event of a malfunction of the
vehicle's electronics, the transmission may lock in position P. Have the
vehicle electronics checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Park position P is automatically
engaged if:
Ryou switch off the engine using the
key and remove the key
Ryou switch off the engine using the
key or using the Start/Stop button
and open the driver's door or frontpassenger door
Ryou open the driver's door when
the vehicle is stationary or when
driving at a very low speed and the
transmission is in position D or R
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission into position R when the vehicle is stationary.
A
147
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you to
move the vehicle freely, e.g. to push
it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty: shift
the transmission to position N if the
vehicle is in danger of skidding, e.g.
on icy roads.
If you switch the engine off with the
transmission in position R or D, the
automatic transmission shifts to N
automatically.
Driving and parking
Transmission positions
Automatic transmission
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
7
Drive
The automatic transmission changes
gear automatically. All forward gears
are available.
Driving tips
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined
by:
Rthe selected drive program
Rthe position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Accelerator pedal position
Your driving style influences how the automatic
transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle throttle: early upshifts
Rmore throttle: late upshifts
Z
148
Automatic transmission
Holding the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients
Driving and parking
G WARNING
If the clutch overheats, the electronic management system is automatically deactivated.
This interrupts the power transmission. The
vehicle may, for example, roll backwards on
gradients. There is a risk of an accident.
Never hold the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients by depressing the accelerator.
For further information on kickdown in manual
drive program M (Y page 152).
Towing a trailer
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models.
For further information, see (Y page 196).
X Drive in the middle of the engine speed range
on uphill gradients.
X Depending on the uphill or downhill gradient,
select a lower gear (Y page 160), even if
cruise control, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or
the speed limiter are activated.
The clutch may overheat if you hold the vehicle
stationary on uphill gradients by depressing the
accelerator pedal. If the clutch overheats, a
warning tone sounds.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): the Stop vehicle Shift to P Leave
engine running display message appears in
the multifunction display. You will only be able to
continue your journey once the clutch has
cooled down and the display message in the
multifunction display has disappeared.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the Trans. oil
overheated Drive on with care display
message appears in the multifunction display.
Do not hold the vehicle stationary on uphill gradients by depressing the accelerator pedal.
Instead, only ever hold the vehicle stationary on
uphill gradients by:
Rdepressing the brake pedal
Ractivating the HOLD function
Rapplying the electric parking brake
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle has improved driving stability, e.g.
on slippery road surfaces.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the
automatic transmission shifting up sooner.
The vehicle is driven in the low engine speed
range and the wheels are less likely to spin.
Kickdown
Drive program S (Sport)
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration:
X Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The automatic transmission shifts to a lower
gear depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: it is only possible to
use kickdown in the automatic drive programs
and in temporary manual drive program M.
When manual drive program M is selected permanently, kickdown is not possible.
Drive programs
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG
vehicles)
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rsporty engine settings.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later.
Fuel consumption may be higher as a result of
the later automatic transmission shift points.
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I, the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension (vehicles with adjustable
damping or AMG RIDE CONTROL)
Rthe steering
Automatic transmission
climate control
Information on configuring drive program I with
the multimedia system can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
i To permanently shift the gears manually in
drive program I using the steering wheel gearshift paddles, select the M (Manual) setting
for the drive.
Drive program E (Economy)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented engine settings.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the
automatic transmission shifting up sooner.
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle has improved driving stability, e.g.
on slippery road surfaces.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up sooner.
This results in the vehicle being driven at
lower engine speeds and the wheels being
less likely to spin.
Rgliding mode is activated automatically when
engine-internal conditions are fulfilled and
the accelerator is not depressed. At the same
time the transmission’s clutch opens and the
vehicle rolls freely using its kinetic energy. As
a result great distances can be completed
without the engine brake and fuel consumption reduced.
i The availability of gliding mode depends on
various factors, including the following:
Rthe engine and transmission temperature
Rthe downhill gradient
Rthe vehicle speed
Rperforming regular adaptation functions
When you depress the brake pedal, gliding
mode is deactivated, depending on pedal
pressure.
When you activate cruise control or Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC, gliding mode is not available.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I, the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe drive (engine management)
Rthe transmission management
Rthe suspension (vehicles with AMG RIDE
CONTROL)
RESP®
Information on configuring drive program I with
the multimedia system can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle has improved driving stability, e.g.
on slippery road surfaces.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the
automatic transmission shifting up sooner.
The vehicle is driven in the low engine speed
range and the wheels are less likely to spin.
Rgliding mode is available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is available.
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits sporty driving characteristics.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later.
Fuel consumption may be higher as a result of
the later automatic transmission shift points.
Rthe suspension exhibits stiff springing and
damping settings (vehicles with AIR RIDE
CONTROL).
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
Z
Driving and parking
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe
149
150
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
Drive program S+ (Sport Plus)
Drive program S+ is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly sporty driving
characteristics.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later.
Rfuel consumption may be higher as a result of
the later automatic transmission shift points.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly stiff
springing and damping settings (vehicles with
AIR RIDE CONTROL).
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
Drive program RACE (vehicles with AMG
RIDE CONTROL)
Drive program RACE is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits driving characteristics
suitable for the racetrack.
Rall vehicle systems are set for maximum
sportiness.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later.
Rfuel consumption may be higher as a result of
the later automatic transmission shift points.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly rigid
springing and damping settings.
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
Manual gearshifting
General notes
You can shift gears yourself using the steering
wheel gearshift paddles. The transmission must
be in position D to do this.
Depending on which steering wheel gearshift
paddle is pulled, the automatic transmission
immediately shifts into the next gear up or
down, if permitted.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: to use manual shifting, you have two options:
Rtemporary setting
Rpermanent setting
If you activate manual gearshifting, the multifunction display will show the current gear
instead of transmission position D.
If manual gearshifting is deactivated, the gears
will be selected automatically.
Temporary setting
To activate: shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to
position D.
X Pull steering wheel gearshift paddle : or ;.
X
The temporary setting will remain active for a
certain amount of time. Under certain conditions, the minimum amount of time is extended,
e.g. in the case of lateral acceleration, during an
overrun phase or when driving on steep terrain.
X To deactivate: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle ; and hold it in place.
or
X Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to shift the
transmission position.
or
X All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles):
use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to change
the drive program.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: use the DYNAMIC
SELECT controller to change the drive program.
Permanent setting (Mercedes-AMG
vehicles)
To activate: shift the selector lever to position D.
X Press button :.
X
X
or
X
To deactivate: press button :.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): if the maximum engine speed in the
currently engaged gear is reached and you
continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission automatically shifts up in order to
prevent engine damage.
X To shift down: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle :.
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
Automatic downshifting occurs when coasting.
If the engine exceeds the maximum engine
speed when shifting down, the automatic
transmission protects against engine damage
by not shifting down.
Gearshift recommendation
If position D (automatic transmission) is
selected for the transmission in drive program I: shift to drive program I with the
DYNAMIC SELECT controller.
Shifting gears
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the automatic
transmission does not shift up automatically
even when the engine limiting speed for the
current gear is reached. When the engine limiting speed is reached, the fuel supply is cut to
prevent the engine from overrevving. Always
make sure that the engine speed does not
reach the red area of the rev counter. There is
otherwise a risk of engine damage.
The gearshift recommendation assists you in
adopting a fuel-efficient driving style. The recommended gear is shown on the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according to
gearshift recommendation : when shown in
the multifunction display.
Upshifting (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
! The automatic transmission does not shift
up automatically even when the engine limiting speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. Always make sure that the
engine speed does not reach the red area of
the rev counter. There is otherwise a risk of
engine damage.
X
To shift up: pull steering wheel gearshift paddle ;.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
Z
151
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
Refuelling
Driving and parking
152
Before the engine speed reaches the red area,
an upshift indicator will be shown on the multifunction display.
X Shift to recommended gear : when message ; is shown in the multifunction display.
During kickdown, you cannot shift gears using
the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
If you apply full throttle, the automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear when the
maximum engine speed is reached. This prevents the engine from overrevving.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: it is only possible to
use kickdown in temporary manual drive program M. When manual drive program M is selected permanently, kickdown is not possible.
Kickdown
For maximum acceleration, depress the
accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point.
The automatic transmission shifts to a lower
gear depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
X
Problems with the transmission
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
problems shifting gear.
The transmission is losing oil.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
X Stop.
The transmission no lon- X Shift the transmission to position P.
ger shifts into all of the
X Switch off the engine.
gears.
Reverse gear can no lon- X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D.
ger be engaged.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Refuelling
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
G WARNING
Vehicles with a diesel engine:
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel could
result in damage to the fuel system and the
engine. The repair costs are high. Notify a
qualified specialist workshop and have the
fuel tank and fuel lines drained completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel can.
The fuel lines and/or the fuel injection system
could otherwise be blocked by particles from
the fuel can.
Do not get back into the vehicle during the refuelling process; Otherwise, electrostatic charge
could build up again.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may spray
out when you remove the fuel pump nozzle.
Further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 327).
Refuelling
General notes
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 152).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked/locked automatically when you unlock/lock the vehicle with the
key.
The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed
æ in the instrument cluster. The arrow next
to the filling pump indicates the side of the vehicle.
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition if
you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel.
Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel system.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel can
result in damage to the fuel system and the
engine. Notify a qualified specialist workshop
and have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not switch on the ignition if
you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel.
Z
Driving and parking
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
153
Driving and parking
154
Refuelling
Opening the fuel filler flap
Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings open.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder on the
inside of fuel filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place and
refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
To open the fuel filler flap
Tyre pressure table
To insert the fuel filler cap
Instruction label on the fuel type to be refuelled
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or, on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS‑GO:
X Open the driver's door.
The vehicle electronics now have status 0.
This is the same as the key having been
removed.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the filler neck is
designed for refuelling at diesel filling pumps.
Do not add any more fuel after the pump stops
filling for the first time. Otherwise, fuel may leak
out.
:
;
=
?
X
Closing the fuel filler flap
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
Close the fuel filler flap before locking the vehicle.
X
Parking
155
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
The engine does not
start.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely
dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least 5 litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for approximately ten seconds (Y page 133).
X Start the engine continuously for a maximum of ten seconds until it
runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again for a maximum of ten seconds
(Y page 133).
X Start the engine again continuously for a maximum of ten seconds
until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel filler flap cannot The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
be opened.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 76).
The key battery is weak or discharged.
Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element (Y page 78).
X
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
Z
Driving and parking
G WARNING
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or, on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS‑GO:
X Open the driver's door.
The vehicle electronics now have status 0. This is the same as the
key having been removed.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
156
Parking
G WARNING
Manual transmission
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Shift to either 1st gear or reverse gear R.
With the key: turn the key to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X With the Start/Stop button: press the
Start/Stop button (Y page 133).
The engine stops and all the indicator lamps
on the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's
door is open, this corresponds to key position
0: "key removed".
X Apply the electric parking brake.
Rrelease
the parking brake
Driving and parking
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! Always secure the vehicle correctly against
rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is safeguarded
against rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe electric parking brake must be applied
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, engage
1st gear or reverse gear
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, the
transmission must be in position P and the
transmission position display must show P in
the multifunction display.
Rthe key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron uphill or downhill gradients, the front
wheels must be turned towards the kerb.
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
X
X
Automatic transmission
X
Apply the electric parking brake.
X
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): shift the transmission to position P.
X
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: press button :.
With the key: turn the key to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X With the Start/Stop button: press the
Start/Stop button (Y page 133).
The engine stops and all the indicator lamps
on the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's
door is open, this corresponds to key position
0: "key removed".
X
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open the driver's door
or the front-passenger door or remove the key
from the ignition, the automatic transmission
shifts to P automatically.
With the Start/Stop button: if you then open
the driver's door or the front-passenger door,
the automatic transmission shifts to P automatically.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the vehicle
cleaned in an automatic car wash with a towing
system:
X Vehicles with the Start-Stop button:
remove the Start-Stop button from the ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X All vehicles: switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in the
ignition lock.
The function of the electric parking brake is
dependent on the on-board voltage. If the onboard voltage is low or if there is a malfunction
in the system, it may not be possible to apply the
released parking brake.
X If this is the case, park the vehicle only on
level ground and secure it to prevent it from
rolling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position
P.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first gear.
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake if the on-board voltage is low or if
there is a malfunction in the system. Contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
The electric parking brake carries out a function
check at regular intervals when the engine is
switched off. Noises that occur are normal.
Applying or releasing manually
Electric parking brake
General notes
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
X
To apply: push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the red ! indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
The electric parking brake can also be applied
when the key is removed.
X
To release: pull handle :.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
The electric parking brake can be released
only:
Rwhen the key is in position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 133) or
Rif the ignition was switched on using the
Start/Stop button
Z
157
Driving and parking
Parking
158
Parking
Driving and parking
Applying automatically (vehicles with
automatic transmission)
The electric parking brake is automatically
applied when the transmission is in position P
and:
Rthe engine is switched off or
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is opened
To prevent the electric parking brake from being
applied automatically, pull handle :.
The electric parking brake is also applied automatically if:
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC brings the vehicle
to a standstill or
Rthe HOLD function is keeping the vehicle stationary
RParking Pilot is keeping the vehicle stationary
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine is switched off
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is opened
Rthere is a system malfunction
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp on the instrument
cluster lights up.
The electric parking brake is not automatically
applied if the engine is switched off by the ECO
start/stop function.
Applying automatically (vehicles with
manual transmission)
The electric parking brake is applied automatically when the vehicle is being kept stationary by
the HOLD function.
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine is switched off
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is open
Rthere is a system malfunction
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
The electric parking brake is not automatically
applied if the engine is switched off by the ECO
start/stop function.
Releasing automatically
The electric parking brake can only be released
automatically in vehicles with automatic transmission.
The electric parking brake of your vehicle is
released automatically when all the following
conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe engine is running
Rthe transmission is in position D or R
Rthe seat belt is fastened
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
If the transmission is in position R, the boot lid
must be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled for the electric parking brake to be released automatically:
Rthe driver's door is closed
Ryou have shifted out of transmission position
P or you have previously driven faster than
3 km/h
Ensure that you do not depress the accelerator
pedal unintentionally. Otherwise, the parking
brake will be released and the vehicle will start
to move.
Emergency braking
The vehicle can also be braked during an emergency by using the electric parking brake.
X While driving, press handle : of the electric
parking brake (Y page 157).
The vehicle is braked as long as you keep
handle : of the electric parking brake
pressed. The longer the electric parking brake
handle : is depressed, the greater the braking force.
During braking:
Ra warning tone sounds
Rthe Release parking brake message
appears
Rthe red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is applied.
Driving tips
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer than
four weeks, the battery may be damaged by
exhaustive discharging.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer than
six weeks, it may suffer from lack of use.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
in achieving the most economical driving style
for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. Consumption can be significantly influenced by your driving style.
i You can obtain information on trickle chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving tips
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
:
;
=
?
Acceleration
Coasting
Constant
Additional range achieved
Range ? is shown under Bonus from start
and represents the additional range achieved
since the beginning of the journey as a result of
an adapted driving style.
If the fuel level has dropped into the reserve
range, the Reserve fuel level message is
shown in the multifunction display instead of
range ?. In addition, the 8 warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up (Y page 255).
Drive sensibly – save fuel
Observe the following tips to save fuel:
RThe tyres should always be inflated to the recommended tyre pressure.
RRemove unnecessary loads.
RRemove roof racks when they are not needed.
RWarm up the engine at low engine speeds.
RAvoid frequent acceleration or braking.
RHave all maintenance work carried out as
indicated by the service intervals in the Service Booklet or by the service interval display.
Fuel consumption also increases when driving in
cold weather, in stop-start traffic, on short journeys and in hilly terrain.
ECO display
The ECO display shows you how economical
your driving style is. The ECO display assists you
Z
Driving and parking
Parking up the vehicle
159
160
Driving tips
Driving and parking
The ECO display consists of three sections, with
an inner and outer area. The sections correspond to the following three categories:
:
Acceleration (evaluation of the
acceleration processes):
Rthe outer area fills up and the inner
area lights up green: moderate
acceleration, especially at higher
speeds
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: sporty acceleration
;
Coasting (evaluation of all deceleration processes):
Rthe outer area fills up and the inner
area lights up green: anticipatory
driving, keeping your distance and
early release of the accelerator.
The vehicle can coast without use
of the brakes.
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: frequent heavy
braking
=
Constant (continuous evaluation
over the entire journey):
Rthe outer area fills up and the inner
area lights up green: constant
speed and avoidance of unnecessary acceleration and deceleration
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: fluctuations in
speed
The three inner areas display the current driving
style and light up green as a result of a particularly economical driving style. Depending on the
driving situation, up to two areas may light up
simultaneously.
At the beginning of the journey, the three outer
areas are empty and fill up as a result of economical driving. A higher level indicates a more
economical driving style. If the three outer areas
are completely filled at the same time, the driver
has adopted the most economical driving style
for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. The ECO display border lights up.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual fuel
consumption. The additionally achieved range
displayed under Bonus from start does not
indicate a fixed consumption reduction.
In addition to driving style, the actual consumption is affected by other factors, such as:
Rload
Rtyre pressure
Rcold start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
An economical driving style involves driving at a
moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
"Acceleration" and "Constant":
Robserve the gearshift recommendation.
Rdrive the vehicle in drive program C or E
(vehicles with DYNAMIC SELECT button).
On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g. on the
motorway, only the outer area for "Constant"
will change.
The ECO display summarises the driving style
from the start of the journey to its completion.
Therefore, there are more marked changes in
the outer areas at the start of a journey. During
a prolonged driving time, these changes are
smaller. For more marked changes, perform a
manual reset (Y page 204).
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 204).
Brakes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. For vehicles with
automatic transmission, you need to activate
manual gearshifting beforehand (Y page 150).
Driving tips
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If heavy demands are made on the brakes, do
not park the vehicle immediately. Drive on for a
short while. This allows the airflow to cool the
brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness.
To do this, brake more firmly from a higher
speed, paying attention to traffic conditions.
This improves the grip of the brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after a car wash or
after driving through deep water.
You will have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance to the vehicle
in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle
washed, brake firmly while paying attention to
the traffic conditions. This will warm up the
brake discs, thereby drying them more quickly
and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salt-treated roads, a layer of salt
may form on the brake discs and pads. This can
increase the braking distance considerably.
RIn order to prevent any salt build-up, apply the
brakes occasionally while paying attention to
the traffic conditions.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal at the end
of the journey and when starting the next
journey.
RMaintain a much greater distance to the vehicle in front.
New brake pads/linings
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either new
or have been replaced only achieve optimum
braking effect after several hundred kilometres
of driving. Compensate for the reduced braking
effect by applying greater force to the brake
pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which correspond to an equivalent quality standard. Brake
pads/linings which have not been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which are not of an
equivalent quality could affect your vehicle's
operating safety.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth on
the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou are driving at low speeds
Rthe tyres have adequate tread depth
Z
Driving and parking
Take particular note of this when driving a laden
vehicle and when towing a trailer.
This also applies if you have activated cruise
control, the speed limiter or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC.
This will use the braking effect of the engine, so
less braking will be required to maintain the
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
Briefly depressing the accelerator pedal on
downhill gradients while the manual drive program M is temporarily activated (vehicles with
automatic transmission): the automatic transmission may switch back to the last active automatic drive program E or S. The automatic transmission may shift to a higher gear. This can
reduce the engine's braking effect.
161
162
Driving systems
Driving and parking
For this reason, drive in the following manner in
the event of heavy rain or in conditions in which
aquaplaning can occur:
Rlower your speed
Ravoid tyre ruts
Ravoid sudden steering movements
Rbrake carefully
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in front
or in the opposite direction create waves. This
may cause the maximum permissible water
depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all circumstances. You could otherwise damage
the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you must drive on stretches of road on which
water has collected, please bear in mind that:
Rin the case of standing water, the water level
must be no higher than the lower edge of the
vehicle body
Ryou should drive no faster than walking pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration,
steering and braking manoeuvres. Do not use
cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
X Vehicles with manual transmission: shift
to neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by using
corrective steering.
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device and
is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above freezing
point do not guarantee that the road surface is
free of ice. The road may still be icy, especially in
wooded areas or on bridges.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing
point.
Further information on driving with snow chains
(Y page 313).
Further information on driving with summer
tyres (Y page 312).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation" section (Y page 312).
Driving systems
Cruise control
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road speed
for you. It brakes automatically in order to avoid
exceeding the set speed. You must select a
lower gear in good time on long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden or
towing a trailer. On vehicles with automatic
transmission, you need to have selected the
manual drive program M (Y page 150). By doing
so, you will make use of the braking effect of the
Driving systems
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise control can neither reduce the risk of an accident
nor override the laws of physics. Cruise control
cannot take into account road, weather or traffic
conditions. Cruise control is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time
and for staying in lane.
Do not use cruise control:
Rin road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g. in
heavy traffic or on winding roads.
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or accelerating can cause the drive wheels to lose
traction and the vehicle could then skid.
Rin poor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow.
If a new driver takes over, advise the new driver
of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
= To activate at the current speed/last stored
speed
? To activate or reduce speed
A To switch between cruise control and the
variable speed limiter
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and the variable
speed limiter with the cruise control lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable limiter is
selected.
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display for
five seconds.
Selecting cruise control
To select cruise control:check whether LIM
indicator lamp ; is on or off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
X If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
X
Activation conditions
To activate cruise control, all of the following
activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe electric parking brake must be released.
Ryou are driving faster than 30 km/h.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, the
selector lever must be in position D.
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, a gear
must be engaged.
Rcruise control must be selected.
Storing, maintaining and calling up a
speed
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
: To activate or increase speed
; LIM indicator lamp
You can store the current speed if you are driving faster than 30 km/h.
Z
Driving and parking
engine. This relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly.
When the engine is running, you can use the
cruise control lever to limit the speed to any
speed between 30 km/h and the technically
permitted maximum speed of the vehicle. If the
set value of the permanent limiter is lower, then
this value applies (Y page 166).
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions are appropriate for maintaining a steady
speed for a prolonged period.
The speed indicated in the speedometer may
differ slightly from the speed stored.
163
Driving systems
164
Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed.
Briefly press the cruise control lever up : or
down ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle automatically maintains the speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by automatically braking the vehicle.
X
Driving and parking
X
i Vehicles with manual transmission:
RAlways
drive at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds.
RChange gear in good time.
RIf possible, do not change down several
gears at a time.
Storing the current speed or calling up the
last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously stored
speed.
X
Setting a speed
Bear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X To adjust the set speed in10 km/hincrements:briefly press cruise control lever : up
or
beyond the pressure point for a higher speed,
or down ? for a lower speed.
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed beyond
the pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
X
To adjust the set speed in1 km/hincrements:briefly press cruise control lever up :
to the pressure point for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is set.
Press cruise control lever up : for a higher
speed or down ? for a lower speed.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if
you accelerate briefly to overtake, cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise control:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards
B.
or
X Brake.
or
X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
The variable limiter is selected. LIM indicator
lamp ; in the cruise control lever lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
vehicle is secured with the electric parking brake
Ryou are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® engages or you deactivate ESP®
Rwhile driving a vehicle with manual transmission, you shift into neutral or depress the
clutch pedal for longer than six seconds
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you
shift to a gear that is too high, and as a result
the engine speed is too low
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, you
shift to position N while driving
Rthe
Driving systems
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
trol off message in the multifunction display
for approximately five seconds.
165
Variable speed limiter
General notes
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
Speed limiter
General notes
The limiter restricts the speed of the vehicle. The
limiter brakes automatically in order to adjust
the vehicle's speed to the stored speed.
You must select a lower gear in good time on
long and steep downhill gradients, especially if
the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer. On vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected the manual drive program
M (Y page 150). By doing so, you will make use
of the braking effect of the engine. This relieves
the load on the brake system and prevents the
brakes from overheating and wearing too
quickly.
You can set a variable or permanent limit speed:
RVariable for maximum permissible speeds,
e.g. in built-up areas
RPermanent for a technically permitted maximum vehicle speed, e.g. when driving with
winter tyres fitted (Y page 166)
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the stored maximum
permissible speed.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, the speed
limiter can neither reduce the risk of an accident
nor override the laws of physics. The limiter cannot take into account road, weather or traffic
conditions. The limiter is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time
and for staying in lane.
If a new driver takes over, advise the new driver
of the speed stored.
: Activates or increases speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= Activates at the current speed/last stored
speed
? Activates or reduces speed
A Switches between cruise control and the
variable speed limiter
B Switches off the speed limiter
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and
the variable speed limiter.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM indicator lamp off: cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable speed limiter is selected.
When the engine is running, you can use the
cruise control lever to limit the speed to any
speed between 30 km/h and the maximum
design speed of the vehicle. If the set value of
the permanent limiter is lower then this value
applies (Y page 166).
Selecting the variable speed limiter
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is on.
If it is on, the variable speed limiter is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever lights up. The variable limiter is selected.
Z
Driving and parking
switch off the engine.
Driving systems
166
Driving and parking
Storing the current speed
You can use the cruise control lever to limit the
speed to any speed above 30 km/h while the
engine is running.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up : or
down ?.
The current speed is stored and shown in the
multifunction display.
Storing or calling up the speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
Setting a speed
X
or
To adjust the set speed in10 km/hincrements:briefly press the cruise control lever
up : beyond the pressure point for a higher
speed, or down ? for a lower speed.
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed beyond
the pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
X
To adjust the set speed in1 km/hincrements:briefly press the cruise control lever
up : to the pressure point for a higher speed
or down ? for a lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is set.
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
Switching the speed limiter to passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point (kickdown), the limiter is
switched to passive mode. The Limiter pas‐
sive message appears in the multifunction display.
You can then exceed the stored speed. The limiter is activated again if, without kickdown, you:
Rdrive more slowly than the stored speed
Rset a new speed or
Rcall up the last speed stored again
The Limiter passive message in the multifunction display disappears.
Switching off the variable speed limiter
You cannot switch the variable speed limiter off
by braking.
There are several ways to deactivate the variable speed limiter:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards
B.
or
X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. The variable speed limiter is
switched off.
Cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
selected.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the limiter switches off if you shift to a higher gear and
as a result, the engine speed is too low.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent limiter
If you wish to restrict the maximum speed of the
vehicle for an extended period (e.g. when driving
with winter tyres), the desired maximum speed
can be set with the permanent limiter.
You can use the on-board computer to limit the
speed to a value between 160 km/h and
240 km/h (Y page 211).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display. When you
confirm the message with a or %, the
display is suppressed until you next switch off
the engine. The speed will only be displayed
again once the engine has been restarted.
The permanent limiter remains active even if the
variable limiter is deactivated. The driven speed
will remain below the stored speed even in the
event of kickdown.
Driving systems
General notes
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC regulates the speed
and automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. The system detects vehicles using the radar sensor system. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC brakes automatically to avoid exceeding the set speed or to
maintain the designated distance from the vehicle in front.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects that there is
a risk of a collision, you will be warned visually
and acoustically. Without your intervention, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC cannot prevent a collision. An intermittent warning tone will then
sound and the distance warning lamp will light
up in the instrument cluster. Brake immediately
to increase the distance to the vehicle in front,
or take evasive action, provided it is safe to do
so.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC operates in the range
between 0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Shift into a lower gear in good time on long and
steep downhill gradients. Take particular note of
this when driving a laden vehicle. By doing so,
you will make use of the braking effect of the
engine. This relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly.
Do not use Distance Pilot DISTRONIC on roads
with steep gradients.
For Distance Pilot DISTRONIC to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must be
operational.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC does not recognise
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary objects on the road, e.g. stopped
or parked vehicles
vehicles or crossing traffic
As a result, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may
neither give warnings nor intervene in such
situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Roncoming
G WARNING
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC cannot always
clearly identify other road users and complex
traffic situations.
In such cases, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate or brake unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be ready to
brake, especially if Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
warns you.
G WARNING
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC brakes your vehicle
with up to 50% of the maximum possible
deceleration. If this deceleration is not sufficient, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC alerts you
with a visual and acoustic warning. There is a
risk of an accident.
Apply the brakes yourself in these situations
and try to take evasive action.
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time
and for staying in lane.
Z
Driving and parking
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
167
Driving and parking
168
Driving systems
Do not use Distance Pilot DISTRONIC:
Rin road and traffic conditions that do not allow
you to maintain a constant speed, e.g. in
heavy traffic or on winding roads.
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or accelerating can cause the drive wheels to lose
traction and the vehicle could then skid.
Rin poor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may not detect narrow vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can be
impaired in the following situations:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, e.g. in multi-storey
car parks
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC no longer detects a
vehicle in front, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may
unexpectedly accelerate to the speed stored.
This speed can:
Rbe too high for a filter lane or a slip road
Rbe so high on the right lane that you pass
vehicles driving in the left lane
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass vehicles driving in the right lane
If a new driver takes over, advise the new driver
of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
To store the current speed or a higher speed
To set the specified minimum distance
LIM indicator lamp
To store the current speed or call up the last
stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower speed
:
;
=
?
B To switch between Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC and the variable limiter
C To deactivate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the variable limiter.
LIM indicator lamp = on the cruise control lever
indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM indicator lamp=
=off: distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp=
=on: variable limiter is
selected.
Selecting Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
Check whether LIM indicator lamp = is off.
If it is off, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is already
selected.
X If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow B.
LIM indicator lamp = in the cruise control
lever goes out. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
selected.
X
Activating Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
Activation conditions
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
To activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC, the following conditions must be fulfilled:
RThe engine must be running. It may take up to
two minutes of driving before Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is ready for use.
RThe electric parking brake must be released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
RParking Pilot must not be activated.
RThe transmission must be in position D.
RThe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Driving systems
RThe
front-passenger door must be closed.
vehicle must not be skidding.
Switching on
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?, up : or down A.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed up : or
down A until the desired speed is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the Distance Pilot passive message appears in the multifunction display. The
set distance to a slower-moving vehicle in
front will then not be maintained. The position
of the accelerator pedal will determine the
speed.
You can also activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
when stationary. The lowest speed that can be
set is 30 km/h.
X
Driving with Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
Activating at the current speed/last
stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
The first time Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
activated, it stores the current speed or regulates the speed of the vehicle to the previously stored speed.
X
Pulling away and driving
If you want to pull away with Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC: remove your foot from the
brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
or
X If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated:
accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its speed
to that of the vehicle in front. If no vehicle is
detected in front, your vehicle accelerates to
the set speed.
The vehicle can also pull away when it is facing
an unidentified obstacle or is driving on a different line from another vehicle. The vehicle then
brakes automatically. Be ready to brake at all
times.
If there is no vehicle in front, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a slowermoving vehicle in front, it brakes your vehicle. In
this way, the distance you have selected is maintained.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a fastermoving vehicle in front, it increases the driving
speed. However, the vehicle is only accelerated
up to the speed you have stored.
X
i Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated
when you depress the brake, except when the
vehicle is stationary.
Selecting the drive program
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC supports a sporty
driving style when you select the S+ drive program (Mercedes-AMG vehicles only), S
(Y page 148) or the manual drive program
(Y page 150). Acceleration behind the vehicle in
front or to the set speed is then noticeably more
dynamic. If you have selected the E (C in
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:) drive program, the
vehicle accelerates more gently. This setting is
recommended in stop-start traffic.
Changing lanes
If you want to change to the overtaking lane on
multi-lane roads, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC supports you if:
Ryou are driving faster than 70 km/h
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC is maintaining the
distance to a vehicle in front
Z
Driving and parking
RThe
169
170
Driving systems
RYou
switch on the respective turn signal
Pilot DISTRONIC does not currently
detect a danger of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle accelerates. Acceleration will be interrupted if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle in front
becomes too small.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects that the
vehicle in front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle
until it is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
control lever repeatedly until the desired
speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed to the new speed stored.
X To adjust the set speed in1 km/hincrements: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down A to the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases
in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in10 km/hincrements: press the cruise control lever briefly
up : or down A beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases
in 10 km/h increments.
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
i Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is not deactivated
Driving and parking
RDistance
Stopping
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill at
a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in
front. The specified minimum distance is set
using the control on the cruise control lever.
When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated,
the transmission is shifted automatically to
position P if:
Rthe
driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
The electric parking brake is applied automatically if Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is active when
the vehicle is stationary and:
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
If a fault occurs, the transmission may also shift
to position P automatically.
Setting a speed
Bear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until the
desired speed is reached or press the cruise
if you depress the accelerator pedal. If you
accelerate to overtake, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC adjusts the vehicle's speed to the
last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance for
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC by varying the time
span between one and two seconds. With this
function, you can set the minimum distance that
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC maintains to the vehicle in front, dependent on the vehicle speed. You
can see this distance in the multifunction display (Y page 171).
The specified minimum distance can be
changed while Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
switched on or off.
i Make sure that you maintain the minimum
distance to the vehicle in front as required by
law. Adjust the distance to the vehicle in front
if necessary.
Driving systems
Deactivating Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
RYou
pull the cruise control lever towards you
in order to pull away and the front-passenger
door or one of the rear doors is open
RThe vehicle is skidding
RYou activate Parking Pilot
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated automatically, you will hear a warning tone. The
Distance Pilot off message will appear in
the multifunction display for approximately five
seconds.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is automatically deactivated if you activate DSR. The à DSR symbol appears in the multifunction display.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC displays in
the instrument cluster
Displays in the speedometer
There are several ways to deactivate Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
The variable limiter is selected. LIM indicator
lamp ; in the cruise control lever lights up.
When you deactivate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC,
the Distance Pilot off message appears in
the multifunction display for approximately five
seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine. Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is not deactivated if you depress
the accelerator pedal.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is automatically deactivated if:
RYou apply the electric parking brake or if the
vehicle is automatically secured with the electric parking brake
RESP® engages or you deactivate ESP®
RThe transmission is in the P, R or N position
When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated and
there are no vehicles detected in front, one or
two segments ; in the speed range set light up.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a vehicle in
front, segments ; between speed of the vehicle in front = and stored speed : light up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed in
the speedometer may differ slightly from the
speed set for Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
Display when Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
deactivated
In the Assistance menu (Y page 208) of the onboard computer, you can select the assistance
graphic display.
Z
Driving and parking
To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC then maintains a
greater distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC then maintains a
shorter distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front.
X
171
Driving systems
172
Tips for driving with Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC
Driving and parking
General notes
Assistance graphic
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to the
vehicle in front
= Specified minimum distance to the vehicle
in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer (Y page 208).
Display when Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
activated
You will initially see the stored speed for about
five seconds when you activate Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC.
Assistance graphic
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Specified minimum distance to the vehicle
in front; adjustable
= Own vehicle
? Distance Pilot DISTRONIC active (text only
appears when the cruise control lever is
actuated
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer (Y page 208).
Pay particular attention in the following traffic
situations:
RCornering, entering and exiting a bend: the
ability of Distance Pilot DISTRONIC to detect
vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle may brake unexpectedly or late.
RDriving on a different line: Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC may not detect vehicles driving in
a different lane. The distance to the vehicle in
front will be too short.
ROther vehicles changing lane: Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle will be
too short.
RNarrow vehicles: Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
does not detect the vehicle in front on the
edge of the carriageway because of its narrow
width. The distance to the vehicle in front will
be too short.
RObstacles and stationary vehicles: Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC does not brake for obstacles
or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
detected vehicle turns a corner and an obstacle or stationary vehicle is revealed, Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC will not brake for them.
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC may mistakenly
detect vehicles that are crossing your lane. If
you activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC under
the following conditions, the vehicle could
pull away unintentionally:
- at traffic lights with crossing traffic, for
example
- if there is a vehicle in front after a crossing
with the HOLD function activated
In such situations, brake if necessary. Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC is then switched off.
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen pulling away, especially on steep slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
Driving systems
The vehicle is kept stationary without the driver
having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
173
Activating the HOLD function
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
Deactivating the HOLD function (Y page 173).
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe vehicle is stationary
Rthe engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
Rthe driver's door is closed or if your seat belt
is fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N on
vehicles with automatic transmission
Make sure that the activation conditions are
met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first time
does not activate the HOLD function, wait
briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically
if:
Ryou accelerate. On vehicles with automatic
transmission: only when the transmission is in
position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P on vehicles
with automatic transmission.
Ryou depress the brake pedal again with a certain amount of pressure until : disappears
from the multifunction display.
Ryou activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric parking brake.
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
When the HOLD function is activated, the transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
Z
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
174
Driving systems
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated,
the vehicle is stationary and:
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Driving and parking
Vehicles with manual transmission
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated
and:
Rthe driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
The Brake immediately message may also
appear on the multifunction display.
X Immediately depress the brake pedal firmly
until the warning message on the multifunction display goes out.
The HOLD function is deactivated.
A horn will sound at regular intervals if you turn
off the engine, take off your seat belt or open the
driver's door when the HOLD function is activated. The horn alerts you to the fact that the
HOLD function is still activated. If you attempt to
lock the vehicle, the tone becomes louder. The
vehicle cannot be locked until you have deactivated the HOLD function.
i Once you have switched off the engine, you
cannot restart it until you have deactivated
the HOLD function.
Start-off assist (except MercedesAMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use start-off assist, individual wheels
may start to spin and the vehicle may skid. If
ESP® is deactivated, there is a greater danger
of skidding and having an accident. Make sure
that no persons or obstacles are in the area
around the vehicle.
Start-off assist enables optimum acceleration
from a standstill. For this, a suitably high-grip
road surface is required; the tyres and vehicle
must also be in good condition.
Do not activate start-off assist on public roads.
Observe the safety notes on driving safety systems (Y page 66).
Be sure to read the safety notes and information
on ESP® (Y page 69).
Activating start-off assist
Deactivate ESP® (Y page 209).
Turn the steering wheel to the straight-ahead
position.
X Depress the brake pedal hard with your left
foot and keep it depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D.
X Use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to select
the S drive program (Y page 141).
X Quickly depress the accelerator pedal fully.
X Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
i Activate ESP® as soon as the acceleration
process has ended. ESP® will otherwise not
be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle
starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin.
Cancelling start-off assist
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
X Reactivate ESP®.
X
X
RACE START (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
i RACE START must not be used on normal
roads. RACE START must be activated and
used only on dedicated race circuits, not on
public roads.
i RACE START is only available in
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles.
G WARNING
If you use RACE START, individual tyres may
get into a spin and the vehicle could skid.
Depending on the selected ESP® mode, there
Driving systems
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. For this, a suitably highgrip road surface is required; the tyres and vehicle must also be in good condition.
i Observe the safety notes on driving safety
systems (Y page 66).
Be sure to read the safety notes and information on ESP® (Y page 69).
Activation conditions
You can activate RACE START if:
Rthe doors, the bonnet and the boot lid are
closed
Rthe engine is running and the transmission,
traction control and engine are at operating
temperature
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake pedal is
depressed (left foot)
Rthe transmission is in position D
Rone of the drive programs S, S+ or RACE is
selected (Y page 141)
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Pull and hold both steering wheel gearshift
paddles.
X The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Release both steering wheel gearshift paddles.
i If the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The RACE
START not possible See Owner's Man‐
ual message appears in the multifunction
display.
X
X
or
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 150).
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 150).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator pedal
within a few seconds, RACE START is cancelled. The multifunction display shows the
RACE START cancelled message.
X Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed increases.
The RACE START Release brake to start
message appears in the multifunction display.
i If the brake pedal is not released after a
short while, RACE START is cancelled. The
multifunction display shows the RACE START
cancelled message.
X Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active message appears in
the multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if you
release the accelerator pedal during RACE
START or if any of the activation conditions are
no longer fulfilled. The RACE START not pos‐
sible or RACE START cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
i After using it several times in short succession, RACE START will be unavailable until a
certain distance has been driven.
AMG RIDE CONTROL
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
Z
Driving and parking
is an increased risk of skidding and having an
accident. Make sure that no persons, animals
or obstacles are within range of the vehicle.
175
Driving and parking
176
Driving systems
The damping is adjusted individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour driving style, e.g. sporty
Rthe road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection of "Sport" or "Comfort"
The suspension setting is adjusted using the
corresponding button on the centre console.
X
i The mode can also be set using the AMG
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle raised.
DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Y page 141).
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
Comfort mode is activated when the engine is
next started.
Sport mode
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
Sport mode ensures even better contact with
the road. Select this mode when employing a
sporty driving style, e.g. on winding country
roads.
X Press button : once.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected
Sport mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Comfort mode
In Comfort mode, the driving characteristics of
your vehicle are more comfortable. Select this
mode if you prefer a more comfortable driving
style, but also when driving at speed on straight
roads, e.g. motorways.
Press button : again to switch off indicator
lamp ;.
You have selected Comfort mode.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
4MATIC
This may damage the differential. Damage of
this sort is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz
implied warranty. All wheels must remain
either on the ground or be fully raised.
Observe the instructions for towing the vehicle with all wheels in full contact with the
ground.
4MATIC, together with ESP®, improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel
spins due to insufficient grip.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC can
neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot take
account of road, weather and traffic conditions.
4MATIC is only an aid. You are responsible for
the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time and for staying in
lane.
If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip:
Rwhen pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
Raccelerate less when driving.
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if you
use winter tyres (M+S tyres), with snow
chains if necessary.
Chassis with adaptive adjustable
damping
General notes
Suspension with the Adaptive Damping System
provides improved driving comfort and continuously controls the calibration of the dampers.
The damping characteristics adapt to the current operating and driving situation.
The damping is tuned individually to each wheel
and depends on:
Ryour driving style, e.g. sporty
Rthe road surface conditions
Rthe drive program selected
The drive program can be set using the
DYNAMIC SELECT button (Y page 141).
Selecting Comfort mode
In the Comfort drive program, the driving characteristics of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select this drive program if you prefer a
more comfortable driving style. Also select the
Comfort drive program when driving fast on
straight roads, e.g. on straight stretches of
motorway.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button (Y page 141)
as many times as necessary until the Comfort drive program is selected.
Selecting Sport mode
The firmer suspension setting in the Sport drive
program ensures even better contact with the
road. Select this drive program when employing
a sporty driving style, e.g. on winding country
roads.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button (Y page 141)
as many times as necessary until the Sport
drive program is selected.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is an electronic
parking aid with ultrasound. It monitors the area
around your vehicle using six sensors in the
front bumper and six sensors in the rear
bumper. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC shows you
the distance between your vehicle and an obstacle visually and audibly.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is
not a substitute for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals or
objects in range while manoeuvring and parking.
flower pots or trailer drawbars. Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects
when they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or the
objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and other
objects that absorb ultrasonic waves.
Ultrasonic sources such as an automatic car
wash, the compressed-air brakes of a lorry or
a pneumatic drill could cause Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC may not function
correctly on uneven terrain.
! Fold in the ball coupling if the trailer tow
hitch is not required. Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC measures the minimum detection range to an obstacle from the bumper,
not the ball coupling.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when you:
Rswitch on the ignition
Rshift the transmission to position D, R or N on
vehicles with automatic transmission
Rrelease the electric parking brake
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated at
speeds above 18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower
speeds.
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch: Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear
area when you establish the electrical connection between your vehicle and a trailer.
Range of the sensors
General notes
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC does not take into
account obstacles located:
Rbelow the detection range, e.g. persons, animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such as
Z
177
Driving and parking
Driving systems
178
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Minimum distance
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 20 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the relevant warning displays light up and a warning
tone sounds. If the distance falls below the minimum, the distance may no longer be shown.
: Sensors in the front bumper, left-hand side
Warning displays
(example)
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and slush.
Otherwise, they may not function correctly.
Clean the sensors regularly, taking care not to
scratch or damage them (Y page 289).
Range
: Segments on the left-hand side of the vehi-
cle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the vehi-
cle
= Segments showing operational readiness
: Front sensors detection range
; Rear sensors detection range
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Rear sensors
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located on
the dashboard above the centre air vents. The
warning display for the rear area is located on
the roof lining in the rear compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle
is divided into five yellow and two red segments.
If yellow segments = showing operational readiness light up, Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is
operational.
The gear lever position or the transmission position of the automatic transmission and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the
engine is running.
Driving systems
Manual transmission:
Gear lever position Warning display
Forward gear
or
Neutral
Front area activated
This indicates that you have now reached the
minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
Driving and parking
Reverse gear or the Rear and front areas
activated
vehicle is rolling
backwards
Automatic transmission:
Transmission posi- Warning display
tion
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle is Rear and front areas
activated
rolling backwards
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth segment onwards, you will hear an intermittent warning tone for approximately two
seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds.
179
: Indicator lamp
; Deactivates/activates Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC is deactivated.
i Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is automati-
cally activated when you turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
Z
180
Driving systems
Problems with Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments in Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is malfunctioning and has been deactithe Parking Assist
vated.
PARKTRONIC warning
X If problems persist, have Parking Assist PARKTRONIC checked at a
displays are lit. You also
qualified specialist workshop.
hear a warning tone for
approximately two seconds.
Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated and the indicator lamp on the
PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments in The Parking Assist PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or malfunctioning.
the Parking Assist
X Clean the Parking Assist PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 289).
PARKTRONIC warning
X Switch the ignition back on.
displays are lit. Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC is
The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or ultrathen deactivated.
sound waves.
X Check to see if Parking Assist PARKTRONIC functions in a different
location.
Parking Pilot
General notes
Parking Pilot is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasound. It measures the road on both sides
of the vehicle. A parking symbol indicates a suitable parking space. Active steering intervention
and brake application can assist you during
parking and when exiting a parking space. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is also available
(Y page 177).
i The active braking application is only avail-
able on vehicles with automatic transmission.
Important safety notes
Parking Pilot is only an aid. It is not a substitute
for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe manoeuvring
and parking remains with you. Make sure that no
persons, animals or objects are in the manoeuvring range.
When Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated, Parking Pilot is also unavailable.
G WARNING
While parking or pulling out of a parking
space, the vehicle swings out and can drive
onto areas of the oncoming lane. This could
cause you to collide with other road users.
There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to other road users. Stop the
vehicle if necessary or cancel the Parking Pilot
parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over obsta-
cles such as kerbs slowly and not at a sharp
angle. Otherwise, you may damage the
wheels or tyres.
Parking Pilot may also display spaces not suitable for parking, e.g.:
Rin a zone where parking or stopping is prohibited
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Ron unsuitable surfaces
Driving systems
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the detection range of
Parking Pilot will not be detected when the parking space is measured. These are not taken into
account when the parking procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods vehicles.
G WARNING
If there are objects above the detection range:
RParking
Pilot may steer in too early
vehicle may not stop in front of these
objects
This could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop and deactivate Parking Pilot.
Rthe
Further information on the detection range
(Y page 177).
Parking Pilot does not assist you parking in
spaces at right angles to the direction of travel if:
Rtwo parking spaces are located directly next
to one another
Rthe parking space is directly next to a low
obstacle such as a low kerb
Ryou forward-park
Parking Pilot does not assist you parking in
spaces parallel or at right angles to the direction
of travel if:
Rthe parking space is on a kerb
Rthe system reads the parking space as being
blocked, such as by foliage or grass paving
blocks
Rthe area is too small for the vehicle to
manoeuvre into
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle,
e.g. a tree, a post or a trailer
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Parking Pilot is activated automatically when
driving forwards. The system is operational at
speeds of up to approximately 35 km/h. While
in operation, the system independently locates
and measures parking spaces on both sides of
the vehicle.
Z
Driving and parking
Parking tips:
Ron narrow roads, drive as closely as possible
past the parking space
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown
might be identified or measured incorrectly
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied by
trailer drawbars might not be identified as
such or be measured incorrectly
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately
Rpay attention to the Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC warning messages
(Y page 178) during the parking procedure
Ryou can intervene in the steering procedure to
correct it at any time. Parking Pilot will then be
cancelled
Rwhen transporting a load that protrudes from
your vehicle, you should not use Parking Pilot
Rnever use Parking Pilot when snow chains are
fitted
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are always
correct. This has a direct influence on the
parking characteristics of the vehicle
Use Parking Pilot for parking spaces that are:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
Ron straight roads, not bends
Ron the same level as the road, e.g. not on the
pavement
For vehicles with the trailer tow hitch folded out,
the minimum length for parking spaces is
slightly longer.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle, you
should not use Parking Pilot. Once the electrical
connection is established between your vehicle
and the trailer, Parking Pilot is no longer available. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated
for the rear area.
181
Driving and parking
182
Driving systems
Parking Pilot will detect only parking spaces
which are:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel and
are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel and
at least 1.0 m longer than your vehicle
Rthat are at right angles to the direction of
travel and at least 1.0 m wider than your vehicle
i Note that Parking Pilot cannot measure the
length of a parking space if it is at right angles
to the direction of travel. You will need to
judge whether your vehicle will fit in the parking space.
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you will
see parking symbol ; as a status indicator in
the instrument cluster. When a parking space
has been detected, an arrow towards the right or
the left also appears. Parking Pilot displays only
parking spaces on the front-passenger side as
standard. Parking spaces on the driver's side
are displayed as soon as the turn signal on the
driver's side is activated. When parking on the
driver's side, this must remain activated until
you confirm the use of Parking Pilot by pressing
the a button on the multifunction steering
wheel. The system automatically determines
whether the parking space is parallel or at right
angles to the direction of travel.
A parking space is displayed while you are driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m
away from it.
Parking
G WARNING
If you leave the vehicle when it is only being
braked by Parking Pilot, it could roll away if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected
Rthe vehicle is accelerated, e.g. by a vehicle
occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always secure it
against rolling away.
i Vehicles with automatic transmission:
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC detects obstacles, Parking Pilot brakes automatically whilst
the vehicle is parking. You are responsible for
braking in good time.
X Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the instrument cluster.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position R.
Vehicles with manual transmission: shift
to reverse gear.
The Start Parking Pilot? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure:press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel or
pull away.
or
X To park using Parking Pilot: press the a
button on the multifunction steering wheel.
The Parking Pilot active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. When reversing, drive at a speed
below 10 km/h. Otherwise Parking Pilot is
cancelled.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Parking Pilot brakes the vehicle to a standstill
when the vehicle approaches the rear border
of the parking space.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking
spaces.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: stop
when Parking Assist PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking
spaces.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Parking Pilot active Select D Observe
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Parking Pilot active Engage forward
gear Observe surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
select transmission position D while the vehicle is stationary.
Vehicles with manual transmission: shift
to first gear while the vehicle is stationary.
Parking Pilot immediately steers in the other
direction.
The Parking Pilot active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting
for the steering procedure to complete before
pulling away.
X Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Parking Pilot brakes the vehicle to a standstill
when the vehicle approaches the front border
of the parking space.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking
spaces.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: stop
when Parking Assist PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Parking Pilot active Select R Observe
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Parking Pilot active Engage reverse
gearObserve surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete,
the Parking Pilot ended message appears in
the multifunction display and a warning tone
sounds. The vehicle is now parked.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
vehicle is kept stationary without the driver having to depress the brake pedal. The braking
effect is cancelled when you depress the accelerator pedal.
Parking Pilot no longer supports you with steering interventions and brake applications. When
Parking Pilot is ended, you must steer and brake
again yourself. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is
still available.
Parking tips:
RThe way your vehicle is positioned in the parking space after parking is dependent on various factors. These include the position and
shape of the vehicles parked in front of and
X
behind it and the conditions of the location. It
may be the case that Parking Pilot guides you
too far into a parking space, or not far enough
into it. In some cases, it may also lead you
across or onto the kerb. If necessary, you
should abort the parking procedure with Parking Pilot.
RYou can also preselect transmission position
D. The vehicle redirects and does not drive as
far into the parking space. Should the transmission change take place too early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible
parking position can no longer be achieved
from this position.
Exiting a parking space
In order that Parking Pilot can support you when
exiting the parking space:
Ryou need to have parked using Parking Pilot
Rthe border of the parking space must be high
enough at the front and the rear. A kerb stone
is too small, for example.
Rthe border of the parking space must not be
too wide, as the position of the vehicle must
not exceed an angle of 45° to the starting
position as it is manoeuvred into the parking
space.
Ra manoeuvring distance of at least 1.0 m must
be available.
Parking Pilot can assist you with exiting a parking space only if you have parked the vehicle
parallel to the direction of travel using the Parking Pilot
i Vehicles with automatic transmission:
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC detects obstacles, Parking Pilot brakes automatically whilst
the vehicle is exiting the parking space. You
are responsible for braking in good time.
X Start the engine.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the turn signal in the direction you
will drive out of the parking space.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position D or R.
Vehicles with manual transmission: shift
to forward or reverse gear.
The Start Parking Pilot? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
Z
183
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
184
X
or
To cancel the procedure:press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel or
pull away.
To exit a parking space using Parking
Pilot: press the a button on the multifunction steering wheel.
The Parking Pilot active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Pull away, being ready to brake at all times. Do
not exceed a maximum speed of approximately 10 km/h when exiting a parking
space. Otherwise, Parking Pilot is cancelled.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: stop,
when Parking Assist PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
depending on the message or as required,
shift the transmission to position D or R.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
depending on the message or as required,
engage forward or reverse gear.
Parking Pilot steers immediately in the other
direction. The Parking Pilot active
Accelerate and brake Observe sur‐
roundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting
for the steering procedure to complete before
pulling away.
If you reverse after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
X Drive forwards and reverse as prompted by
the Parking Assist PARKTRONIC warning displays, several times if necessary.
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and the
Parking Pilot ended message appears in the
multifunction display. You will then have to steer
and merge into traffic on your own. Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC is still available. You can
take over the steering before the vehicle has
exited the parking space completely. This is
useful, for example, when you recognise that it
is already possible to pull out of the parking
space.
Cancelling Parking Pilot
X
Driving and parking
X
or
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Parking Pilot is cancelled at once. The Park‐
ing Pilot cancelled message appears in
the multifunction display.
Press the PARKTRONIC button (Y page 179).
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is switched off
and Parking Pilot is immediately cancelled.
The Parking Pilot cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Parking Pilot is cancelled automatically when:
Rthe electric parking brake is applied
Rtransmission position P is selected in vehicles
with automatic transmission
Rparking with Parking Pilot is no longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails. In
such cases the ÷ warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol disappears and the multifunction display shows the
Parking Pilot cancelled message.
When Parking Pilot is cancelled, you must steer
and brake again yourself.
If a system malfunction occurs, the vehicle is
braked to a standstill. To drive on, depress the
accelerator pedal again.
X
Reversing camera
General notes
Reversing camera : is an optical parking and
manoeuvring aid. It shows the area behind your
Driving systems
vehicle with guide lines in the multimedia system display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
185
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
display depends on the language setting. The
following are examples of reversing camera
messages in the multimedia system display.
See the notes on cleaning (Y page 289).
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals or
objects in range while manoeuvring and parking.
The reversing camera will not function or will
function only in a limited manner:
RIf the boot lid is open
RIn heavy rain, snow or fog
RAt night or in very dark places
RIf the camera is exposed to very bright light
RIf the area is lit by fluorescent lamps or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
RIf there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in winter
RIf the camera lens is dirty or obstructed.
Observe the notes on cleaning
(Y page 289)
RIf the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g.
licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the Activation by R gear
function is selected in the multimedia system;
see the Digital Owner's Manual.
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown with
guide lines in the multimedia system display.
The image from the reversing camera is available throughout the manoeuvring process.
X
To switch the function mode for vehicles
with trailer tow hitch:using the controller,
select symbol : for the "Reverse parking"
function or symbol ; for "Coupling up a
trailer".
The symbol of the selected function is highlighted.
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
X
Messages in the multimedia system display
The reversing camera may show a distorted view
of obstacles, show them incorrectly or not at all.
Obstacles are not shown by the reversing camera in the following locations:
RVery close to the rear bumper
RUnder the rear bumper
RIn the area immediately above the recessed
handle on the boot lid
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe bumper of a parked vehicle
Rthe drawbar of a trailer
Z
Driving and parking
i The text shown in the multimedia system
186
Driving systems
Rthe
ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottommost guideline.
Driving and parking
Rthe
: Front warning displays
; Additional measurement operational readi-
ness indicator of the Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
= Rear warning displays
: Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steering
wheel, vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors (static)
= Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres will
take at the current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
A Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
B Vehicle centre axis (locating aid)
C Bumper
D Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
When Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 178), additional measurement
operational readiness indicator ; appears in
the multimedia system display. If the Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC warning displays are active
or light up, warning displays : and = are also
active or light up correspondingly in the multimedia system display.
"Reverse parking" function
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
: White guide line without turning the steering
wheel, vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors (static)
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
= Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
? Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
Driving systems
Make sure that the reversing camera is activated (Y page 185).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X With the help of white guide line :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using white guide line : as a guide, carefully
reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line ? is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel
in the parking space.
187
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
: Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
X Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
: Parking space marking
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
X Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
X Make sure that the reversing camera is activated (Y page 185).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X While the vehicle is stationary, turn the steering wheel in the direction of the parking space
until yellow guide line ; reaches parking
space marking :.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position and
reverse carefully.
: White guide line at current steering wheel
angle
; Parking space marking
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position
while the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
X
Driving systems
Driving and parking
188
: Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steering
wheel
= End of parking space
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached the
end position.
Red guide line : is then at the end of parking
space =. The vehicle is almost parallel in the
parking space.
"Coupling up a trailer" function
: Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the ball coupling
; Trailer drawbar locating aid
= Trailer drawbar
? Symbol for the "Coupling up a trailer" func-
tion
A Ball coupling
Select symbol ? using the controller.
The "Coupling up a trailer" function is selected. The distance specifications now only
apply to objects that are at the same level as
the ball coupling.
X Reverse carefully, making sure that trailer
drawbar locating aid ; points approximately
in the direction of trailer drawbar =.
X Reverse carefully until trailer drawbar = reaches the red guide line.
The distance between the trailer drawbar and
the red guide line is now approximately
0.30 m.
X Couple up the trailer (Y page 196).
X
Wide-angle function
: Vehicle centre point on the yellow guide line
at a distance of approximately 1.0 m from
the rear of the vehicle
; Trailer drawbar
This function is available only on vehicles with a
trailer tow hitch.
X Before coupling up a trailer, set the height of
trailer drawbar ; so that it is slightly higher
than the ball coupling.
X Position the vehicle centrally in front of trailer
drawbar ;.
: Symbol for the wide-angle view function
; Own vehicle
= Parking Assist PARKTRONIC warning dis-
plays
Driving systems
Select this view when you are driving out of an
exit and the view of crossing traffic is restricted,
for example.
189
Displaying the attention level
ATTENTION ASSIST
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 60 km/h to
200 km/h speed range. If ATTENTION ASSIST
detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the
driver, it suggests taking a break.
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration
until too late, or may not detect them at all. The
system is not a substitute for a well-rested and
attentive driver.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or not
occur at all in the following situations:
Rthe length of the journey is less than approximately 30 minutes
Rif the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface
is uneven or contains potholes
Rin case of strong side winds
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving at a speed
below 60 km/h or above 200 km/h
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when you
change lanes or change your speed
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts assessing
your tiredness again when you continue your
journey if:
Ryou switch off the engine
Ryou take off your seat belt and open the driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or to
take a break
You can have current status information displayed in the Assistance menu (Y page 208) of
the on-board computer.
X Select the assistance graphic display for
ATTENTION ASSIST using the on-board computer (Y page 208).
The following information is displayed:
Rthe length of the journey since the last break
Rthe attention level determined by ATTENTION
ASSIST(Attention
Attention level),
level displayed in a
bar display in five levels from high to low
Rif ATTENTION ASSIST is unable to calculate
the attention level and cannot output a warning, the System suspended message
appears. The bar display then changes the
display, e.g. if you are driving at a speed below
60 km/h or above 200 km/h.
Activating ATTENTION ASSIST
X
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 209).
The system determines the attention level of
the driver depending on the setting selected:
Standard selected: the sensitivity with which
the system determines the attention level is set
to normal.
Sensitive selected: the sensitivity is set
higher. The attention level detected by ATTENTION ASSIST is adapted accordingly and the
driver is warned earlier.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic display.
When ATTENTION ASSIST has been deactivated,
it is automatically reactivated after the engine
has been switched off. The sensitivity selected
Z
Driving and parking
General notes
190
Driving systems
corresponds to the last selection activated
(standard/sensitive).
Driving and parking
Warning on the multifunction display
If fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration
are detected, a warning appears in the multifunction display: ATTENTION ASSIST Take a
break!
In addition to the message shown on the multifunction display, you will then hear a warning
tone.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Confirm the message by pressing the a
button on the steering wheel.
On long journeys, take regular breaks that allow
for adequate recuperation. If you do not take a
break and ATTENTION ASSIST still detects
increasing lapses in concentration, you will be
warned again after 15 minutes at the earliest.
This will happen only if ATTENTION ASSIST still
detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration.
Vehicles with multimedia system COMAND
Online: if a warning is output in the multifunction display, a service station search is performed in the multimedia system. You can
select a service station and you will then be
navigated to this service station. This function
can be activated and deactivated in the multimedia system; see Digital Owner's Manual.
Traffic Sign Assist
General notes
Traffic Sign Assist displays the maximum speed
permitted and overtaking restrictions to the
driver in the instrument cluster. Driving onto a
section of road in the wrong direction triggers a
warning. Traffic Sign Assist detects traffic signs
with multifunction camera : attached at the
top of the windscreen. The data and general
traffic regulations stored in the navigation system are also used to determine the current
speed limit.
If a traffic sign that is relevant to your vehicle is
passed, the display of the speed limits and overtaking restrictions is updated.
The display can also be updated without a visible
traffic sign in the following situations:
RThe vehicle changes roads (e.g. motorway
exit or slip road)
RA village or town boundary that is stored in the
digital map is passed
RThe last traffic sign detected by the camera
has not been repeated
If a sign indicating the end of a restriction (speed
limit or overtaking restriction) is passed, the
sign is displayed for five seconds. The currently
applicable traffic regulation continues to be
shown in the assistance graphic display
(Y page 208).
The camera also detects traffic signs with a
restriction indicated by an additional sign (e.g. in
wet conditions).
The traffic signs are only displayed with the
restriction if:
RThe regulation must be observed with the
restriction, or
RTraffic Sign Assist is unable to determine
whether the restriction applies
If Traffic Sign Assist is unable to determine a
maximum permitted speed from any of the available sources, no speed limit is displayed in the
instrument cluster either.
Traffic Sign Assist is not available in all countries. In this case, display : is shown in the
multifunction display.
Driving systems
191
Traffic Sign Assist is only an aid and is not always
able to correctly display speed limits and overtaking restrictions. Traffic signs always have priority over the Traffic Sign Assist display.
The system may be either functionally impaired
or temporarily unavailable in the following situations:
RVisibility is poor, e.g. due to snow, rain, fog or
spray
RGlare, e.g. from the sun being low in the sky
RDirt, ice or misting on the windscreen in the
vicinity of the camera
RTraffic signs are hard to detect (dirt, ice,
snow)
RThe traffic signs are insufficiently lit at night
RSigns are ambiguous (e.g. traffic signs on construction sites or in adjacent lanes)
RThe information in the digital street map of the
navigation system is incorrect or out of date
: Maximum permissible speed
; Maximum permitted speed for vehicles for
which the restriction in the additional sign is
relevant
= Additional sign for unknown restriction
A maximum permissible speed of 80 km/h
(80 mph) and a speed limit of 60 km/h (60 mph)
with an unknown restriction apply.
No entry (wrong-way warning)
Activating Traffic Sign Assist
If you have activated the Traffic Sign Assist display in the on-board computer, the traffic regulations (speed limits and overtaking restrictions)
are displayed in the instrument cluster for five
seconds in each case. The wrong-way warning
and the traffic sign display for speed limits and
overtaking restrictions remain active in the
assistance graphic even when the display has
been deactivated.
X Activate the Traffic Sign Assist display using
the on-board computer (Y page 208).
Instrument cluster display
Speed limit with unknown restriction
i The following illustrations are examples of
vehicles with colour multifunction display.
The illustrations of vehicles with black and
white multifunction display differ from them.
i The unit for the speed limit (km/h or mph)
depends on the country in which you are driving. It is generally neither shown on the traffic
sign nor on the instrument cluster but must be
taken into account on observance of the maximum permissible speed.
A warning message : is displayed in the instrument cluster if Traffic Sign Assist detects that
you are passing a “no entry” sign and you are
driving in the wrong direction. You will then also
hear a warning tone. You should immediately
check your direction of travel in order to avoid
danger to yourself and other road users.
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 192) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 193).
Z
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
192
Driving systems
Blind Spot Assist
Driving and parking
General notes
Blind Spot Assist monitors the areas on either
side of the vehicle that are not visible to the
driver with two lateral, rear-facing radar sensors. A warning display in the exterior mirrors
draws your attention to vehicles detected in the
monitored area. If you then switch on the corresponding turn signal to change lanes, you will
also receive a visual and audible warning.
Blind Spot Assist supports you from a speed of
approximately 30 km/h.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles:
Rovertaken
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rwhen the difference in the speed of
approach and overtaking is too great
As a result, Blind Spot Assist cannot warn
drivers in these situations. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to
detect some vehicles and is not a substitute for
attentive driving. Always ensure that there is
sufficient distance to the side for other road
users and obstacles.
Monitoring range of the sensors
In particular, the detection of obstacles can be
impaired in the following situations:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle or a bicycle
Rvery wide lanes
Rnarrow lanes
Rvehicles not driving in the middle of their lane
Rbarriers or other road boundaries
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Blind Spot Assist monitors an area up to 3.0 m
behind your vehicle and directly next to your
vehicle.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may be
indicated, especially if the vehicles are not driving in the middle of their lane. This may be the
case if the vehicles are driving on the inner side
of their lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driving
close to crash barriers or similar solid boundaries
Rwarnings may be interrupted when you are
driving alongside particularly long vehicles,
for example lorries, for a prolonged time
Warning display
Radar sensors
The radar sensors for Blind Spot Assist are integrated into the rear bumper. Make sure that the
bumpers are free from dirt, ice or slush. The
sensors must not be covered, e.g. by cycle racks
or overhanging loads. Following a severe impact
or in the event of damage to the bumpers, have
the function of the radar sensors checked at a
qualified specialist workshop. Blind Spot Assist
may no longer work properly in such cases.
: Warning display
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
If Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow
Driving systems
To do so, you will need to deactivate Blind
Spot Assist if:
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
Rthe engine is not running
Rthe electrical connection to the trailer has
been established
Lane Keeping Assist
Driving and parking
up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds above
30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out and Blind
Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning always
occurs when a vehicle enters the blind spot
monitoring range from behind or from the side.
When you overtake a vehicle, the warning only
occurs if the difference in speed is less than
12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Blind Spot Assist is then deactivated.
The brightness of the indicator/warning lamps
is adjusted automatically according to the ambient light.
General notes
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the blind spot monitoring range and you switch on the corresponding turn signal, a double warning tone sounds.
Red warning lamp : flashes. If the turn signal
remains on, detected vehicles are indicated by
the flashing of red warning lamp :. There are
no further warning tones.
Activating Blind Spot Assist
Make sure that Blind Spot Assist is activated
in the on-board computer (Y page 209).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors light
up red for approximately 1.5 seconds and
then turn yellow.
X
Towing a trailer
If you couple up a trailer, make sure that you
have correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated. The indicator lamps in the exterior
mirrors light up yellow and the Blind Spot
Assist not available when towing a
trailer See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
i You can deactivate the indicator lamps in
the exterior mirrors.
193
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in front of
your vehicle by means of multifunction camera : attached at the top of the windscreen.
Lane Keeping Assist detects lane markings on
the road and can warn you before you leave your
lane unintentionally.
This function is available in a speed range
between 60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A warning may be given if a front wheel passes
over a lane marking. It will warn you by means of
intermittent vibration through the steering
wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist cannot always clearly
identify lane markings.
In these cases, Lane Keeping Assist may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep in lane, especially if Lane
Keeping Assist alerts you.
Rnot
Z
Towing a trailer
194
Driving and parking
G WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist warning does not
return the vehicle to the original lane. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always steer, apply the brakes or accelerate
the vehicle yourself, especially if Lane Keeping Assist alerts you.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Lane Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override the laws of physics. Lane
Keeping Assist cannot take into account road,
weather or traffic conditions. Lane Keeping
Assist is only an aid. You are responsible for the
distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time and for staying in
lane.
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle
in its lane.
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
RPoor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to snow, rain, fog or
spray
RGlare, e.g. from oncoming traffic, the sun or
reflection from other vehicles (e.g. if the road
surface is wet)
RThe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged
or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the
vicinity of the camera
RNo or several, unclear lane markings are present for one lane, e.g. in a construction area
RThe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
RThe distance to the vehicle in front is so small
that the lane markings cannot be detected
RThe lane markings change quickly, e.g. lanes
branch off, cross one another or merge
RThe road is narrow and winding
RThere are highly variable shade conditions on
the roadway
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
X
Activate Lane Keeping Assist using the onboard computer; to do so, select Standard or
Adaptive (Y page 209).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and lane
markings are detected, the lane markings in
the assistance graphics display (Y page 208)
are shown in green.
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration
occurs if:
RYou have switched on the turn signal. In this
event, the warnings are suppressed for a certain period of time.
RA driving safety system such as ABS, BAS or
ESP® engages.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
RYou have switched on the turn signal. In this
case, the warnings are suppressed for a certain period of time
RA driving safety system such as ABS, BAS or
ESP® engages
RYou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown
RYou brake hard
RYou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly
RYou cut the corner on a sharp bend
To ensure that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system detects certain conditions
and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier in the following situations:
RYou approach the outer lane marking on a
bend
RThe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway
RThe system detects solid lane markings
The warning vibration occurs later in the following situations:
RThe road has narrow lanes
RYou cut the corner on a bend
Towing a trailer
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle/trailer
combination if it begins to swerve. The vehicle/trailer combination could even overturn.
There is a risk of an accident.
On no account should you attempt to
straighten out the vehicle/trailer combination by increasing speed. Decrease your
speed and do not countersteer. Brake if necessary.
Towing a trailer
If the maximum permissible load for a carrier
system is exceeded, the carrier could come
loose from the vehicle and endanger other
road users. There is a risk of an accident and
injury.
Never exceed the maximum permissible load
when using a carrier.
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
changes to the engine cooling system may be
necessary, depending on the vehicle type.
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis.
Retrofitting a trailer tow hitch is only permissible
if a trailer load is specified in your vehicle documents. If this is not the case, then the vehicle is
not approved for towing a trailer.
For more information, please contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Exceeding the maximum permissible noseweight of the trailer drawbar on the ball coupling
may cause damage to the following:
Ryour vehicle
Rtrailer
Rball coupling
Rtrailer tow hitch
The vehicle/trailer combination could become
unstable.
The vehicle/trailer combination could also
become unstable if the noseweight used is lower
than the minimum permissible noseweight.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rmake sure to check the noseweight before
each journey
Rthe noseweight should be as close as possible
to the maximum noseweight
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
noseweight
Rthe noseweight must not be lower than the
minimum permissible noseweight
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe permissible noseweight
Rthe permissible trailer load
Rthe
permissible rear axle load of the towing
vehicle
Rthe maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
The applicable permissible values, which must
not be exceeded, can be found:
Rin your vehicle documents
Ron the identification plates of the trailer tow
hitch and the trailer
Ron the vehicle identification plate
If the values differ, the lowest value applies.
You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the identification plates and for the
towing vehicle under "Technical data"
(Y page 334).
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
When reversing the towing vehicle, make sure
there is nobody between the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If you
do not couple the trailer to the towing vehicle
correctly, the trailer could become detached.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different to when driving
without a trailer.
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Ris heavier
Ris restricted in its acceleration and gradientclimbing capability
Rhas an increased braking distance
Ris affected more by strong crosswinds
Rdemands more sensitive steering
Rhas a larger turning circle
This can impair the vehicle's handling characteristics. Adapt your driving style accordingly.
Maintain a safe distance. Drive carefully.
When towing a trailer, always adjust your speed
to the current road and weather conditions. Do
Z
Driving and parking
G WARNING
195
196
Towing a trailer
not exceed the maximum permissible speed for
your vehicle/trailer combination.
Notes on towing a trailer
Driving and parking
General notes
Trailer towing is not possible on the following
models:
RCLA 180 d BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
RCLA 250 Sport
RCLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
RMercedes‑AMG CLA 45 4MATIC
When towing a trailer, set the tyre pressure on
the rear axle of the towing vehicle for the maximum load. Further information on the tyre pressure table in the fuel filler flap (Y page 313).
Please note that when towing a trailer, the following driving systems have limited availability
or are not available at all.
RParking Assist PARKTRONIC (Y page 177)
RBlind Spot Assist (Y page 192)
The height of the ball coupling changes with the
load of the vehicle. If necessary, use a trailer
with a height-adjustable drawbar.
You will find fitting dimensions and loads under
"Technical data" (Y page 334).
Driving tips
Observe the notes on ESP® trailer stabilisation
(Y page 72).
The maximum permissible speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations depends on the type of
trailer. Before beginning the journey, check the
trailer's documents to see what the maximum
permitted speed is. Observe the legally prescribed maximum speed in the relevant country.
For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased
when towing a trailer. See the "Technical data"
section to find out whether this applies to your
vehicle. If you utilise any of the added maximum
rear axle load when towing a trailer, the vehicle/
trailer combination may not exceed a maximum
speed of 100 km/h for reasons concerning the
operating permit. This also applies in countries
in which the permissible maximum speed for
vehicle/trailer combinations is above
100 km/h.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different to when driving
without a trailer and the vehicle will consume
more fuel.
Shift into a lower gear in good time on long and
steep downhill gradients. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to have selected
manual drive program M (Y page 150).
This also applies if you have activated cruise
control, SPEEDTRONIC or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC.
This will use the braking effect of the engine, so
less braking will be required to maintain the
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need
additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
Briefly depressing the accelerator pedal on
downhill gradients while the manual drive program M is temporarily activated (vehicles with
automatic transmission): the automatic transmission may switch back to the last active automatic drive program E or S. The automatic transmission may shift to a higher gear. This can
reduce the engine's braking effect.
Driving tips
RMaintain
a greater distance to the vehicle in
front than when driving without a trailer.
RAvoid braking abruptly. If possible, brake gently at first to allow the trailer to run on. Then,
increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe values given for gradient-climbing capabilities from a standstill refer to sea level.
When driving in mountainous areas, note that
the power output of the engine, and consequently the vehicle's gradient-climbing capability from a standstill, decrease with increasing altitude.
If the trailer swings from side to side:
X Do not accelerate under any circumstances
X Do not countersteer
X Brake, if necessary
Towing a trailer
197
Folding out the ball coupling
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not correctly engaged,
the trailer can detach. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always engage the ball coupling as described.
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
X
X
Pull out release wheel =.
Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise as far as
it will go.
The ball coupling disengages and folds out
behind the rear bumper. Indicator lamp ?
flashes.
Before you can tow a trailer with your vehicle,
you must fold out the ball coupling.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the luggage compartment.
Pull the ball coupling in the direction of the
arrow until it engages in a vertical position.
The indicator lamp on the release wheel goes
out. The power socket folds down automatically.
The multifunction display shows the Check
trailer hitch lock display message until
the ball coupling is engaged.
X Remove the protective cap from the ball coupling and store it in a safe place.
X Make sure that the ball of the ball coupling is
clean and that it is either greased or dry
(grease free), depending on the instructions
for the trailer.
X
X
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise, the fold down and remove
cover ;.
Folding in the ball coupling
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
Z
Driving and parking
Folding out the ball coupling
Towing a trailer
198
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Driving and parking
i Fold the ball coupling in if you are not using
the trailer tow hitch.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
the trailer cables are disconnected.
X Place the protective cap on the ball coupling.
X
i The release wheel is located behind the left-
hand side trim panel in the luggage compartment.
X To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise, then fold down and remove
cover ;.
X
X
X
Pull out release wheel =.
Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise as far as
it will go.
The ball coupling disengages and folds out
behind the rear bumper. Indicator lamp ?
flashes.
Press the ball coupling until it engages audibly
behind the bumper.
The indicator lamp on the release knob and
the message in the multifunction display go
out.
Coupling up a trailer
Make sure that the transmission is in position
P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Position the trailer horizontally behind the
vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X Establish the electric connection between the
vehicle and the trailer.
X Check that the trailer lighting system is working.
A connected trailer is only recognised when
the electrical connection is established correctly and when the lighting system is working
properly. The function of other systems, such
as ESP® or PARKTRONIC also depends on
this.
X
Uncoupling a trailer
G WARNING
If you uncouple a trailer with an engaged overrun brake, you could trap your hand between
the vehicle and the trailer drawbar. This poses
a risk of injury.
Do not uncouple a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake.
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake. Otherwise, your vehicle could
be damaged by the rebounding of the overrun
brake.
! Remove the installed adapter cable before
folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear bumper and the
adapter cable.
X Make sure that the transmission is in position
P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Secure the trailer against rolling away.
X Remove the trailer cable and decouple the
trailer.
Trailer power supply
! You can connect accessories to the perma-
nent power supply up to a maximum of 240 W.
You cannot charge a trailer battery using the
power supply.
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's trailer
socket is equipped with a permanent power
supply and a power supply that is switched on
via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin 10.
The trailer's permanent power supply is
switched off in the event of low vehicle supply
voltage and after six hours at the latest.
You can find more information about fitting the
trailer electrics at a qualified specialist workshop.
X To switch the connected power supply on
or off: turn the key to position 2or 0 respectively (Y page 133).
Towing a trailer
199
Failure check for LEDs
Driving and parking
If LED lamps are fitted in the trailer, a malfunction message may appear in the multifunction
display even if there is no fault. The reason for
the error message may be that the current has
fallen below the minimum of 50 mA.
To ensure reliable operation of the failure indicator, each LED chain in the trailer lighting must
be guaranteed a minimum current of 50 mA.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
General notes
Trailer with 7-pin connector: you can connect
to the 13-pin socket on the ball coupling using
an adapter or, if necessary, an adapter cable.
Both can be obtained at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Fitting the adapter
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable play
so that the cable cannot become detached
when cornering.
! Remove the installed adapter cable before
folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear bumper and the
adapter cable.
Open the socket cover.
Insert the plug connector with lug : into
groove = on the socket.
X Turn bayonet connection ; clockwise to the
stop.
X Let the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure the
cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
X
Z
200
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the on-board computer.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The on-board computer only shows messages or
warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make sure
your vehicle is operating safely at all times.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, park the vehicle safely as soon as possible. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
For an overview, see the instrument panel illustration (Y page 32).
Displays and operation
Instrument cluster lighting
The light sensor in the instrument cluster automatically controls the brightness of the multifunction display. In daylight, the displays in the
instrument cluster are not illuminated.
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can
be adjusted using the brightness control knob.
The brightness control knob is located on the
bottom left of the instrument cluster
(Y page 32).
X Turn the brightness control knob clockwise or
anti-clockwise.
If the light switch is set to the Ã, T or
L position, the brightness is dependent
upon the brightness of the ambient light.
Speedometer with segments
The speedometer is divided into segments on
vehicles with Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RVariable speed limiter is activated
(Y page 165):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected speed limitation.
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated
(Y page 167):
One or two segments in the stored speed
range light up.
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a vehicle in
front moving more slowly than the stored
speed:
The segments between the speed of the vehicle in front and the stored speed light up.
Rev counter
! Do not drive in the overrevving range. Doing
so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The engine is limited within a range to protect
the engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing
point.
Bear in mind that the outside temperature display indicates the measured air temperature
and not the road surface temperature.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 202).
Displays and operation
Operating the on-board computer
Overview
On-board computer and displays
There is a short delay before a change in outside
temperature appears in the multifunction display.
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the instrument cluster on the right-hand side (Y page 32).
Under normal operating conditions and with the
correct coolant level, the coolant temperature
may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving
in mountainous terrain, the coolant temperature
may rise to the end of the scale.
201
: Multifunction display
; Right control panel
= Left control panel
X
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using the
buttons on the multifunction steering wheel.
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects the
previous or next station, when the
preset list or station list is active,
or an audio track or video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone number
RSelects
Z
202
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
9
:
Press and hold:
the Audio menu: selects a preset list or a station list in the
desired frequency range, or an
audio track or video scene using
rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling if the phone
book is open
~
RRejects
6
RMakes
RIn
a
RConfirms
%
Press briefly:
or ends a call
the telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
Multifunction display
the selection or display
message
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RBack
RVehicles
with Audio 20: switches
off voice-operated control of the
navigation (see manufacturer's
operating instructions)
RVehicles with COMAND Online:
switches off LINGUATRONIC (see
the separate operating instructions)
RHides display messages or calls up
the last Trip menu function used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
%
Press and hold:
RCalls up the standard display in the
Trip menu
Right control panel
ó
with Audio 20:
Switches on voice-operated control for navigation (see manufacturer's operating instructions)
RVehicles with COMAND Online:
Switches off LINGUATRONIC (see
the separate operating instructions)
8
RMute
W
X
RAdjusts
RVehicles
the volume
: Permanent display: outside temperature or
;
=
?
A
B
speed (Y page 210)
Time
Text field
Menu bar
Drive program (Y page 144)
Transmission position (Y page 146)
Vehicles with manual transmission: the indicators in the lower part of the multifunction display
differ from those shown here.
For Mercedes-AMG vehicles, the indicators in
the lower and upper part of the multifunction
display differ from those shown here.
X To display menu bar?: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
If you do not press the buttons any longer,
menu bar ? is faded out after a few seconds.
Text field = shows the selected menu or submenu as well as display messages.
i Set the time using the multimedia system;
see the separate operating instructions.
Menus and submenus
RZ
Gearshift recommendation for manual
transmission (Y page 143) or for automatic
transmission (shifting manually)
(Y page 150)
Rj Parking Pilot (Y page 180)
R¯ Cruise control (Y page 162)
RÈ Limiter (Y page 165)
R_ Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 109)
Rè ECO start/stop function (Y page 137)
Rë HOLD function (Y page 172)
R120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
Menus and submenus
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the steering wheel until the Trip menu with trip
meter : and total distance recorder ;
appears.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
Menu overview
Using the = or ; button on the steering
wheel, open the menu bar.
Operating the on-board computer (Y page 201).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 203)
RNavi menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 205)
RAudio menu (Y page 206)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 207)
RAssist. menu (assistance) (Y page 208)
RServ. menu (Y page 210)
RSettings menu (settings) (Y page 210)
RAMG menu (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
(Y page 213)
The displays for the Audio
Audio, Navi and Tel menus
may differ slightly to those in your vehicle.
The examples given in this Owner's Manual
apply to vehicles equipped with COMAND
Online.
:
;
=
?
Distance
Driving time
Average speed
Average fuel consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
The values in the From start submenu are calculated from the start of a journey whilst the
values in the From reset submenu are calculated from the last time the submenu was reset
(Y page 204).
In the following cases, the trip computer is automatically reset From start:
start
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
When 9,999 hours or 99,999 kilometres have
been exceeded, the trip computer is automatically reset From reset.
reset
Z
On-board computer and displays
The following messages may appear in the
multifunction display:
203
204
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
ECO display
The ECO display is not available in MercedesAMG vehicles.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select ECO
DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 159).
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the menu only displays range :.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the display with
approximate range : and current fuel consumption ;.
Approximate range : that can be covered is
calculated according to your current driving
style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If
there is only a small amount of fuel left in the
fuel tank, a vehicle being refuelled C
appears instead of approximate range :.
Recuperation display = shows you if energy
has been recuperated from the kinetic energy
in overrun mode and saved in the battery.
Recuperation display = depends on the
engine installed and is therefore not available
in all vehicles.
Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select digital speedometer ;.
Gearshift recommendation : Z may also be
displayed.
Observe the information on gearshift recommendation : for manual transmission
(Y page 143) or for automatic transmission
(shifting manually) (Y page 150).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: a gearshift recommendation is shown in the status bar of the
multifunction display and not in the digital
speedometer display.
X
Resetting values
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : to select Yes and press a to
confirm.
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip meter
R"From start" trip computer
R"From reset" trip computer
RECO display
If you reset the values in the "ECO display", the
values in the "From start" trip computer are also
reset. If you reset the values in the "From start"
trip computer, the values in the "ECO display"
are also reset.
X
Menus and submenus
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows the navigation instructions.
You can find further information on navigation in
the separate multimedia system operating
instructions.
X Switch on the multimedia system; see separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Navi menu.
Route guidance not active
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Change of direction without lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is to be made, you
will see symbol = for the change of direction
and distance graphic ;. This shortens towards
the top of the display as you approach the point
of the announced change of direction. The
change of direction starts once the distance display reaches zero.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
: Road to which the change of direction leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Lanes not recommended
? Recommended lane and new lane during a
:
;
=
?
Distance to the destination
Distance to the next change of direction
Current road
Symbol indicating "follow the road's course"
change of direction
A Change-of-direction symbol
On multi-lane roads, new lane recommendations can be displayed for the next change of
direction if the digital map supports this data.
During the change of direction, new lanes may
be added.
Lane not recommended =: you will not be able
to complete the next change of direction if you
stay in this lane.
Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction ?: in this lane you will be
able to complete the next two changes of direction without changing lane.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Navigation menu
205
206
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
Other status indicators of the navigation system
To select a preset list or station list: press
and briefly hold the 9 or : button until
the preset list or station list in the desired
frequency range is shown.
X To select a station: briefly press 9
or :.
X
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio BroadcastThe navigation system displays additional information and the vehicle status.
Possible displays
route... or Calculating route...
A new route is calculated.
RRoad not mapped
The vehicle position is inside the area of the
digital map but the road is not recognised, e.g.
new roads, car parks or private land.
RNo route
No route could be calculated to the selected
destination.
RO
You have reached the destination or a stopover.
ing) is an optimised digital transmission
standard designed for the mobile reception of
radio transmissions.
Audio player or audio media operation
RNew
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
: Active station list
; Station with preset position
The multifunction display shows station ; with
station frequency or station name. The preset
position is only displayed in addition if station ;
has been stored.
X Switch on the multimedia system and select
radio; see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
: Current track
Audio files from various audio players or media
can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
X Switch on the multimedia system and activate
audio CD or MP3 mode; see the separate
operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track: briefly
press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list (rapid
scrolling): press and hold the 9 or :
button until the desired track appears.
If you press and hold the 9 or : button,
the rapid scrolling speed is increased. Not all
audio players or media support this function.
If track information is saved on the audio player
or media, the multifunction display will show the
number and title of the track.
DVD-Video operation
Menus and submenus
Telephone menu
Introduction
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the legal
requirements for the country in which you are
currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone, see the manufacturer's operating instructions.
X Switch on the multimedia system; see separate operating instructions.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile phone
bracket (Y page 277).
or
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to the multimedia system; see the separate operating
instructions.
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to the multimedia system; see the separate operating
instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Tel menu.
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RTelephone
ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found a
network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service
service: there is no network
available or the mobile phone is searching for
a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rat any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
Ron the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Accepting a call
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call at any time, even if you are
not in the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button on the steering wheel
to accept an incoming call.
Rejecting or ending a call
You can reject or end a call any time even if you
are not in the Tel menu.
X Press the ~ button on the steering wheel
to reject or end an incoming call.
Selecting an entry in the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Authorise access to the phone book on the
phone.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
or
X To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold the
9 or : button for longer than one second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X
Z
On-board computer and displays
Only for vehicles with COMAND Online: you can
use the Audio menu to play video DVDs.
X Switch on COMAND Online and select video
DVD (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene :
appears.
207
Menus and submenus
208
On-board computer and displays
X
or
If only one telephone number is stored for
a name: press the 6 or a button to
start dialling.
If there is more than one number for a
particular name:press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make the call: press
the ~ or % button.
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names or
numbers dialled in the redial memory.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the redial
memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make the call: press
the ~ or % button.
Assistance menu
Introduction
Depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle, you have the following options in the
Assist. menu:
RShowing the assistance graphic
(Y page 208)
RActivating/deactivating the Traffic Sign
Assist message function (Y page 208)
RDeactivating/activating ESP® (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles) (Y page 209)
RActivating/deactivating Active Brake Assist
(Y page 209)
RActivating/deactivating ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 209)
RActivating/deactivating
(Y page 209)
RActivating/deactivating
(Y page 209)
Blind Spot Assist
Lane Keeping Assist
Showing the assistance graphic
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assist.
graphic.
graphic
X Press a to confirm.
The multifunction display shows the distance
display of Distance Pilot DISTRONIC in the
assistance graphic.
The assistance graphic shows you the status
of and/or information from the following driving systems or driving safety systems:
RTraffic Sign Assist (Y page 190)
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 167)
RActive Brake Assist (Y page 67)
RATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 189)
RLane Keeping Assist (Y page 193)
X Press : to display the ATTENTION ASSIST
assessment.
X
Traffic Sign Assist
In the Traffic Sign Assist menu, you can
switch the Traffic Sign Assist message function
on or off. When the message function is activated, detected traffic signs and information
appear in the multifunction display for five seconds.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Traffic Sign Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate the message function: press a again.
Menus and submenus
Activating/deactivating ESP®
Observe the important safety notes on ESP®
(Y page 70).
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen using snow chains
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Deactivating/activating ESP® on MercedesAMG vehicles (Y page 71).
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 69).
X Start the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select ESP
ESP.
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a again.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ and å warning lamps light up
continuously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 252).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 217).
Activating/deactivating Active Brake
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Brake Assist.
Assist
X
Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a again.
When Active Brake Assist is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic display.
Further information on Active Brake Assist
(Y page 67).
X
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Attention Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Sensitive
Sensitive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic display.
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 189).
X
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a again.
X
Further information about Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 192).
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Lane Keeping Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X Press a again to confirm.
X
Z
On-board computer and displays
Further information about Traffic Sign Assist
(Y page 190).
209
Menus and submenus
210
Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When Lane Keeping Assist is activated, the
multifunction display shows the lane markings as bright lines in the assistance graphic.
For further information about Lane Keeping
Assist, see (Y page 193).
On-board computer and displays
X
Service menu
Depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle, you have the following options in the Serv.
menu:
RCalling up display messages in the message
memory (Y page 216)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 315)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 285)
Settings menu
Introduction
Depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle, in the Settings menu you have the following options:
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
RChanging the light settings
RChanging the vehicle settings
RChanging the heating settings
RChanging the convenience settings
RRestoring the factory settings
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
The Display unit Speed-/odometer: function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles in the multifunction display.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or miles
miles.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
The selected unit of measurement for distance
applies to the following:
Rdigital
speedometer in the Trip menu
distance recorder and the trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rcurrent fuel consumption and approximate
range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
Rspeed limiter
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rtotal
Switching the additional speedometer
on/off
United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
If the additional speedometer is switched on,
the speed is shown in the status bar of the multifunction display instead of the outside temperature.
The speed display is inverse to your speedometer.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dig. speedo [mph] function.
You will see the selected setting: on or off
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Selecting permanent display
United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
The Permanent display: function allows you
to choose whether the multifunction display
always shows the outside temperature or the
speed.
The speed display is inverse to your speedometer.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Menus and submenus
Lights
Switching the daytime driving lights
on/off
The Daytime driving lights function can
only be switched on with the engine turned off.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Daytime driving lights function.
If the Daytime driving lights function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
W symbol in the multifunction display are
shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Further information on daytime driving lights
(Y page 107).
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can set the permanent limiter using the
Limit speed (winter tyres): function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres): function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
permanent speed limiter in increments of ten
(160
160 km/h to 240 km/h).
km/h The Off setting
switches the permanent speed limiter off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
Further information on the permanent speed
limiter (Y page 166).
Activating/deactivating the automatic
locking feature
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door locks function.
If the Automatic door locks function is
switched on, the multifunction display shows
the doors in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
If you activate the Automatic door locks
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a
speed of around 15 km/h.
For further information on the automatic locking
feature; see (Y page 85).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function, an
acoustic signal sounds when you lock the vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display
lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Heating
Auxiliary heating departure time
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extracZ
On-board computer and displays
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display: function.
The current setting, outside temperature
or Dig. speedo [mph]:,
[mph]: appears.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
211
On-board computer and displays
212
Menus and submenus
tion system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rthe
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventilation
draws on the vehicle battery. After you have
heated or ventilated the vehicle a maximum of
two times, drive for a longer distance.
Only vehicles with auxiliary heating have this
function.
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates
the switch-on time according to the outside
temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by
the departure time. When the departure time is
reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat
for a further five minutes and then switches off.
The auxiliary heating adopts the set air conditioning or THERMOTRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by using
the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
Further information on auxiliary heating
(Y page 126).
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The current setting appears.
X Press a again.
X Press the : or 9 button to select one
of the three departure times or Timer off (no
timer active).
X Press a to confirm.
If a departure time is selected, the yellow
indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary heating button.
X
Changing the departure time
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The current setting appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Change A,
A Change B or Change C.
C
X Press a to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
X
Comfort
Switching belt adjustment on/off
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X
Menus and submenus
For further information on belt adjustment, see
(Y page 43).
Switching the fold mirrors in when locking function on/off
This function is only available when the vehicle is
equipped with the electrical fold-in function.
When you activate the Auto. fold-in mir‐
rors function, the exterior mirrors are folded in
when the vehicle is locked. When you unlock the
vehicle and then open the driver's or frontpassenger door, the exterior mirrors fold out
again.
If you have switched on the Auto. fold-in
mirrors function and you fold in the exterior
mirrors using the button on the door
(Y page 104), they will not fold out automatically. The exterior mirrors can then only be folded out using the button on the door.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold-in mirrors function.
If the Auto. fold-in mirrors function is
switched on, the multifunction display shows
the exterior mirror in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Resetting to factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? function
appears.
X
Press the : or 9 button to select No or
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function of
the permanent speed limiter can only be set in
the Vehicle submenu.
X
AMG menu (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Warm-up
:
;
=
?
A
B
X
Digital speedometer
Gear indicator
Upshift indicator
Engine oil temperature
Coolant temperature
Transmission oil temperature
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator: upshift indicator UP =
indicates that the engine has reached the
overrevving range when in the manual drive
program.
Engine and transmission oil temperature:
when the engine and transmission are at normal operating temperature, oil temperature ? and B are displayed in white in the
multifunction display.
If the multifunction display shows oil temperature ? or B in blue, the engine or the
transmission are not yet at normal operating
temperature. Avoid using the full output of the
engine during this time.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is activated, the seat belt is displayed in orange in
the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
213
214
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
SETUP
Drive system Comfort
Comfort/Sport
Sport/Sport
Sport +
Suspension Comfort
Comfort/Sport
Sport/Sport
Sport +
Transmission D/M
M
ESP® On
On/Off
Off or SPORT handling mode
Sport
SETUP displays the following information and
functions:
Rthe digital speedometer
Rthe gear indicator
Rthe drive system setting
Rthe suspension mode
Rthe transmission position
Rthe ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) status
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press 9 repeatedly until SETUP appears.
:
;
=
?
You can start the RACETIMER when the engine is
running or if the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER appears.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
Displaying the intermediate time
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is shown for five seconds.
X
Starting a new lap
RACE TIMER
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
Lap
: Lap
; RACETIMER
i A maximum of 16 laps may be stored. The
The RACETIMER is only intended for use on a
closed race circuit. Do not use the function on
public roads.
Stopping the RACETIMER
16th lap can only be completed with Finish
Lap
Lap.
Menus and submenus
Press the % button on the steering wheel.
Confirm Yes with a.
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop the
vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position 3 and
then press a to confirm Start
Start, timing is
continued.
Resetting the current lap
Stop the RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
Lap
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
X
X
= Average speed
? Distance covered
A Maximum speed
This function is shown if you have stored at least
one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation appears.
Lap evaluation
Deleting all laps
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is
reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If you
have stopped 16 laps, the current lap does not
have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset
Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and press
the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
:
;
=
?
A
Lap
Lap time
Average lap speed
Lap length
Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have stored
at least two laps and have stopped the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until a lap
evaluation appears.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu. The
fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a different lap evaluation.
Overall evaluation
: RACETIMER overall evaluation
; Total time driven
Z
On-board computer and displays
X
X
215
Display messages
216
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ from
the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some high-priority
display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been rectified, these
display messages are deleted as well.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD function (Y page 172)
RParking (Y page 155)
Hiding display messages
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
The multifunction display hides the display message.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display
messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages
have been remedied.
X
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call up
the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages,
messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
Display messages
217
Safety systems
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), BAS (Brake Assist System), ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program), ESP® trailer stabilisation, the HOLD
currently unavaila‐ function, hill start assist and PRE-SAFE® are temporarily unavailable.
ble See Owner's Man‐
Adaptive brake lights and Active Brake Assist may have also failed.
ual
In addition, the !, ÷ and å warning lamps may light up in
the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes:
RSelf-diagnosis is not yet complete.
RThe on-board voltage may be insufficient.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake
hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering
movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above
are available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
!÷
ABS, BAS, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and PRE-SAFE® are unavailable due to a malfunction.
inoperative See Own‐ Adaptive brake lights and Active Brake Assist may have also failed.
er's Manual
The !, ÷, å and J warning lamps may also light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake
hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
218
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start
assist and PRE-SAFE® are temporarily unavailable.
currently unavaila‐ Adaptive brake lights and Active Brake Assist may have also failed.
ble See Owner's Man‐
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps may light up in the
ual
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making gentle steering
movements at speeds of above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above
are available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
÷
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start
assist and PRE-SAFE® are unavailable due to a malfunction.
inoperative See Own‐ Adaptive brake lights and Active Brake Assist may have also failed.
er's Manual
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps may light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
T!
÷
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, BAS, ESP®, ESP® trailer
stabilisation, the HOLD function, hill start assist and PRE-SAFE® are
unavailable due to a malfunction.
inoperative See Own‐ Adaptive brake lights and Active Brake Assist may have also failed.
A warning tone sounds.
er's Manual
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps may light up in
the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock
if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
!
The red ! indicator lamp lights up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition
was switched off.
X Key: turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
X KEYLESS-GO: switch on the ignition.
!
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds. A
condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not
fulfilled (Y page 157).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
Turn on the igni‐
tion to release the
parking brake
Release parking
brake
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are making an emergency stop using the electric parking brake
(Y page 157).
!
Parking brake See
Owner's Manual
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
Press the electric parking brake lever for at least ten seconds.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to
position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
219
220
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red ! indicator lamp are lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
or
Turn the ignition off and then back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
Vehicles with manual transmission (automatic emergency
release):insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate
slightly more when pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 157).
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
Do not drive on.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning lamp
is lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Turn the ignition off and then back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Turn the ignition off and then back on.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red ! indicator lamp continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 319).
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to
position P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the kerb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator lamp
flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake has been
applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Turn the ignition off and then back on.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
If you cannot apply the electric parking brake:
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to
position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake:
X Vehicles with manual transmission (automatic emergency
release):insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate
slightly more when pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 157).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red ! indicator lamp
flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. The electric parking
brake cannot be applied manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: switch off the ignition.
The electric parking brake is applied automatically.
or
X Insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate slightly more
when pulling away (automatic emergency release).
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to
position P, as the electric parking brake is not applied automatically.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If you do not wish the electric parking brake to be applied, leave the
ignition switched on, e.g. when washing the vehicle in an automatic
car wash or when having the vehicle towed.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
221
On-board computer and displays
222
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator lamp
flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake has been
applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by charging the battery or restarting the engine.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
Parking brake inop‐
erative
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied or released:
X Turn the ignition off and then back on.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning lamp
is lit.
The electric parking brake cannot be applied manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to
position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
J
Brake immediately
Vehicles with manual transmission: a malfunction has occurred while
the HOLD function was activated.
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. If you attempt to lock the
vehicle, the tone becomes louder.
You cannot start the engine.
X Paying attention to the traffic situation, immediately depress the
brake pedal firmly and hold until the display message disappears.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
You can restart the engine.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up on the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
Check brake fluid
level
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
#
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
G
One or more main features of the Mercedes-Benz Contact system are
malfunctioning.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Brake Assist
Functions currently
limited See Owner's
Manual
Active Brake Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RThe system is outside the operating temperature range.
RThe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Brake Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Restart the engine.
Check brake pad wear
Inoperative
Active Brake Assist is unavailable due to a malfunction. The situationActive Brake
Assist: System inop‐ dependent braking assistance function may also have failed.
erative
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
PRE-SAFE inopera‐
tive See Owner's
Manual
Important PRE-SAFE® functions have failed. All other occupant safety
systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
224
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Radar sensors dirty
See Owner's Manual
The radar sensor system is malfunctioning.
Possible causes:
RDirt on sensors
RHeavy rain or snow
RDriving on inter-urban roads without traffic or infrastructure, e.g. in
desert-like areas
At least one driving system or driving safety system is malfunctioning
or is temporarily unavailable:
RActive Brake Assist
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the driving and
driving safety systems will be available again. The display message
disappears.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Switch off the engine.
X Clean all sensors (Y page 289).
X Restart the engine.
The display message disappears.
ü
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt tongue
has been inserted into a rear seat belt buckle.
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 44).
ý
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt tongue
has not been inserted in a rear seat belt buckle.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or which has not been engaged
in the seat belt buckle correctly, cannot provide the intended level of
protection.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat belts
(Y page 43).
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 44).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The restraint system is malfunctioning. The 6 warning lamp also
lights up on the instrument cluster.
Restraint sys. mal‐
function Consult
workshop
6
Front left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Front right
malfunction Consult
workshop
6
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Rear right
malfunction Consult
workshop
6
Left windowbag mal‐
function Consult
workshop or Right
windowbag malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally
or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information about the restraint system (Y page 39).
The front left or right restraint system is malfunctioning. The 6
warning lamp also lights up on the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally
or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The rear left or right restraint system is malfunctioning. The 6
warning lamp also lights up on the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally
or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The left-hand or right-hand windowbag is malfunctioning. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The left-hand or right-hand windowbag may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, not triggered at all.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
226
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front-passenger
airbag disabled See
Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag is disabled during the journey
although:
Ran adult
or
Ra person of the corresponding stature is on the front-passenger seat
If additional forces are applied to the seat, the weight the system
detects may be too low.
G WARNING
The front-passenger front airbag does not deploy during an accident.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Have the occupant on the front-passenger seat step out of the
vehicle.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the front-passenger
door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
RA self-diagnosis is carried out. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps light up simultaneously
for approximately six seconds
RThe PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must then light up
and remain lit after the self-diagnosis. If the indicator lamp is on,
the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
has disabled the front-passenger front airbag (Y page 47)
RThe Front-passenger airbag enabled See Owner's Man‐
ual or Front-passenger airbag disabled See Owner's
Manual display messages must not be shown in the multifunction
display
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system
checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear on the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied
again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF or ON indicator lamp
remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 47).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front-passenger
airbag enabled See
Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag is enabled during the journey
although:
Ra child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system
weight threshold is located on the front-passenger seat
or
Rthe front-passenger seat is not occupied
The system may detect objects or forces that are placing additional
weight on the seat.
G WARNING
The airbag may deploy unintentionally.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Open the front-passenger door.
X Remove the child and child seat from the front-passenger seat.
X Make sure that no objects are present that are applying additional
weight to the seat.
The system might otherwise detect the additional weight and interpret the seat occupant's weight as greater than it actually is.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the front-passenger
door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
RA self-diagnosis is carried out. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps light up simultaneously
for approximately six seconds
RThe PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must then light up
and remain lit after the self-diagnosis. If the indicator lamp is on,
the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
has disabled the front-passenger front airbag (Y page 47)
RThe Front-passenger airbag enabled See Owner's Man‐
ual or Front-passenger airbag disabled See Owner's
Manual display messages must not be shown in the multifunction
display
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system
checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear on the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied
again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF or ON indicator lamp
remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
Z
227
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
228
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 47).
Lights
i Vehicles with LED light bulbs in the light clusters:
The display message for the corresponding lamp only appears when all the LEDs in the lamp have
failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Left cornering
light or Right cor‐
nering light
b
Left dipped beam or
Right dipped beam
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions.
b
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
X Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions.
b
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions.
Trailer left tail
lamporTrailer
lamp
Trailer right
tail lamp
Trailer left turn
signalorTrailer
signal
Trailer
right turn signal
Trailer brake lamp
b
Rear left indicator
or Rear right indi‐
cator
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
b
Left mirror indica‐
tor or Right mirror
indicator
b
Third brake lamp
b
Left brake
lamporRight
lamp
Right brake
lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
Left-hand tail lamp/
(Y page 111).
brake lamp or Rightor
hand tail lamp/
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
brake lamp
b
Left main beam or
Right main beam
The left or right-hand main-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand licence plate lamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Number plate lamp
Rear fog lamp
Front left parking
lamp or Front right
parking lamp
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
229
On-board computer and displays
230
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
Reversing light
The reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Left tail lamp or
Right tail lamp
b
The left or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
Left daytime driv‐
(Y page 111).
ing lamp or Right
or
daytime driving lamp
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The exterior lighting is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Malfunction See Own‐
er's Manual
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Check the fuses (Y page 308).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes as
you do so.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The light sensor is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A warning
tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to the à position.
b
You are driving without dipped-beam headlamps.
X Turn the light switch to the L or à position.
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Switch off lights
Switch on headlamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
Possible causes:
unavailable See Own‐
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
er's Manual
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again, the
Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message is displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is operational again.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
X
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 283).
If you have to top up the coolant frequently:
X
?
Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the engine cooling
system checked.
The fan motor is faulty.
If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, drive on to the nearest
qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
X
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
231
On-board computer and displays
232
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine has
overheated can cause any fluids that may have leaked into the engine
compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Wait until the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked,
e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out and
the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may otherwise
be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature gauge.
If the temperature increases again:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
#
See Owner's Manual
The battery is no longer being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty alternator
Rtorn poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is no longer being charged and the battery charge level is
too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Observe the instructions in the # See Owner's Manual display
message.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
4
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
Stop vehicle See
Owner's Manual
Check eng. oil lev.
when next refuelling ! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling
system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest (Y page 282).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 283).
If you have to top up the engine oil frequently:
Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the engine
checked.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedesbenz.com.
X
4
Add 1 litre engine
oil when next refu‐
elling
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling
system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest (Y page 282).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 283).
If you have to top up the engine oil frequently:
Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the engine
checked.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedesbenz.com.
X
4
Engine oil level
Stop vehicle Switch
engine off
The engine oil level is too low. There is a risk of engine damage.
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Check the engine oil level (Y page 282).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 283).
X
Z
233
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
234
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
æ
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level drops
into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ç
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated.
X You must refuel at the nearest filling station.
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must be
replaced.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The water
must be drained off.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Reserve fuel level
Replace air cleaner
Clean the fuel fil‐
ter
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue or
increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver. A warning
tone also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you get
enough rest.
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
ë
Off
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle has started to skid.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 172).
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is no longer fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 172).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Lane Keeping Assist Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
currently unavaila‐ Possible causes:
ble See Owner's Man‐
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
ual
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
RThere have been no lane markings for an extended period.
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Lane Keeping Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Clean the windscreen.
Lane Keeping Assist
inoperative
Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavaila‐ Possible causes:
ble See Owner's Man‐
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
ual
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RThe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature range
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Restart the engine.
Active Blind Spot
Assist not availa‐
ble when towing a
trailer See Owner's
Manual.
Manual
Blind Spot Assist is deactivated while towing a trailer.
You have established the electrical connection between the trailer and
your vehicle.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative
Blind Spot Assist is malfunctioning.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Pilot can‐
celled
The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been fastened.
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
235
236
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while
steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Parking Pilot again later (Y page 180).
Parking Pilot inop‐
erative
You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking manoeuvres.
Parking Pilot will become available again after approximately ten
minutes (Y page 180).
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Parking Pilot ended
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
Traffic Sign Assist Traffic Sign Assist is temporarily inoperative.
currently unavaila‐ Possible causes:
ble See Owner's Man‐
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
ual
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display
message disappears.
Traffic Sign Assist is operational again.
Traffic Sign Assist
inoperative
Traffic Sign Assist is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Distance Pilot off
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated (Y page 167).
If it was not deactivated by the driver, a warning tone also sounds.
Distance Pilot
available again
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC (Y page 167).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Distance Pilot cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RThe system is outside the operating temperature range.
RThe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Restart the engine.
Distance Pilot inop‐ Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is faulty. The situation-dependent braking
assistance function may also have failed.
erative
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Distance Pilot pas‐
sive
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
is no longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
Distance Pilot
- - - km/h
A condition for activating Distance Pilot DISTRONIC has not been met.
X Check the activation conditions for Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
(Y page 167).
Distance Pilot and
Limiter inoperative
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and speed limiter are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
Limiter inoperative
Cruise control and speed limiter are faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Limiter passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown), the limiter is switched to passive mode.
The speed limitation is not active.
X Drive slower than the stored speed and without kickdown.
X Call up the last speed stored again.
or
X Set a new speed.
When the display message disappears, the speed limitation is active.
Z
237
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
238
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Cruise control
- - - km/h
RA
condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
RESP® is deactivated The yellow ESP® OFF warning lamp is lit.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the speed.
or
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 162).
or
X Reactivate ESP® (Y page 209).
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
120 km/h!
Maximum speed excee‐ In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!.
km/h!
ded
X Drive more slowly.
Display messages
239
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure Check
tyre(s)
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant loss
in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the positions of the wheels and tyres or fitted new
wheels and tyres
Rthe tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly
impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be
greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat
tyre (Y page 294).
X Check and, if necessary, correct the tyre pressures.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre pressure is correct (Y page 315).
Check tyre pres‐
sures then restart
Run Flat Indicator
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
Rectify tyre pres‐
sure
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message
and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 315).
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 315).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 317).
Z
On-board computer and displays
Tyres
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly. The
wheel position appears in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
On-board computer and displays
240
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly
impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be
greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat
tyre (Y page 294).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 315).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Warning tyre defect
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position appears in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra flat tyre impairs the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
Ryou could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat build-up
and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat
tyre (Y page 294).
Tyre press. monitor
currently unavaila‐
ble
No signals can be received from the tyre pressure sensors due to
strong RF interference. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily malfunctioning.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several tyres.
The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the multifunction
display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. monitor
inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The tyre
pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated after driving for a few
minutes.
Tyre press. monitor
inoperative
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Depress brake to
start engine
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in position N without depressing the brake pedal.
X Depress the brake pedal.
To shift out of P
or N, depress brake
and start engine
You have attempted to shift the transmission to position R or D without starting the engine.
X Start the engine.
X Depress the brake pedal.
i It is only possible to shift the transmission from position P to the
desired position if you depress the brake pedal. Only then can the
parking lock be deactivated. If you do not depress the brake pedal,
the DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved but the parking lock
remains engaged.
i At transmission fluid temperatures below Ò20 † you can only shift
out of position P into another transmission position when the
engine is running.
Apply brake to dese‐ You have attempted to shift the transmission to position R, N or D
lect Park (P) posi‐ without depressing the brake pedal.
tion
X Depress the brake pedal.
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
242
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Risk of vehicle
rolling Transmis‐
sion not in P
The driver's door is open or not fully closed and the transmission is in
position R, N or D.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The vehicle may roll away.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Close the driver's door fully.
Without changing
gear, consult work‐
shop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
X
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Only select Park
(P) when vehicle is
stationary
The vehicle is moving.
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
Apply brake to
select R
You have attempted to shift from position D or N to position R.
X Shift the transmission to position R when the brake pedal is
depressed.
Reversing not poss.
Consult workshop
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning. You cannot drive in
reverse.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Transmission Mal‐
function
X
Transmission Mal‐
function Stop
X
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning.
Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Stop vehicle Shift
to P Leave engine
running
The automatic transmission has overheated.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the automatic transmission is
available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Wait until the automatic transmission has cooled down and the display message goes out.
X
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer being
charged.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Until then, always shift the transmission to position P before you
switch off the engine.
X Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
Clutch overheated
Avoid pulling away
If necessary,
quickly release and
engage the clutch
The clutch is under considerable load and the permitted operating
temperature has been exceeded. A warning tone also sounds.
Avoid frequent pulling away and driving at walking pace over longer
distances.
X Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Leave the engine running.
The clutch is cooled more quickly with the engine running.
or
X If possible, drive on at a steady speed.
X Remove your foot from the clutch pedal and do not allow the clutch
to slip.
The clutch may also cool down during the journey.
It may take several minutes for it to cool down. When the clutch has
cooled down, the display message disappears. The clutch is fully
operational again.
For engine start
depress clutch
You have attempted to start the engine without depressing the clutch
pedal.
X Depress the clutch pedal.
X Restart the engine.
The engine has stalled while pulling away, e.g. because the clutch
pedal was released too quickly.
X Depress the clutch pedal again.
The engine starts automatically.
X Slowly release the clutch pedal to pull away.
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
244
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Trans. oil overhea‐
ted Drive on with
care
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the transmission oil has overheated.
Manual drive program M and the temporarily active manual drive program are no longer available. Engine power output is reduced.
X Allow the vehicle to cool down.
4matic currently
unavailable
4MATIC has overheated. The vehicle is only driven by the front wheels.
X Drive on.
The airflow cools 4MATIC more quickly.
When the display message goes out, 4MATIC is available again and
the vehicle is driven by all four wheels.
4matic inoperative
4MATIC is malfunctioning. The vehicle is only driven by the front
wheels.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
M
The bonnet is open.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Close the bonnet.
Active bonnet mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
C
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a malfunction or because it has already been triggered.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
Close all doors.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
j
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Check trailer hitch
lock
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not engaged, the trailer may come loose. There
is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Engage the ball coupling of the trailer tow hitch in the end position
(Y page 197).
&
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 126).
X Drive for a considerable distance.
The battery charges. The auxiliary heating is operational again as
soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
&
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank. The auxiliary heating cannot be
switched on (Y page 126).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
inoperative Battery
Low
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
&
The auxiliary heating is temporarily malfunctioning or faulty.
If the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled down:
inoperative See Own‐
X Make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting
er's Man.
several minutes between each attempt (Y page 126).
If the auxiliary heating does not switch on:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Ð
Power steering mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra steering force
required.
If you are able to steer safely:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
If you are unable to steer safely:
X
X
Do not drive on.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
246
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Ð
The electric steering lock is malfunctioning.
Steering malfunc‐
tion See Owner's
Manual
_
Before starting the
engine, turn the
steering wheel.
G WARNING
The steering may be locked by the electric steering lock.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Do not drive on.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The electric steering lock was unable to unlock the steering.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X To unlock the steering, move the steering wheel slightly.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock again.
Telephone No service Your vehicle is outside the mobile phone network provider's transmitter/receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol appears
in the multifunction display.
¥
Top up washer fluid
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below
the minimum.
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 284).
Wiper malfunction‐
ing
The windscreen wipers are defective.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Hazard warning
lamps malfunction‐
ing
The hazard warning lamps are faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not belong
to vehicle
Â
Replace key
Â
Change key batteries
The key needs to be replaced.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The key battery is discharged.
X Change the battery(Y page 79).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Locate the key.
Key not detected
(red display message)
Because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves, the
key is not detected whilst the engine is running.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and bring into key mode.
Â
Key not detected
(white display message)
The key is currently undetected.
Change the location of the key in the vehicle.
X
If the key still cannot be detected:
Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
X
Â
The key is continually undetected.
The key detection function has a temporary malfunction or is faulty. A
Remove starting but‐ warning tone also sounds.
ton, then insert key
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired position.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
General notes
Some systems perform a self test when the ignition is switched on. Some warning and indicator
lamps may temporarily switch on or flash during the test. This behaviour is nothing to be concerned
about.
The warning and indicator lamps will alert you to a malfunction if they switch on or flash after the
engine is started or while driving.
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
248
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety
On-board computer and displays
Seat belts
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
N Only for certain countries: the red seat belt warning lamp lights up for 6 seconds
after the engine starts.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten their
seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 43).
ü
N Only for certain countries: the red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the
engine starts. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up to 6 seconds.
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 43).
The warning tone ceases.
ü
N The red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the engine starts, as soon as the
driver's or the front-passenger door is closed.
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 43).
The warning lamp goes out.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure
place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
N The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent audible warning
sounds.
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the same time, you are
driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 43).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time, you are driving
faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure
place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
249
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
N The red brake system warning lamp lights up while the engine is running. A
warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be
affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
J
N The red brake system warning lamp lights up while the engine is running. A
warning tone also sounds.
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not correct the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Safety systems
On-board computer and displays
250
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
N The yellow ABS warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) has been deactivated due to a fault. BAS (Brake
Assist), Active Brake Assist, ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), ESP® trailer stabilisation, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and
PRE‑SAFE® are also deactivated, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired as a result.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other systems, such
as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
N The yellow ABS warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. BAS, Active Brake Assist, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, EBD (Electronic Brake-force Distribution), the HOLD function, hill start
assist, the adaptive brake lights and PRE‑SAFE®, for example, are also deactivated.
Possible causes:
RSelf-diagnosis is not yet complete.
RThe on-board voltage may be insufficient.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired as a result.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements
at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the warning lamp goes
out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
!
N The yellow ABS warning lamp lights up while the engine is running. A warning
tone also sounds.
EBD is faulty. ABS, BAS, Active Brake Assist, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, the
HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and PRE‑SAFE®, for
example, are also unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired as a result.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
252
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
֌
J
N The red brake system warning lamp and the yellow ABS, ESP® and ESP® OFF
warning lamps are lit while the drive system is running.
ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning. BAS, Active Brake Assist, EBD, PRE‑SAFE®, the
HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example, are also unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired as a result.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
N The yellow ESP® warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion.
ESP® or traction control has engaged due to a risk of skidding or because at least
one wheel has started to spin.
Cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
In exceptional cases (Y page 71) it may be better to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 70).
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
å
N The yellow ESP® OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
ESP® is deactivated. ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle if it starts to skid or if a
wheel starts to spin.
G WARNING
If ESP® is deactivated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Further driving systems or driving safety systems are thus restricted.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Reactivate ESP®.
In exceptional cases (Y page 71) it may be better to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 70).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop immediately and have the ESP® system
checked.
M
N Mercedes-AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Only switch to SPORT handling mode in accordance with the conditions described in the "Activating/deactivating ESP®" section (Y page 71).
֌
N The yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamps are lit while the engine is running.
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, Active Brake Assist, the HOLD function, hill
start assist, the adaptive brake lights and PRE‑SAFE® are not available due to a
malfunction.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
254
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
N The yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamps are lit while the engine is running.
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist and PRESAFE® are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and Active Brake Assist may also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Increased risk of skidding and/or accident!
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements
at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the warning lamp goes
out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
!
N The red indicator lamp for the electric parking brake flashes or lights up and/or
the yellow warning lamp for the electric parking brake lights up.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
6
N The red restraint system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The restraint system is malfunctioning.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the
event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop immediately and have the restraint system checked.
Further information about the restraint system (Y page 39).
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
255
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
N The yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
There may be a fault with the following, for example:
REngine management
RFuel injection system
RExhaust system
RIgnition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
RFuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be running in
emergency mode.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry (Y page 155).
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency mode is
cancelled. The vehicle does not have to be checked.
æ
N The yellow reserve fuel warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level drops into the
reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
?
N The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running and the
coolant temperature gauge is at the start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is malfunctioning.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. The engine could be damaged if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions,
and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Engine
On-board computer and displays
256
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
N The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may be blocked or
the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is not being cooled sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions,
and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has
cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, making sure to observe the
warning notes (Y page 283).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine cooling system
checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by frozen
slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The
engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain
and stop-start traffic.
?
N The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running. A warning
tone also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the engine radiator
may be blocked or the coolant level may be too low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine has overheated
can cause any fluids that may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch
fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns, which can
occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions,
and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has
cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, making sure to observe the
warning notes (Y page 283).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine cooling system
checked.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by frozen
slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue driving to the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain
and stop-start traffic.
X
Driving systems
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
N The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion.
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed selected.
X Increase the distance.
·
N The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion. A warning
tone also sounds.
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line of travel at too
high a speed.
X Be prepared to brake immediately.
X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to brake or take
evasive action.
Further information on the distance warning function of Active Brake Assist
(Y page 67).
Z
On-board computer and displays
Warning/
indicator
lamp
257
258
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Tyres
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
N The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction) is
lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at least one of the
tyres.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly
impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking manoeuvres.
Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat tyre
(Y page 294).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 315).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rthe
h
N The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction)
flashes for approximately one minute and then remains lit.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to detect or register low tyre pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Operating system
The section on the multimedia system in this
manual describes the basic principles for operation. More information can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the multimedia system.
The multimedia system calculates the route to
the destination without taking the following into
account, for example:
Rtraffic lights
Rstop and give way signs
Rparking or stopping restrictions
Rroad narrowing
Rother road and traffic rules and regulations
The multimedia system may give incorrect driving recommendations if the actual road/traffic
situation does not correspond with the digital
map data.
For example:
Ra diverted route
Rthe road layout or the direction of a one-way
street has been changed
For this reason, you must always observe road
and traffic rules and regulations during your
journey. Road and traffic rules and regulations
always have priority over multimedia system
driving recommendations.
Function restrictions
For safety reasons, some functions are restricted or unavailable while the vehicle is in motion.
You will notice this, for example, because either
you will not be able to select certain menu items
or a message will appear to this effect.
Operating system
Overview
General notes
! Do not use the space in front of the display
for storage. Objects placed here could damage the display or impair its function. Avoid
any direct contact with the display surface.
Pressure on the display surface may result in
impairments to the display, which could be
irreversible.
Wearing polarised sunglasses may impair your
ability to read the display.
The display has an automatic temperature-controlled switch-off feature. The brightness is
automatically reduced if the temperature is too
high. If necessary, the display may temporarily
switch off completely.
Cleaning instructions
! Do not touch the display. The display has a
very sensitive high-gloss surface; there is a
risk of scratching. If you have to clean the
screen, however, use a mild cleaning agent
and a soft, lint-free cloth.
The display must be switched off and have
cooled down before you start cleaning. Do not
apply pressure to the display surface when
cleaning it, as this could cause irreversible damage to the display.
Switching the multimedia system
on/off
X
Press the q control knob.
Z
Multimedia system
General notes
259
Operating system
260
Adjusting the volume
Back button
Turn the q control knob.
The volume changes:
Rfor the currently set media source
Rduring a traffic announcement or navigation
message
Rin hands-free mode during an active call
You can use the % button to exit a menu or to
call up the basic display of the current operating
mode.
X To exit the menu: briefly press the %
button.
The multimedia system changes to the next
higher menu level in the current operating
mode.
X To call up the basic display: press the %
button for longer than two seconds.
The multimedia system changes to the basic
display of the current operating mode.
X
Switching the sound on/off
Press the 8 button on the control panel.
If the audio output is switched off, the status
line will show the 8 symbol. If you switch
the media source or change the volume, the
sound is automatically switched on.
i You will hear navigation messages even
when the sound is muted.
Multimedia system
X
Functions
The multimedia system has the following functions:
RRadio mode
RMedia mode with media search
RSound systems
RNavigation system
COMAND Online: navigation using hard drive
Audio 20: navigation using SD memory card
RCommunication functions
RVehicle functions with system settings
RFavourites functions
Favourites
Calling up and exiting favourites
To call up: press the g button on the controller.
X Select a favourite, e. g. Vehicle
Vehicle.
The favourites are displayed.
X To exit: press the g button again.
X
Adding favourites
Adding a predefined favourite
Controller
The controller in the centre console lets you:
menu items on the display
Renter characters
Rselect a destination on the map
Rsave entries
The controller can be:
Rturned 3
Rslid left or right 1
Rslid forwards or back 4
Rslid diagonally 2
Rpressed briefly or pressed and held 7
Rselect
:
;
=
?
To add a new favourite
To rename a selected favourite
To move a selected favourite
To delete a selected favourite
Press the g button.
Slide 6 the controller.
The menu bar is shown.
X Select Reassign
Reassign.
The categories are displayed.
X Select a category.
The favourites are displayed.
X
X
Operating system
X
Select a favourite.
Add a favourite at the desired position.
If a favourite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
Adding your own favourite
Select Vehicle
VehicleQClimate
Climate control.
control
Press and hold the g button until the
favourites are displayed.
X Add a favourite at the desired position.
If a favourite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
X
X
Navigation mode
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the navigation system.
General notes
Correct functioning of the navigation system
depends, amongst other things, on GPS reception. In certain situations, GPS reception may be
impaired, there may be interference or there
may be no reception at all, e.g. in tunnels or
multi-storey car parks.
Audio 20 is equipped with Garmin® MAP PILOT
(see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
The Garmin® MAP PILOT operating instructions
are stored on the SD card as a PDF file. The SD
card box contains a quick guide.
The following descriptions apply to navigation
with COMAND Online. Further information can
be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Selecting a route type and route options
Multimedia system:
Select Navi
NaviQNavigation
Navigation.
The map displays the current vehicle position.
X Slide 6 the controller.
X Select Options
OptionsQRoute
Route settings.
settings
Notes for route types:
X
REco
route
route
Traffic reports on the route for the route guidance are taken into account (not available in
all countries).
RDynamic route only after request
You can decide whether or not current traffic
reports should be included in the route calculation (not available in all countries).
RCalculate alternative routes
Different routes are being calculated. In order
to do so, instead of Start
Start, select the menu
item Continue
Continue.
X To avoid/use route options: select Avoid
options.
options
X Select a route option.
Notes for route options:
RDynamic
RUse
toll roads
The route calculation includes roads which
require you to pay a usage fee (toll).
RUse vignette roads (not available in all
countries)
The route calculation includes roads which
require you to pay a time-based fee (vignette).
A vignette allows temporary use of the route
network, e. g. 10 days or 1 year.
Entering an address
Multimedia system:
Select Navi
NaviQNavigation
Navigation.
The map displays the current vehicle position.
X Slide 6 the controller.
X Select Destination
DestinationQAddress
Address entry.
entry
Enter an address, e.g. as follows:
Rtown or postcode, street, house number
Rcountry, town or postcode
Rtown or postcode, centre
Rstreet, town or postcode, junction
X
Z
Multimedia system
X
261
Operating system
262
Select Town
Town.
The town in which the vehicle is currently
located (current vehicle position) is at the top.
Below this, you will see locations for which
route guidance has already been carried out.
X Enter the town.
The G symbol: the location is contained on
the digital map multiple times.
X To switch to the list: slide 5 the controller.
X Select the location.
If available, the postcode is shown. If there
are different postcodes available for the location, the corresponding digits are displayed
with an X.
X Enter the street and house number.
The address is in the menu.
Further options for destination entry:
Multimedia system
X
Rsearch
for a keyword
The keyword search finds destinations using
fragments of words.
Rselect the last destination
Rselect a contact
Rselect a POI
You can search for a POI by location, name or
telephone number.
Rselect destination on the map
Renter intermediate destination
You can map the route to the destination
yourself with up to four intermediate destinations.
Rselect travel guide destination (only available
for selected European countries)
Rselect destinations from Mercedes-Benz
Apps
Rselect geo-coordinates
Calculating the route
Prerequisite: the address has been entered and
is in the menu.
X Select Start or Continue
Continue.
The route is calculated with the selected route
type and the selected route options.
If route guidance has already been activated,
a prompt will appear asking whether you wish
to end the current route guidance.
X Select Cancel current route guidance or
Set as intermediate destination.
destination
Cancel current route guidance cancels
the current route guidance and starts route
calculation to the new destination.
Set as intermediate destination adds
the new destination in addition to the existing
destination and opens the intermediate destinations list.
Connecting the mobile phone
Requirements
For telephony via the Bluetooth® interface, you
require a Bluetooth®-capable mobile phone. The
mobile phone must support Hands-Free Profile
1.0 or above.
Multimedia system:
Select Vehicle
VehicleQSystem
System set‐
tingsQActivate
tings
Activate Bluetooth
Bluetooth.
X Activate Bluetooth® O.
X
Mobile phone:
X
Activate Bluetooth® and, if necessary, Bluetooth® visibility for other devices (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
The Bluetooth® device names for all of one manufacturer's products might be identical. To
make it possible to clearly identify your mobile
phone, change the device name (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
If the mobile phone supports the PBAP (Phone
Book Access Profile) and MAP (Message
Access Profile) Bluetooth® profiles, the following information will be transmitted after you
connect:
RPhone book
RCall lists
RText messages and e-mails
i Further information on suitable mobile
phones can be found at: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Operating system
Before using your mobile phone with the multimedia system for the first time, you will need to
search for the phone and then authorise (connect) it. Depending on the mobile phone, authorisation takes place by means of Secure Simple
Pairing or by entering a passkey. The multimedia
system automatically makes the procedure that
is relevant for your mobile phone available. The
mobile phone is always connected automatically after authorisation. Further information on
using a mobile phone with the multimedia system (see the Digital Owner's Manual).
If the multimedia system does not detect your
mobile phone, this may be due to particular
security settings on your mobile phone (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
Only one mobile phone can be connected to the
multimedia system at any one time.
Searching for a mobile phone
Multimedia system:
Select Tel/
Tel/®QConnect
Connect
device Search for phones
deviceQSearch
phonesQStart
Start
search.
search
The available mobile phones are displayed.
Symbols in the device list
X
two minutes to be displayed (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X If the codes are different: select No on the
multimedia system.
The process is cancelled.
Repeat authorisation.
Authorisation by entering a passkey (passcode):
Select the Bluetooth® name of the mobile
phone.
The input menu for the passkey is displayed.
X Choose a one- to sixteen-digit number combination as a passkey.
X Enter the passkey on the multimedia system.
X Press ¬ to confirm.
X Enter and confirm the passkey on the mobile
phone. Depending on the mobile phone used,
confirm the connection to the multimedia system and for the PBAP and MAP Bluetooth®
profiles. The prompt to confirm may take up
to two minutes to be displayed (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X
i Mobile phones that are connected to the
optionally available telephone module with
Bluetooth® (SAP profile) are displayed separately in the device list. These are found below
the entry MB SAP module phones.
phones
Symbol
Explanation
Switching between mobile phones
Ï
New mobile phone found, not yet
authorised.
Ñ
Mobile phone is authorised, but is
not connected.
If you have authorised more than one mobile
phone, you can switch between the individual
phones.
Multimedia system:
#
Mobile phone is authorised and
connected.
Connecting the mobile phone
Authorisation using Secure Simple Pairing:
X Select the mobile phone.
A code is displayed in the multimedia system
and on the mobile phone.
X If codes match: select Yes on the multimedia
system.
X Confirm the code on the mobile phone.
Depending on the mobile phone used, confirm the connection to the multimedia system
and for the PBAP and MAP Bluetooth® profiles. The prompt to confirm may take up to
X
X
Select Connect device.
device
Select a mobile phone from the device list.
Telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile)
Introduction
The module can be used as a permanently installed telephone with its own SIM card
(Y page 265) or in conjunction with a mobile
phone (Y page 265).
If you wish to use the module in conjunction with
your mobile telephone, the mobile phone must
support the Bluetooth® SAP profile (SIM Access
Profile).
Z
Multimedia system
Searching for and authorising (connecting) a mobile phone
263
264
Operating system
The following functions are available using the
module:
Rhands-free mode
Rdata modem mode (Y page 265)
Rsending and receiving text messages
(Y page 266)
Raccess to the phone book of the mobile phone
(if supported by the mobile phone)
(Y page 266)
Rcharging a mobile phone via the USB connection (Y page 266)
Mounting the module in the stowage compartment of the centre console
X Insert USB cable : into the module.
X Slide the module into the bracket until it audibly engages.
X Connect the USB cable to the USB port.
Activating and connecting the module
Multimedia system
i The module is not available in all vehicles,
depending on the equipment.
Installing the module
Multimedia system:
Select Tel/
Tel/®.
Module: install (Y page 264).
X Press and hold button ;.
X As soon as indicator lamp : starts flashing
yellow, release the button.
The indicator lamp continues to flash yellow.
X
X
Mounting the module in the stowage compartment of the centre console
X Slide module ; into bracket : until it audibly engages.
Connecting the module via a USB cable
(COMAND Online)
Multimedia system:
Select Connect deviceQConnect
device Connect MB
SAP moduleQStart
module Start search.
search
The module is searched for and connected.
X To authorise a mobile phone: select Start
search and follow the instructions of the multimedia system. Further information on
authorising and connecting mobile phones
(Y page 263).
X
Operating system
SIM card mode
Inserting a SIM card
265
RBluetooth®
must be activated on the mobile
phone and must be made visible to other devices
Rthe Bluetooth® SIM Access Profile of the
mobile phone must be activated
Authorising and connecting a mobile
phone
Multimedia system:
Select Connect deviceQSearch
device Search for
phones SAP phone
phonesQSAP
phoneQStart
Start
searchQMB
search
MB SAP module phones
X Select the mobile phone.
X Enter and confirm any 16-digit PIN.
X Enter and confirm the same PIN on the mobile
phone.
X Where necessary, enter the SIM card PIN into
the multimedia system and confirm.
i Please observe the messages in the mobile
phone. If necessary, you will be asked to confirm further profile requests.
X
With the contact surface facing down, insert
SIM card : into the SIM card slot until it
engages.
After a SIM card is inserted in the module, a
Bluetooth® connection with another mobile
phone is no longer possible. Any existing
Bluetooth® connection is ended upon SIM
card insertion.
Connecting the mobile phone
General notes
Before using your mobile phone with the module
and the multimedia system for the first time, you
will need to search for the phone and then
authorise it.
Requirements
The mobile phone can be authorised and connected to the module if:
Rthe module is installed (Y page 264) and activated in the multimedia system
(Y page 264)
Rno SIM card is inserted in the module
Rthe mobile phone has no active Bluetooth®
connection to another device
Rthe mobile phone supports the Bluetooth®
SAP profile (SIM Access Profile)
Depending on the type of mobile phone, different settings must be changed on the mobile
phone (see the manufacturer's operating
instructions).
Switching between mobile phones
If you have authorised more than one mobile
phone on the module, you can switch between
the individual phones.
X Select the mobile phone under MB SAP mod‐
ule phones.
phones
X Confirm the connection request (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X Where necessary, enter the SIM card PIN into
the multimedia system and confirm.
data modem mode
X
or
Connect the mobile phone to the module
(Y page 265).
Insert the SIM card into the SIM card slot on
the module (Y page 265).
X Before connecting for the first time, enable
the module for Internet access and select the
network provider in the multimedia system
(see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
Use as a data modem is automatically activated.
X Activate/deactivate data roaming (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
X
Z
Multimedia system
X
Operating system
266
For further information on data mode without
telephony with COMAND Online (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
Charging a mobile phone
Settings
Storing/deleting the SIM card PIN
Multimedia system:
Select Connect device
deviceQMB
MB SAP module
phones
X Highlight the mobile phone.
X To select G: navigate to the right.
X Activate O or deactivate ªStore
Store PIN.
PIN
Multimedia system
X
Transferring the phone book
In order to use the phone book of the mobile
phone via the multimedia system, the phone
book must be transferred using the module.
The transfer of data may take up to ten minutes.
Transmission occurs automatically after a Bluetooth® connection is automatically established.
Text messages
Requirements
The module is connected with the mobile phone
(Y page 265) or is being used in the SIM card
mode (Y page 265).
Activating/deactivating text message
downloading from the mobile phone
Dial number
Function
00080
Text message downloading is deactivated.
00081
Text message downloading is activated.
For further information on receiving text messages when using the telephone module (see
the manufacturer's operating instructions).
Slide cover ; on the module in the direction
of the arrow and remove it.
X Connect the mobile phone via a USB data
cable with USB port :.
X
Media mode
General notes
If you wish to play external media sources, the
default display must already be turned on. Further information on media mode (see the Digital
Owner's Manual).
The following external media sources can be
used:
RApple®
devices (e.g. iPhone®)
RUSB devices (e.g. USB stick, MP3 player)
(Y page 267)
RCD
RDVD (COMAND Online)
RSD cards
Rvia devices connected by Bluetooth®
i Information on the single CD/DVD drive or
DVD changer (see the Digital Owner's Manual).
Using the device list
Multimedia system:
Select Media
MediaQDevices
Devices.
The available media sources will be shown.
The # dot indicates the current setting.
X Select the media source.
Playable files are played back.
X
Operating system
267
Inserting/removing an SD card
Important safety notes
G WARNING
SD cards are small parts. They can be swallowed and cause choking. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Keep the SD card out of the reach of children.
If a SD card is swallowed, seek medical attention immediately.
! If you are no longer using the SD card, you
Multimedia system
should remove it and store it outside the vehicle. High temperatures can damage the card.
Inserting an SD card
The SD card slot is on the control panel.
X Insert the SD card into the SD card slot until
the SD card engages. The side with the contacts must face downwards.
Removing an SD card
Press the SD card.
The SD card is ejected.
X Remove the SD card.
X
Connecting USB devices
There are two USB ports in the stowage space
under the armrest.
X Connect the USB device to the USB port.
X Select the media source (Y page 266).
Z
268
Stowage areas
Loading guidelines
Stowing and features
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk
of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid. Never drive with the boot lid
open.
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
these components to cool down before touching them.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle
are dependent on the distribution of the load
within the vehicle.
Observe the following notes when loading and
transporting a load:
Rnever exceed the maximum permissible gross
vehicle weight or the permissible axle loads
for the vehicle (including occupants).
Rthe boot is the preferred place to store
objects.
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot as possible.
Rthe
load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or front
seat backrests. Make sure that the seat
backrests are securely locked into place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Ruse the lashing eyelets and the luggage nets
to transport loads and luggage.
Ronly use lashing eyelets and fastening components that are suitable for the weight and
size of the load.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. Pad sharp
edges for protection.
Stowage areas
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants. In
addition, cupholders, open stowage spaces
and mobile phone brackets cannot always
retain all objects they contain. There is a risk
of injury, particularly in the event of sudden
braking or a sudden change in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces before
starting a journey.
RAlways stow and secure heavy, hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky objects in
the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 268).
Stowage areas
Glove compartment
To open: pull handle : and open glove compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
There is a pen holder at the top of the glove
compartment flap.
X
Spectacles compartment
X
To open: press marking :.
Make sure that the spectacles compartment is
always closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Stowage compartment in the front centre
console
Illustration: vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
To open: press the marking on cover :.
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there may be an ashtray in the centre console
instead of the stowage compartment.
X
Stowage compartment in front of the armrest (vehicles with automatic transmission)
Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
X To open: press the marking on cover :.
i You can remove the non-slip mat and the
insert for cleaning. When removing the insert
you will have to overcome some slight resistance.
Z
Stowing and features
Front stowage compartments
269
Stowage areas
270
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
To open: pull handle : up and fold cover ;
forwards.
On vehicles with a fire extinguisher instead of a
stowage compartment, the fire extinguisher is
installed under the driver's seat.
X
To open: on vehicles with moveable armrests, make sure that the armrest is in the
rearmost position.
X Press button : and fold the armrest up.
Stowing and features
X
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the armrest can be moved backwards or forwards in a
longitudinal direction.
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the following may be in the stowage space:
Ra multimedia connector unit with an SD card
slot and 2 USB ports, e.g. for use with an
iPod®, iPhone® or MP3 player (see the separate operating instructions)
Ra mobile phone bracket (Y page 277)
Rear stowage compartments
Stowage compartment in the rear centre
console
Stowage compartment under the driver's
and front-passenger seat
G WARNING
If you exceed the maximum permitted load of
the stowage compartment, the cover is
unable to restrain the objects. Objects may be
thrown out of the stowage compartment and
hit vehicle occupants as a result. There is a
risk of injury, particularly in the event of sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Always observe the maximum load of the
stowage compartment. Stow and secure
heavy objects in the boot.
The maximum permissible load of the stowage
compartment is 1.2 kg.
X
To open: pull down the top of stowage compartment : by the edge of the handle.
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there may be an open stowage space above
the stowage compartment.
Luggage nets
Luggage nets are located:
the front-passenger footwell
Ron the back of the driver's and frontpassenger seat
Ron the left and right-hand side in the boot
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 268)
and the safety notes regarding stowage spaces
(Y page 268).
Rin
Stowage areas
To open: fold down seat armrest :.
X Pull the centre head restraint on the rear
bench seat into the uppermost position
(Y page 99).
X
RThe
vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt cannot protect as intended and
could result in additional injury.
RObjects or loads in the boot cannot be
restrained by the seat backrest.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged before every trip.
! Before folding the backrest in the rear compartment forwards, make sure that the rear
compartment armrest and the cupholder are
folded in. They may otherwise be damaged.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 268).
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests
can be folded forwards separately to increase
the boot capacity.
Folding the rear seat backrest forwards
and back
Folding the rear seat backrest forwards
Slide locking mechanism = in the direction
of the arrow.
X Swing flap ; fully to the side.
Flap ; is held open by a magnet.
X
To close: swing flap ; in the boot back until
it engages.
X Fold armrest : up fully if necessary.
X
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 268).
Enlarging the luggage compartment
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold forwards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
Fully insert the backrest head restraints if
necessary (Y page 100).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Pull left-hand or right-hand release handle ;
of the seat backrest forwards.
The corresponding seat backrest : is
released.
X Fold backrest : forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Z
Stowing and features
Through-loading facility in the rear
compartment
271
Stowage areas
272
RDo
not use elastic straps or nets to secure a
load. These are only intended as an anti-slip
protection for light loads.
RDo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
RPad sharp edges for protection.
X
Insert the seat belt into seat-belt holder :.
Stowing and features
Folding the rear seat backrest back
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
: Lashing eyelets
Stowage well under the boot floor
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold seat backrest : back until it engages.
Red lock status indicator ; is no longer visible.
X Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 100).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Under the boot floor you can find a bracket for
TIREFIT and the vehicle tool kit, etc.
X To open: pull handle : up.
Securing a load
Observe the following notes on securing loads:
RObserve the loading guidelines (Y page 268).
RSecure the load using the lashing eyelets.
RDistribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
Features
To enlarge the boot you can remove the boot
floor.
X To remove: lift the boot floor almost to rain
trough ; and pull it out.
273
You will find information on the maximum roof
load in the "Technical Data" section
(Y page 333).
An incorrectly secured roof carrier or roof load
may become detached from the vehicle. You
must therefore ensure that you observe the roof
carrier manufacturer's installation instructions.
To insert: place the boot floor at the bottom
in the centre.
X Hold sides of boot floor = and press in the
direction of the arrow until it engages in
hooks ?.
X
Open and fold the covers : upwards carefully in the direction of the arrow.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage
points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When a load is transported on the roof, the
vehicle's centre of gravity rises and the handling changes. If you exceed the maximum
roof load, the handling as well as steering and
braking characteristics are severely affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always observe the maximum roof load and
adapt your driving style.
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use roof carriers that have been tested and
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. This
helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such a
way that the vehicle will not sustain damage
even when it is in motion.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, ensure
that when the roof carrier is fitted you can:
Ropen the panorama sliding sunroof fully
Ropen the boot lid fully
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The cup holder cannot secure a drinks container in place during a journey. If you use a
cup holder during a journey, the drinks container could be flung around and liquid could
be spilt. Vehicle occupants could come into
contact with the liquid and, in particular, be
scalded by hot liquid. You could be distracted
from the traffic situation and lose control of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident and
injury.
Only use the cup holder when the vehicle is
stationary. Only place containers of a suitable
Z
Stowing and features
Attaching the roof carrier
274
Features
Stowing and features
size in the cup holder. Seal the container, in
particular when it contains hot liquid.
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants. In
addition, cupholders, open stowage spaces
and mobile phone brackets cannot always
retain all objects they contain. There is a risk
of injury, particularly in the event of sudden
braking or a sudden change in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces before
starting a journey.
RAlways stow and secure heavy, hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky objects in
the boot.
Two coin holders = and a card holder ; can be
found in the cup holder.
The cup holder and the rubber mat underneath
can be removed for cleaning. Clean them with
clean, lukewarm water only.
X To remove: lift the cup holder up : and out
with a brief tug.
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The drinks
could otherwise spill.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 268).
The stowage compartments in the doors provide
space for bottles:
Rfront: capacity up to 1.0 l
Rrear: capacity up to 0.5 l
Cup holder in the front centre console
To fit: insert cup holder : into lateral curved
sections ; in the stowage compartment.
When doing so, insert the cup holder in such a
way that the cant of the upper section of the
cup holder faces forwards.
X Press cup holder : downwards until it
engages on the right and left-hand sides.
X
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit on or support your body weight on
the rear seat armrest when it is folded down,
as you could otherwise damage it.
! Close the cup holder before folding the rear
seat armrest up. Otherwise, the cup holder
could be damaged.
: Cup holders
Features
275
Glare from the side
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
X
X
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is not
heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in
the ashtray, make sure that the ashtray is
properly engaged. Otherwise, the stowage
space could be damaged.
Sun visors
Overview
Vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover: press the lower section of cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X To remove the insert: lift insert = up ; and
out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X
:
;
=
?
A
Mirror light
Retainer
Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Vanity mirror
Mirror cover
i If you remove the ashtray insert, you can use
the resulting compartment for stowage.
Rear-compartment ashtray
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor is
clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A has
been folded up.
Z
Stowing and features
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
X To open: press the front of cup holder :
or ;.
Cup holder : or ; extends automatically.
X To close: slide cup holder : or ; back until
it engages.
X
Features
276
To open: pull cover = out by its top edge.
To remove: pull insert ; by recess : in the
direction of arrow ? until it audibly releases.
X Lift insert ; up and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert ; from above into
the holder and press down until it engages.
X
X
Stowing and features
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
Rthe
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
Ra
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Use the cigarette lighter only
when road and traffic conditions permit.
12 V sockets
General notes
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
The sockets can be used for accessories with a
maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories
include such items as mobile phone chargers.
If you use the sockets for long periods when the
engine is switched off, the battery may discharge.
An emergency cut-off ensures that the on-board
voltage does not drop too low. If the on-board
voltage is too low, the power to the sockets is
automatically cut. This ensures that there is sufficient power to start the engine.
X
Socket in the front centre console
Vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover: press the lower section of the cover.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Lift up the cover of the socket.
X
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
Pull the cover out by the top of its handle
edge.
X Lift up the cover of the socket.
X
Socket in the boot
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover: press the lower section of cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically
when the heating element is red-hot.
X
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
Information on these requirements can be found
in the separate operating instructions.
To open: press cover : briefly.
To make an emergency call: press SOS button ; briefly.
The indicator lamp in SOS button ; flashes
until the emergency call is concluded.
X Wait for a voice connection to the MercedesBenz emergency call centre.
X After the emergency call, close cover :.
You will see a message if:
Ra connection to the Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre cannot be made
Ra call has not been automatically forwarded
to the public emergency call centre
In this case, dial the 112 emergency number
on your mobile phone.
You can find more information on the MercedesBenz emergency call system in the separate
operating instructions.
X
X
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating mobile communications equipment in
the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in motion,
you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the
traffic conditions, cause an accident and injure
yourself and others.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk posed
by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal mobile phone reception quality in the
vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle
electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields generated by a wireless device to the exterior
Rthe field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have an
exterior aerial
Information on fitting two-way radios and mobile
phones (RF transmitters) (Y page 325).
General notes
There are various mobile phone brackets that
may be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases,
these are country-specific.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with the multimedia system can be obtained:
Rat your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
Ron the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
The functions and services available when you
use the phone depend on your mobile phone
model and service provider.
Using a mobile phone
To connect a mobile phone to the exterior aerial
and charge it, insert it into the mobile phone
bracket.
Z
277
Stowing and features
Features
Features
278
Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 270).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the preinstalled fitting; see the separate installation
instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile phone
bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X
Mobile phone bracket in the stowage
compartment
i The mobile phone can also be operated
Stowing and features
without being in the bracket. However, the
charging function and aerial function are not
available.
In order to use Bluetooth® (SAP profile) on your
telephone module, you must first insert the telephone module into the pre-installed fitting. This
connects it to the exterior aerial. If you wish to
charge the mobile phone, you must connect it to
a USB port.
Further information on the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) can be found in the
Digital Owner's Manual.
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the phone using the 6 and
~ buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel. You can operate other mobile phone
functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 207).
When you remove the key from the ignition lock,
the mobile phone is disconnected from the vehicle. You can then no longer make calls using the
hands-free system.
If a call is active and you remove the key from
the ignition lock, the conversation is transferred
over to the mobile phone. It is then possible to
continue the conversation on the mobile phone.
You can fold the pre-installed bracket up to
improve access to the stowage space beneath
it.
Further information about the stowage compartment (Y page 270).
X To fold the bracket up: press button :.
X To fold the bracket down: press the bracket
down and allow it to engage.
Floormats
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Features
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press safety catch knobs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
279
X
Stowing and features
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile telephone reception. This is particularly the case for
conductive or metallic-coated films. You can
obtain information about anti-glare film from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
280
Engine compartment
Engine compartment
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open up when the
vehicle is in motion and block your view. There
is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet when driving. Before
every trip, ensure that the bonnet is locked.
Maintenance and care
jewellery and watches
items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
Rkeep
Bonnet
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
Rremove
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
G WARNING
The ignition system and the fuel injection system operate with a high voltage. If you touch
the live components, you could receive an
electric shock. There is a danger of injury.
Never touch components of the ignition system or the fuel injection system when the
ignition is switched on.
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
! An active bonnet that had been triggered
must be repaired at a qualified specialist
workshop. The active bonnet function will
then be available again. The additional pedestrian protection provided by the active bonnet
will then be restored.
The active bonnet is available only in certain
countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury to
pedestrians in certain accident situations. Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to
hard components, such as the engine.
If the active bonnet has been triggered, it is
raised at the rear in the area around the hinge by
approximately 60 mm.
For the drive to the workshop, reset the triggered active bonnet yourself. If the active bonnet has been triggered, pedestrian protection
may be limited.
Resetting
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Engine compartment
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Reach into the gap between the bonnet and
the radiator trim and press bonnet catch
lever ; to the left.
X Raise the bonnet.
X
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen wipers or the bonnet.
X
X
Pull support strut ? out of bracket A.
Lift up support strut ? and insert it into yellow retaining clip =.
Z
Maintenance and care
With your hand flat, push down active bonnet : in the area around the hinges on both
sides (arrows) until you feel it engage.
If you can raise the active bonnet slightly at the
rear in the area around the hinges, it is not
engaged correctly. Repeat the step.
If the bonnet can then still be raised, drive
directly to a qualified specialist workshop. Do
not drive faster than 100 km/h.
X
281
Engine compartment
282
Closing the bonnet
Raise the bonnet slightly and, at the same
time, remove support strut ? from yellow
retaining clip =.
X Swing support strut ? down and press it into
bracket A until it engages.
X Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a height
of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Do not press the bonnet
closed. Open the bonnet again and close it
with a little more force.
X
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
Maintenance and care
Engine oil
General notes
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently drive
at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may be
installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark the vehicle on a level surface
Rthe engine should be switched off for approximately five minutes if the engine is at normal
operating temperature.
Rif the engine is not at normal operating temperature, e.g. if the engine was only started
briefly, wait approximately 30 minutes before
carrying out the measurement
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine
(except the CLA 180 d model)
Example: CLA 180 d model
X All models except CLA 180 d: pull out oil
dipstick :.
X The CLA 180 d model: release the oil filler
cap and pull it out together with integrated oil
dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide tube
to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and MAX
mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark = or
below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
Engine compartment
283
Topping up engine oil
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
! Use only engine oils and oil filters that are
approved for vehicles with a service system. A
list of the engine oils and oil filters that have
been tested and approved in accordance with
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products is available at any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
The following cause engine failure or damage
to the exhaust system:
RUse of engine oils and oil filters that have
not been expressly approved for the service
system
RReplacement of engine oil and oil filter after
the replacement interval specified by the
service system has expired
RUse of engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. Topping up with too
Example: engine oil filler cap
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
X Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick
(Y page 282).
Further information on engine oil (Y page 330).
X
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
The cooling system is pressurised, particularly when the engine is warm. If you open the
cap, you could be scalded if hot coolant
sprays out. There is a risk of injury.
Let the engine cool down before you open the
cap. Wear gloves and eye protection. Open
the cap slowly to release the pressure.
! The coolant level must only be checked and
corrected when the engine has cooled down
(coolant temperature under 40 †). Checking
the coolant level when the coolant temperature is over 40 † can lead to damage to the
engine or engine cooling system.
much engine oil can result in damage to the
engine or to the catalytic converter. Have
excess engine oil siphoned off.
Z
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
ASSYST PLUS
284
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Check the coolant level only if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Check the coolant temperature display in the
instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
40 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Slowly turn cap : anti-clockwise and to
relieve excess pressure.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far as
it will go.
Further information on coolant (Y page 332).
Maintenance and care
X
Windscreen washer system
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
If the washer fluid level drops below the recommended minimum of 1 litre, a message appears
in the multifunction display prompting you to
top up the washer fluid (Y page 246).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 332).
X
X
ASSYST PLUS
Service message
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
You can find information on the type of service
and service intervals in the Service Booklet.
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the engine
oil level. Observe the notes on the engine oil
level (Y page 282).
ASSYST PLUS
RService
A in .. days
RService A due
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until the
next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major service. A number or another letter may be displayed after the letter.
For certain countries only: the position after the
letter A or B indicates any necessary additional
maintenance work. If you notify a qualified specialist workshop of this display, you will receive
a statement on the associated costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display does
not take into account any periods of time during
which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service schedule:
X Note down the service due date displayed in
the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X After reconnecting the battery, subtract the
battery disconnection periods from the service date shown on the display.
Hiding service messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering
wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
Press the = or ; button to select the
Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service
interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
has been inadvertently reset, this setting can
be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described in
the Service Booklet. This may otherwise lead
to increased wear and damage to the major
assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after the
service work has been carried out. You can also
obtain further information on maintenance
work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on normal operation of the vehicle. Service work will
need to be performed more often if the vehicle is
operated under arduous conditions or increased
loads, for example:
RRegular city driving with frequent intermediate stops
RIf the vehicle is primarily used to travel short
distances
RFor frequent use in mountainous terrain or on
poor road surfaces
RIf the engine is often left idling for long periods
RIn particularly dusty conditions, or if air-recirculation mode is frequently used.
In these or similar operating conditions, have
the interior filter, engine air cleaner, engine oil
and oil filter, for example, changed more frequently. The tyres must be checked more frequently if the vehicle is operated under
increased loads. Further information can be
obtained at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g.
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network is
also available in other countries. You can obtain
further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Z
Maintenance and care
The multifunction display shows a service message for a few seconds, e.g.:
285
286
Care
Care
General notes
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
Maintenance and care
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any of
the following:
Rdry, rough or hard cloths
Rabrasive cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective films
with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice scraper.
You could otherwise scratch or damage the
surfaces and protective film.
! Do not park up your vehicle for a long period
of time immediately after cleaning, particularly after cleaning the wheel rim with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaner may lead to increased
corrosion of the brake discs and pads. You
should therefore drive for a few minutes after
cleaning. By heating up the brakes, the brake
discs and pads dry. The vehicle can then be
parked up for a long period of time.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
! Make sure that the automatic transmission
is in position N when washing your vehicle in
a tow-through car wash. The vehicle could be
damaged if the transmission is in another
position.
! Make sure that:
Rthe
side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
Rthe blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed/
airflow control is turned to position 0).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position
0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
If the vehicle is very dirty, wash off excess dirt
before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car
wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off the
wax from the windscreen and the windscreen
wiper blades. This will prevent smears and
reduce wiping noises caused by residue on the
windscreen.
Washing by hand
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards the
air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the sponge
frequently.
Care
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least 30 cm
between the vehicle and the high-pressure
cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct
distance is available from the equipment
manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
Relectrical components
Rbattery
Rplug connectors
Rlamps
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damage to seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
! Vehicles with decorative film: parts of your
vehicle are covered with a decorative film.
Maintain a distance of at least 70 cm between
the parts of the vehicle covered with the film
and the nozzle of the high pressure cleaner.
Information about the correct distance is
available from the equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around whilst cleaning.
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected by
corrosion and damage caused by inadequate
care cannot always be completely repaired. In
such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover and
rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse off
the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resins, oils,
fuels and greases by rubbing gently with a
cloth soaked in petroleum ether or lighter
fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
Rvigorous rubbing with unsuitable materials
Rfrequent use of car washes
Rwashing the vehicle in direct sunlight
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or polishing
products, or gloss preserver, e.g. wax, for the
purpose of paintwork care. These products
are only suitable for high-gloss surfaces. Their
use on vehicles with matt paintwork leads to
considerable surface damage or, more specifically, to shiny, spotted areas.
Always have paintwork repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a clear
matt finish. This will help you to avoid damage to
the paintwork due to incorrect treatment.
Z
Maintenance and care
Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the paintwork.
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
X
287
288
Care
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels with
a clear matt finish.
The vehicle should preferably be washed by
hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of water.
Use only insect remover and car shampoo from
the range of approved Mercedes-Benz care
products.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Maintenance and care
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up your vehicle for a long period
of time immediately after cleaning, particularly after cleaning the wheel rim with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaner may lead to increased
corrosion of the brake discs and pads. You
should therefore drive for a few minutes after
cleaning. By heating up the brakes, the brake
discs and pads dry. The vehicle can then be
parked up for a long period of time.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away from
the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you
will damage the bonnet.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive cleaning
agents, solvents or solvent-based cleaning
agents to clean the inside of the windows/
windscreen. Do not touch the inside of the
windows/windscreen with hard items such
as an ice scraper or a ring. Otherwise, the
windows/windscreen could be damaged.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals and
pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This can lead
to corrosion damage and damage to electronic components.
X Clean the inside and outside of the windows
with a damp cloth and a cleaning agent that is
recommended and approved by MercedesBenz.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away from
the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you
will damage the bonnet.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and do
not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the graphite coating could be damaged. This could
cause wiper noise.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Care
289
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a damp
cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again before
switching on the ignition.
X
Cleaning the exterior lighting
that are suitable for plastic lenses. Unsuitable
cleaning agents or cleaning cloths could
scratch or damage the plastic lenses of the
exterior lighting.
X Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior lighting using a wet sponge and a mild cleaning
agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or
cleaning cloths.
X
Cleaning the mirror turn signal
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths
that are suitable for plastic lenses. Unsuitable
cleaning agents or cleaning cloths could
scratch or damage the plastic lenses of the
mirror turn signals.
X Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn signals in the exterior mirror housing using a wet
sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Clean sensors : of the driving systems with
water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a high-pressure cleaner.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pressure
cleaner, make sure that you keep a distance
of at least 30 cm between the vehicle and the
high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information
about the correct distance is available from
the equipment manufacturer.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Open the camera cover for cleaning via the
multimedia system; see the separate operating instructions.
X To clean the reversing camera: use clean
water and a soft cloth to clean camera
lens :.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths
290
Care
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
these components to cool down before touching them.
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acidbased cleaning agents, such as sanitary
cleanser or wheel cleaner.
Maintenance and care
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles with black exhaust
pipes: the black-chrome tailpipe finishers
should not be polished with a chrome polish.
They will otherwise lose their black sheen. For
optimal care, the finishers should be rubbed
with a lightly oiled cloth after every car wash.
Commercially available engine and care oils
are suitable for this.
For heavier soiling, you can apply a fine paintwork polish with a microfibre cloth. Remove
the excess polish residue after polishing.
Impurities combined with the effects of road grit
and corrosive environmental factors may cause
flash rust to form on the surface. You can
restore the original shine of the exhaust pipe by
cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and
after washing the vehicle.
X Clean the exhaust pipe with a care product
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a highpressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
! Please note the care instructions in the
trailer coupling manufacturer's operating
instructions.
Remove rust, e.g. with a wire brush.
Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or a
brush.
X After cleaning, lightly oil or grease ball coupling :.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer tow hitch is
working properly.
X
X
i You can also have the maintenance work on
the ball coupling and the trailer tow hitch carried out by a qualified specialist workshop.
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning
agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface when
cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
X Before cleaning the display, make sure that it
is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and TFT/LCD
display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre
cloth.
Rabrasive
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
Care
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent or
sunscreen to come in contact with the plastic
trim. This maintains the high-quality look of
the surfaces.
X Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily.
Wait until the surface is dry again.
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wood trim and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes
or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the surface.
X Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements with
a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use a microfibre cloth to clean covers
made out of real leather, artificial leather or
DINAMICA. If used frequently, this can damage the cover.
Note that regular care is essential to make sure
that the appearance and comfort of the covers
are retained over time.
Genuine leather seat covers
! To retain the natural appearance of the
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
RClean genuine leather covers carefully with
a damp cloth and then wipe the covers
down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise become
rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified
specialist workshop.
Leather is a natural product.
It has natural surface properties, e.g.:
Runevenness in structure
Rmarks caused by growth and injury
Rsubtle colour differences
These are characteristics of leather and not
material faults.
Seat covers from other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean
artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully, and always wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines. Leave
the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results
depend on the type of dirt and how long it
has been there.
RClean DINAMICA covers with a damp cloth.
Make sure that you wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
G WARNING
Seat belts may be severely weakened if
bleached or coloured. This may lead to the
seat belts, for example, tearing or failing in an
Z
Maintenance and care
become porous. This could result in plastic
parts breaking away when the airbags are
deployed. There is a danger of injury.
Do not use care products and cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the cockpit.
291
Care
292
accident. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never bleach or colour seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at
temperatures above 80 † or in direct sunlight.
X Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft brush
or dry shampoo.
X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning
agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Maintenance and care
X
Where will I find...?
Where will I find...?
293
First-aid kit
Warning triangle
Removing/replacing the warning triangle
X
X
To remove: open the boot lid.
Press warning triangle holder : in the direction of the arrow and open. Lift retaining clip
= and remove warning triangle ;.
X To replace: place warning triangle ; back
into warning triangle holder :.
X Close warning triangle holder : and push up
to secure.
X
Open the boot lid.
Remove first-aid kit :.
Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit at least
once a year. Replace the contents if necessary,
and replace any missing items.
Fire extinguisher
Setting up the warning triangle
The fire extinguisher is located underneath the
front of the driver's seat.
X Pull tab : upwards.
X Remove fire extinguisher ;.
X
X
Fold feet = out to the side.
Fold side reflectors ; upwards to form a triangle and lock them at the top using press
stud :.
Have the fire extinguisher refilled after each use
and checked every one or two years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
Breakdown assistance
X
294
Flat tyre
Vehicle tool kit
Breakdown assistance
General notes
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: the TIREFIT kit is
located in the stowage well under the boot floor.
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit: the tyrechange tool kit is in the stowage well under the
boot floor.
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel, see
"Removing the emergency spare wheel"
(Y page 324).
Apart from some country-specific variants, vehicles are not equipped with a tyre-change tool kit.
Some tools for changing a tyre are specific to
the vehicle. For more information on which tyrechanging tools are required and approved for
performing a tyre change on your vehicle, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary tyre-changing tools may include, for
example:
Rjack
Rwheel chock
RWheel wrench
RCentring pin
i The jack weighs approximately 3.4 kg.
The maximum load-bearing capacity of the
jack can be found on the adhesive label on the
jack.
The jack is maintenance-free. If there is a
malfunction, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
: Tyre inflation compressor
; Tyre sealant bottle
= Towing eye
Open the boot lid.
Swing the boot floor upwards (Y page 272).
X Use the TIREFIT kit (Y page 296) or remove it.
Towing eye = is located under tyre inflation
compressor :.
X
X
i The tyre inflation compressor weighs
approximately 0.8 kg.
The tyre inflation compressor is maintenancefree. If there is a malfunction, please contact
a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit
Open the boot lid.
Swing the boot floor upwards (Y page 272).
X Remove the tyre-change tool kit.
The tyre-change tool kit contains:
RJack
RWheel wrench
ROne pair of gloves
RFolding wheel chock
X
X
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
with run-flat char-
RMOExtended tyres (tyres
acteristics) (Y page 295)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 294)
Ran emergency spare wheel (certain countries
only) (Y page 323)
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Information on changing and fitting a wheel
(Y page 318).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible from
traffic on solid, non-slippery and level ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 155).
If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove the
key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function
or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
The vehicle electronics now have status 0.
This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock (Y page 133).
X Make sure that the passengers are not endangered as they get out of the vehicle. Make
sure that no one is near the danger area while
a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not
directly assisting in the wheel change should,
for example, stand behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic
conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle a suitable distance
away (Y page 293). Observe legal requirements.
X
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics), you can continue to drive your vehicle even if there is a total loss of pressure in one
or more tyres. The affected tyre must not show
any clearly visible damage.
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
"MOExtended" marking that appears on the tyre
sidewall. You will find this marking next to the
tyre size designation, the load-bearing capacity
and the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may be used only in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or tyre pressure monitor.
If a pressure loss warning message appears
in the multifunction display:
Robserve the instructions
sages (Y page 239)
Rcheck
Rif
in the display mes-
the tyre for damage
driving on, observe the following notes
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode is
approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially laden and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible in run-flat mode depends on the:
Rvehicle speed
Rroad condition
Routside temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/
manoeuvres, or it can be increased through a
moderate style of driving.
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode is
counted from the moment the tyre pressure loss
warning appears on the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
When replacing one or all tyres, observe the following specifications for your vehicle's tyres:
Rsize
Rtype and
Rthe "MOExtended" marking
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be replaced
with an MOExtended tyre, a standard tyre may
be used as a temporary measure. Make sure
that you use the proper size and type (summer
or winter tyre).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Z
295
Breakdown assistance
Flat tyre
296
Flat tyre
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
Rthere
TIREFIT kit
Breakdown assistance
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures down
to Ò20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
RImmediately change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out of
the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation compres-
sor for longer than ten minutes at a time without a break. It may otherwise overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Comply with the manufacturer's safety instructions on the sticker on the tyre inflation compressor.
Using the TIREFIT kit
Flat tyre
Remove filler hose B and connector = from
the bottom section of tyre inflation compressor housing ;.
X Slide the yellow filler hose connector into the
mounting on yellow cap A of tyre sealant
bottle : until the connector engages.
X With sealing rings in front, slide yellow cap A
of tyre sealant bottle : into the holder of tyre
inflation compressor ;.
Yellow cap A must engage in both hooks.
X
X
X
X
Remove cap from valve C on faulty tyre.
Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
Insert connector = into a 12 V socket in your
vehicle.
Observe the notes on sockets (Y page 276).
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Press on and off switch ? on the tyre inflation
compressor to ON.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched on.
The tyre is inflated.
First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre. The
pressure may briefly rise to approximately
500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X Let the tyre inflation compressor run for a
maximum of ten minutes. The tyre should
then have attained a pressure of at least
200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi).
If a pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has
been attained after ten minutes, see "Tyre pressure reached" (Y page 298).
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has
not been attained after ten minutes, see "Tyre
pressure not reached" (Y page 297).
If tyre sealant leaks out, make sure you clean the
affected area as quickly as possible. It is preferable to use clear water.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
X
Tyre pressure not reached
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has
not been attained after ten minutes:
X Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of the
faulty tyre.
Please note that tyre sealant may leak out
when unscrewing the filler hose.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of ten minutes, the tyre
pressure must be at least 200 kPa (2.0 bar/
29 psi).
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
Z
Breakdown assistance
Do not remove any foreign objects that have
penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation
compressor from the stowage space under
the boot floor (Y page 294).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker to the
instrument cluster within the driver's field of
vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
297
Flat tyre
298
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
The maximum permissible speed for a tyre
sealed with tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The upper
part of the TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the
instrument cluster where it will be easily seen by
the driver.
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has
been attained after ten minutes:
X Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of the
faulty tyre.
Please note that tyre sealant may leak out
when unscrewing the filler hose.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
X Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the tyre pressure table on the fuel filler flap for values.
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
When the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew
the filler hose from the valve of the sealed
tyre.
Please note that tyre sealant may leak out
when unscrewing the filler hose.
X Screw the valve cap onto the tyre valve of the
sealed tyre.
X
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation
compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with the
tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can significantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To remove the tyre sealant bottle from the
tyre inflation compressor, press together the
locking tabs on the yellow cap.
X Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant bottle.
X
Battery (vehicle)
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can lead, for example, to a short circuit and
thus damage the vehicle electronics. This can
lead to function restrictions applying to
safety-relevant systems, e.g the lighting system, the ABS (anti-lock braking system) or the
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program). The operating safety of your vehicle may be restricted.
You could lose control of the vehicle, for
example:
Rwhen
braking
Rin the event of abrupt steering manoeuvres
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not
adapted to the road conditions
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or a similar incident, contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. Always
have work on the battery carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Further information about ABS (Y page 66) and
ESP® (Y page 69).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic
charge is created, for example:
Rby wearing synthetic-fibre clothing
Rby friction between clothing and the seat
Rif you pull or push the battery across carpet or
other synthetic materials
Rif you rub the battery with a cloth
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not
lean over the battery. Keep the batteries out
of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off
battery acid thoroughly with plenty of clean
water and seek medical attention at once.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle and the filler hose
replaced as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
299
300
Battery (vehicle)
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and smoking are
prohibited when handling the battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact
with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing; in
particular, gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes off
with clean water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Breakdown assistance
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist workshop for more information.
! You should have all work involving the bat-
tery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. In the exceptional case that it is necessary for you to disconnect the battery yourself, make sure that:
Ryou switch off the engine and remove the
key. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, ensure
that the ignition is switched off. Check that
all the indicator lamps in the instrument
cluster are off. Otherwise, electronic components, such as the alternator, may be
damaged.
Ryou first remove the negative terminal
clamp and then the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system
may be damaged.
Rin vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle
is secured against rolling away. You can
then no longer move the vehicle.
The battery and the cover of the positive terminal clamp must be fitted securely during
operation.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Keep children at a safe distance.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle
occupants from suffering acid burns should the
battery be damaged in the event of an accident.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum
possible service life, it must always be sufficiently charged.
Like other batteries, the vehicle battery may
discharge over time if you do not use the vehicle.
In such cases, have the battery disconnected at
a qualified specialist workshop. You can also
charge the battery with a charger recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. For more information,
please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a lengthy
period. Consult a qualified specialist workshop
if you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for a
long period of time.
When you park the vehicle, remove the key if you
do not require any electrical consumers. The
Jump-starting
Charging the battery
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not
lean over the battery. Keep the batteries out
of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off
battery acid thoroughly with plenty of clean
water and seek medical attention at once.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum
charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jump-start
connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 301).
X Open the bonnet.
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order as
when connecting the donor battery in the
jump-starting procedure (Y page 301).
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up in
the instrument cluster at low temperatures, it is
very likely that the discharged battery has frozen. In this case, you may neither jump-start the
vehicle nor charge the battery. The service life of
a battery that has been thawed may be reduced.
The starting characteristics may be impaired,
especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Only charge the installed battery with a battery
charger which has been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. A battery charger unit specially
adapted for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and tested
and approved by Mercedes-Benz is available as
an accessory. This device permits charging of
the battery while it is installed. Contact a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for information
and availability. Read the battery charger's
operating instructions before charging the battery.
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not lean over
the battery. Keep the batteries out of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off battery acid
thoroughly with plenty of clean water and seek medical attention at once.
Z
Breakdown assistance
vehicle will then use very little energy, thus conserving battery power.
If the power supply has been interrupted, e.g. if
the battery was discharged, you will have to:
Rset the clock using the multimedia system;
see the separate operating instructions.
Rreset the function for folding the exterior mirrors in/out automatically, by folding the mirrors out once (Y page 104)
301
302
Jump-starting
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Vehicles with a petrol engine: avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, the
non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up in the instrument cluster at low temperatures, it is very
likely that the discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor
charge the battery. Let the battery thaw first. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may
be reduced. The starting characteristics may be impaired, especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the
engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump leads.
Observe the following points:
RThe battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible, jumpstart the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RVehicles with a petrol engine: jump-start the vehicle only when the engine and exhaust system
are cold.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting may be performed only using batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
ROnly use jump leads that are not damaged and have a sufficient cross-section and insulated
terminal clamps.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Jump-starting
303
Make sure that:
jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts while
the jump leads are connected to the battery
RThe jump leads cannot come into contact with parts that can move when the engine is running,
such as the V-belt pulley or the fan
X Secure the vehicle by applying the electric parking brake.
X Manual transmission: depress the clutch pedal fully and engage neutral.
X Automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0in the ignition lock and remove it.
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jump-starting
device.
X Press together cover : of positive clamp ; and slide it back.
X Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B using the
jump lead, beginning with your own battery.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the jump
lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X If the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected for
a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive
clamp ; and positive terminal =. Each time, begin at the contacts on your own vehicle first.
X Close cover : of positive clamp ; after removing the jump leads.
X Close the bonnet.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
Z
Breakdown assistance
RThe
304
Towing away and tow-starting
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump-starting can be obtained at any
qualified specialist workshop.
Towing away and tow-starting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Safety relevant functions are restricted or no
longer available if:
Rthe
engine is not running
brake system or power steering is malfunctioning
Rthere is a malfunction in the voltage supply
or the vehicle's electrical system
When your vehicle is towed away or towed
started, you may require considerably more
effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such cases use a rigid towing bar. Before
being towed away or tow started, make sure
the steering moves freely.
Breakdown assistance
Rthe
G WARNING
If the steering wheel lock is engaged, the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always switch on the ignition when towing
with a tow rope or a towing bar.
G WARNING
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle
and its weight is greater than the permissible
gross weight of your vehicle, the:
Rtowing
eye may be torn off
combination may swerve or
even overturn
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
Rcar/trailer
Details on the permissible gross vehicle weight
of your vehicle can be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 326).
! When Active Brake Assist, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC or the HOLD function is activated,
the vehicle brakes automatically in certain
situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
these systems in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
! Make sure that the electric parking brake is
released. If the electric parking brake is faulty,
visit a qualified specialist workshop.
! Only secure the tow cable or tow bar to the
towing eyes or, if available, to the trailer tow
hitch. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
RSecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
RMake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope in
the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This will make other road
users aware that a vehicle is being towed.
ROnly secure the tow cable to the towing
eyes or, if available, to the trailer tow hitch.
RObserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a distance a distance so that the tow rope does
not sag.
RDo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage
the vehicle.
! Do not use the towing eyes for recovery purposes as this could damage the vehicle. If in
doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Pull away smoothly when towing away or
tow-starting a vehicle. If the tractive power is
too high, the vehicles could be damaged.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
Towing away and tow-starting
For towing distances over 50 km, the front
axle or the entire vehicle must be raised and
transported.
305
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the
key instead of the Start/Stop button. The
automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the driver's or front-passenger door which could
damage the transmission.
not be tow-started. The transmission may
otherwise be damaged.
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant
countries when towing and tow-starting.
It is better to have the vehicle transported than
to have it towed.
If the vehicle can no longer be driven because of
an accident or breakdown, you have the following options:
Rtransporting the vehicle
As a rule, you should have the vehicle transported.
Rtowing the vehicle with a tow rope or tow bar
Only tow the vehicle in exceptional cases.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
Rcannot release the electric parking brake
Rcannot shift the transmission to position N on
vehicles with automatic transmission
The function of the electric parking brake and
the parking lock is dependent on the on-board
voltage.
If the on-board voltage is low or if there is a system malfunction:
Rit may not be possible to apply the released
parking brake or
Rit may not be possible to shift the transmission to position P
Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. the
radio.
Deactivate the automatic locking feature before
towing the vehicle (Y page 211). You could otherwise be locked out when pushing or towing
the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection before the vehicle is towed away (Y page 74).
The brackets for the screw-in towing eye are in
the bumpers. They are located at the rear and at
the front, under covers :.
X Remove the towing eye from the stowage
space.
The towing eye is located with the vehicle tool
kit under the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 294).
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: the towing eye is
located under the tyre inflation compressor.
X Press the mark on cover : inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Remove cover : from the opening.
X Screw in the towing eye clockwise to the stop.
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch only have a
bracket at the front for the screw-in towing eye.
If you intend to use the vehicle for towing, fold
out the ball coupling (Y page 197) and secure
the towbar to it .
Removing the towing eye
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Attach cover : to the bumper and press until
it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the stowage well
under the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 294).
X Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: replace the tyre
inflation compressor.
X
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
! Vehicles with automatic transmission must
306
Towing away and tow-starting
Towing the vehicle with the front axle
raised
When towing your vehicle with the front axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 304).
Only vehicles without 4MATIC can be towed
with the front axle raised.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may either be towed with
both axles on the ground or be loaded and transported.
Breakdown assistance
! The ignition must be switched off if you are
towing the vehicle with the front axle raised.
Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
X On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESS-GO start function: you must use the
key instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 134).
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position
P.
or
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
neutral.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Deactivate tow-away protection (Y page 74).
X Deactivate automatic locking (Y page 211).
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 109).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position 0
and leave the key in the ignition lock.
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 304).
X
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESS-GO start function: you must use the
key instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 134).
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
automatic transmission automatically shifts to
position P when you open the driver's or frontpassenger door or when you remove the key
from the ignition lock. In order to ensure that the
automatic transmission stays in position N
when towing away the vehicle, you must
observe the following points:
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position
N.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
neutral.
X
X
Vehicles with manual or automatic transmission:
Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition lock.
Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 109).
X
X
i In order to signal a change of direction when
towing the vehicle with the hazard warning
lamps switched on, use the combination
switch as usual. In this case, only the turn
signals for the desired direction flash. When
you reset the combination switch, the hazard
warning lamps start flashing again.
Towing away and tow-starting
Transporting the vehicle
4MATIC vehicles or vehicles with automatic transmission
307
The towing eye or trailer tow hitch can be used
to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if
you wish to transport it.
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles
! When the vehicle is loaded for transport, the
front and rear axles must be stationary and on
the same transportation vehicle. Positioning
over the connection point of the transport
vehicle is not permitted. The drive train may
otherwise be damaged.
All vehicles
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise, the
vehicle could be damaged.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
neutral.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Shift the transmission to position N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Secure the vehicle against rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage first
or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0in the ignition lock
and remove it.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may only be either towed
away with both axles on the ground or be loaded
up and transported.
If the vehicle has transmission damage or damage to the front or rear axle, have it transported
on a transporter or trailer.
In the event of damage to the electrical system:
If the battery is defective, the automatic transmission will be locked in position P. To shift the
automatic transmission to position N, you must
provide power to the vehicle's electrical system
in the same way as when jump-starting
(Y page 301).
Have the vehicle transported on a transporter or
trailer.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Do not tow-start vehicles with automatic
transmission. You could otherwise damage
the automatic transmission.
i You can find information on "Jump-starting"
under (Y page 301).
Before tow-starting, the following conditions
must be fulfilled:
Rthe battery is connected
Rthe engine has cooled down
Rthe exhaust system has cooled down
When tow-starting, it is important that you
observe the safety notes (Y page 304) and the
legal requirements in each respective country.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 109).
X Fit the towing eye (Y page 305).
X Secure the rigid towing bar or the towing
rope.
Z
Breakdown assistance
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
Electrical fuses
308
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 133).
X Depress the clutch pedal fully, engage second
gear and continue to keep the clutch pedal
fully depressed.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Tow-start the vehicle.
X Release the clutch pedal slowly; do not
depress the accelerator pedal while doing so.
X When the engine has been started, immediately depress the clutch pedal fully and shift
to neutral.
X Pull over at a suitable place and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions.
X Use the electric parking brake to secure the
vehicle and prevent it from rolling away.
X Remove the rigid towing bar or towing rope.
X Remove the towing eye (Y page 305).
X Switch off the hazard warning lamps.
Breakdown assistance
X
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
! Only use fuses that have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the
correct fuse rating for the system concerned.
Only use fuses marked with an "S". Components or systems could otherwise be damaged.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it is
lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair the operation of the fuses.
The fuses in your vehicle disconnect faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components in the
circuit and their functions will fail.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of the
same rating, which you can recognise by the
colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings are listed
in the fuse allocation chart.
The fuse allocation chart is in the fuse box in the
front-passenger footwell (Y page 309).
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Before replacing a fuse
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 155).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove the
key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function
or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
The vehicle electronics now have status 0.
This is the same as the key having been
removed.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
RFuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed in
the direction of travel
RFuse box in the front-passenger footwell
The fuse allocation chart is on the fuse box in the
front-passenger footwell (Y page 309).
X
Fuse box in the engine compartment
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
Electrical fuses
309
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
Open the bonnet.
Remove any existing moisture from the fuse
box using a dry cloth.
X To open: open clamps ;.
X Fold cover : up in the direction of the arrow
and remove it.
X
X
X
X
To release cover =, press retaining
clamp ;.
X Fold out cover = in the direction of the arrow
to the catch.
X Remove cover = forwards.
Fuse allocation chart ? is located on the
lower right-hand side of cover =.
X To close: insert cover = on the left-hand side
of the fuse box into the retainer.
Cover = engages in the retainers.
X Fold down cover = until clamps ; lock audibly.
X Fold back perforated floor covering :.
X Fit the floormats.
X
Hook clamps ; into the fuse box and close.
Close the bonnet.
Z
Breakdown assistance
To close: check whether the seal is lying correctly in cover :.
X Insert cover : at the back into openings =
on the fuse box.
X Fold down cover :.
X
To open: open the front-passenger door.
Remove the floormat.
X Fold out perforated floor covering : in the
direction of the arrow.
X
X
310
Operation
Rdesignation
Further information regarding wheels and tyres
can be found under "Wheel/tyre combinations"
(Y page 323).
You can ask for information regarding permitted
wheel/tyre combinations at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Information on tyre pressures can be found:
Rin the tyre pressure table in the fuel filler flap
(Y page 154)
Runder "Tyre pressure" (Y page 313)
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of spacers or
brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating permit for the vehicle.
Rtype
i Further information on wheels and tyres can
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rimmediately
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being used correctly can impair operating safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Rlegal stipulations
Rfactory recommendations
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressure when the vehicle is
heavily laden and adjust prior to a trip.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations, noises
and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the
wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that
a tyre is defective, reduce your speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon as possible to
check the wheels and tyres for damage. Hidden
tyre damage could also be causing the unusual
handling characteristics. If you find no signs of
damage, have the tyres and wheels checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure not to
squash the tyre. If you cannot avoid driving over
obstacles, e.g. kerbs, do so slowly and at an
obtuse angle only. You could otherwise damage
the wheel rims and tyres.
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Operation
Check wheels and tyres for damage at least
once a month. Check wheels and tyres after
driving off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels can cause a loss of tyre pressure. Pay
particular attention to damage such as:
Rcuts in the tyres
Rpunctures
Rtears in the tyres
Rbulges on the tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on the
wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width of
the tyre (Y page 311). If necessary, turn the
front wheels to full lock to make it easier to
inspect the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect the
valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit anything onto the valve other than the standard
valve cap or other valve caps specially approved
for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit
any other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitors.
Check the pressure of all tyres regularly as well
as prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre pressure as
necessary (Y page 313).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 323).
The service life of a tyre depends on various factors, including the following:
RDriving style
RTyre pressure
RMileage
Notes on the tyre tread
G WARNING
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at differ-
ent locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rsummer
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tyre load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tyre damage or the tyre bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Therefore, only use tyre types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
tyre load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
Pay special attention to country-specific
requirements for tyre approval. These requirements may stipulate a specific tyre type for your
vehicle. Furthermore, the use of a specific tyre
type in certain regions and areas of operation
can be highly beneficial. You can find further
information regarding tyres at specialist tyre
retailers, at qualified specialist workshops or at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
RUse only tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe here the "MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 295).
RFit only tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for the
first 100 km. They reach their full performance only after this distance.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
311
312
Winter operation
RDo
not drive with tyres that have too little
tread depth. This significantly reduces traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 323).
Wheels and tyres
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics), you can continue to drive your vehicle even if there is a total loss of pressure in one
or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may be used only in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or with an activated tyre pressure monitor and only on wheels specifically tested by
Mercedes-Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with a
flat tyre (Y page 295).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 318).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres lose
elasticity and therefore traction and braking
power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to
M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very cold
temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility for
this type of damage.
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres or
all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are identified
by the M+S marking.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide
the best possible grip in wintry road conditions.
Only these tyres will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to function optimally in winter. These tyres have been developed specifically for driving in snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on all
wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum
permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix
an appropriate warning label in the driver's field
of vision. This can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum design speed of the vehicle using the permanent limiter to the maximum
permissible speed for the M+S tyres
(Y page 166).
Tyre pressure
Snow chains
G WARNING
If snow chains are fitted to the rear wheels,
they may scrape against the vehicle body or
chassis components. This could cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres. There is a risk
of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
fit snow chains on the rear wheels
fit snow chains in pairs to the front
wheels.
Ralways
! Vehicles with steel wheels: if you fit snow
chains on steel wheels, you may damage the
hub caps. Remove the hub caps from the relevant wheels before fitting the snow chains.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that have
been approved for Mercedes-Benz or that are of
an equivalent standard of quality. For more
information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
If you wish to fit snow chains, please bear the
following points in mind:
RSnow chains cannot be fitted to all wheel/
tyre combinations. Permitted wheel/tyre
combinations (Y page 323).
RUse snow chains only if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the snow
chains as soon as possible when you come to
a road that is not snow-covered.
RLocal regulations may restrict the use of snow
chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if
you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Rdo not use Parking Pilot when snow chains are
fitted (Y page 180).
You may wish to deactivate ESP® when pulling
away with snow chains fitted (Y page 70). This
allows the wheels to spin in a controlled manner,
achieving increased propulsive force (cut).
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 323).
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tyres pose the
following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure and
check the tyre pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Rat
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore embarking on a longer journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rwhen
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
Z
Wheels and tyres
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 313).
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
(Y page 315).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 317).
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 323).
X
313
314
Tyre pressure
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
RCheck the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Wheels and tyres
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
The recommended tyre pressures for various
operating conditions can be found in the tyre
pressure table on the fuel filler flap
(Y page 154).
Operation with an emergency spare wheel:
information on operation with an emergency
spare wheel can be found in the general notes in
the "Emergency spare wheel" section
(Y page 324).
Operation with a trailer: the applicable value
for the rear axle is the maximum value stated in
the tyre pressure table inside the fuel filler flap.
Additionally, the tyre pressure table may also
state tyre pressures for different load conditions. These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary; for
more information, please refer to the vehicle
documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures
stated on the tyre pressure table apply for all
tyres approved at the factory for this vehicle.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the following tyre pressure information is valid only for
that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the tyre
pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre does
not give any reliable indication of the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the electronic tyre
pressure monitor, you can also check the tyre
pressure using the on-board computer.
If possible, correct tyre pressures only when the
tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three hours
and
Rif the vehicle has been driven less than
1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
vehicle speed and the load on the tyres, the tyre
temperature and thus the tyre pressure changes
by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per
10 †. Take this into account when checking the
pressure of warm tyres. Correct the tyre pressure only if it is too low for the current operating
condition.
Driving with a tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten the service life of the tyres
Rcause increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
The tyre pressure values given for low loads are
minimum values that offer you good driving
comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given for
higher loads. These are permissible and will not
adversely affect the running of the vehicle.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure
loss warning system monitors the set tyre pressure using the rotational speed of the wheels.
This enables the system to detect significant
pressure loss in a tyre. If the rotational speed of
a wheel changes as a result of a loss of tire
pressure, a corresponding warning message will
appear in the multifunction display.
Tyre pressure
Important safety notes
The tyre pressure warning system does not warn
you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 313).
The tyre pressure loss warning system does not
replace the need to regularly check the tyre
pressure. An even loss of pressure on several
tyres at the same time cannot be detected by
the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure loss warning system is not
able to warn you of a sudden loss of air, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of air, bring the vehicle to
a halt by braking carefully. Avoid abrupt steering
manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow chains are fitted on your vehicle
Rroad conditions are wintry
Ryou are driving on a loose surface (e.g. sand or
gravel)
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high rates of
acceleration)
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the vehicle or on the roof)
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system if
you have:
Rchanged the tyre pressure
Rchanged the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres for
the respective operating conditions. The recommended tyre pressures can be found in the
tyre pressure table on the fuel filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set the
correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect tyre
pressure is set, this incorrect value will be
monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre pressures (Y page 313).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 133).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the Serv.
Serv.menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message appears
in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure loss
warning system will monitor the set tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
or
Press the % button.
If the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, press the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres. The tyre
pressure monitor warns you if the pressure
drops in one or more of the tyres. The tyre pressure monitor functions only if the corresponding
sensors are fitted to all wheels.
Z
Wheels and tyres
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss warning by the Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message which appears in
the multifunction display in the Serv.
Serv.menu.
Information on the message display can be
found in the "Restarting the tyre pressure loss
warning system" section (Y page 315).
315
316
Tyre pressure
Information on tyre pressures is shown on the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre is
shown in the Serv. menu of the multifunction
display, see illustration (example).
For information on the message display, refer to
the "Checking the tyre pressure electronically"
section (Y page 316).
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 313). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor. If
a substantial loss of pressure occurs, the warning threshold for the warning message is aligned
to the taught-in reference values. Restart the
tyre pressure monitor after adjusting to the cold
tyre pressure (Y page 317). The current pressures are saved as new reference values. This
ensures that a warning message appears only if
the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you of
an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe the
notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 313).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the tyre
is penetrated by a foreign object. In the event of
a sudden loss of air, bring the vehicle to a halt by
braking carefully. Avoid abrupt steering
manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning
lamp on the instrument cluster for indicating a
pressure loss or malfunction. Depending on how
the warning lamp flashes or lights up, a tyre
pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the
tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
RIf the warning lamp is lit continuously, the tyre
pressure on one or more tyres is significantly
too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
RIf the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
In addition to the warning lamp, a message
appears on the multifunction display. Observe
the information on display messages
(Y page 239).
It may take up to ten minutes for a malfunction
of the tyre pressure monitor to be indicated. A
malfunction will be indicated by the tyre pressure warning lamp flashing for approximately
one minute and then remaining lit. When the
fault has been rectified, the tyre pressure warning lamp goes out after you have driven for a few
minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure gauge.
The tyre pressures shown by the on-board computer refer to those measured at sea level. At
high altitudes, the tyre pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge are higher than those
shown by the on-board computer. In this case,
do not reduce the tyre pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor can
be affected by interference from radio transmitting equipment (e.g. cordless headphones, twoway radios) that may be being operated in or
near the vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 133).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the Serv.
Serv.menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel will
be displayed in the multifunction display.
If the vehicle was parked for longer than
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of driv‐
ing message is shown.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure monitor automatically detects new wheels or new
sensors. As long as a clear allocation of the tyre
pressure values to the individual wheels is not
possible, the Tyre pressure monitor active
X
Tyre pressure
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure
loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is
shown in the multifunction display. The yellow
tyre pressure warning lamp then lights up:
RIf
the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display,
the tyre pressure in at least one tyre is too
low. The tyre pressure must be corrected
when the opportunity arises.
RIf the Tyre pressure Check tyre(s) message appears in the multifunction display, the
tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly. The tyres must be checked.
RIf the Tyre pressure Caution Tyre mal‐
function message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in one or more
tyres has dropped suddenly. The tyres must
be checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in the
display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 239).
If the position of the wheels on the vehicle is
changed, the tyre pressures may be displayed in
the wrong positions for a short time. After a few
minutes of driving, this is rectified and the tyre
pressures are displayed in the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor, all
existing warning messages are deleted and the
warning lamps go out. The monitor uses the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values
for monitoring. In most cases, the tyre pressure
monitor will automatically detect the new reference values after you have changed the tyre
pressure. However, you can also set reference
values manually as described here. The tyre
pressure monitor then monitors the new tyre
pressure values.
Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler flap
to ensure that the tyre pressure is set correctly in all four tyres for the current operating
conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 313).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 133).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the Serv.
Serv.menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current
tyre pressure for each tyre or the Tyre pres‐
sures will be displayed after a few
minutes of driving message.
X Press the : button.
The multifunction display shows the Use
current pressures as new reference
values message.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre pressures are within the specified range. The new
tyre pressures are then accepted as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
Country
Radio type approval number
Argentina
MW2433A
H-12337
GG4
H-12338
Brazil
2770-12-8001
Model: MW2433A
0381-13-8001
Model: GG4
Z
Wheels and tyres
message is shown instead of the tyre pressure
display. The tyre pressures are already being
monitored.
After an emergency spare wheel has been fitted,
the system may still display the tyre pressure of
the removed wheel for a few minutes. If this
occurs, note that the value displayed for the
position where the spare wheel is fitted is not
the same as the current tyre pressure of the
emergency spare wheel.
317
318
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Abu Dhabi TRA, Registered NO
ER0092100/12
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
ER0099792/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer NO: DA0047074/10
Wheels and tyres
Jordan
Model: Gen Alpha Wal 2 TPMS
transmitter
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/114
Model: Gen Gamma Gen 4
433.92 Mhz.
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/190
Model: Corax 3 MRXMC34MA4
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2011/158
Type Number: LPD
Morocco
MR7319 ANRT 2012/
11/07/2012
MR7672 ANRT 2012/
23/11/2012
MR6706 ANRT 2011
Moldova
1024
Philippines
No: ESD-1206394C
No: ESD-1306871C
Serbia
И 011 12
Singapore Compliance with IDA Standard
DA- 103365
South
Africa
TA-2012/719
TA-2012/1540
TA-2011/1370
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 294). Information on
driving with MOExtended tyres in the event of a
flat tyre can be found under "Breakdown assistance" (Y page 295).
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel: in
the event of a flat tyre, the emergency spare
wheel is fitted according to the description
under "Fitting a wheel" (Y page 319).
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure mon-
itor, electronic components are located in the
wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in the
area of the valve, as this could damage the
electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Interchanging the front and rear wheels of differing dimensions can render the general operating permit invalid.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in the
"Changing a wheel" section (Y page 318).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres typically wear more on the shoulders, while rear
tyres wear more in the centre.
On vehicles that have front and rear wheels of
the same size, you can interchange the wheels
every 5,000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure the direction of
rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and the
brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel is
interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and, if
necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Changing a wheel
wheel change on your vehicle, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary tyre-changing tools may include,
for example:
RJack
RWheel chock
RWheel wrench
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation have
additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk of aquaplaning. These advantages can only be gained if
the tyres are fitted corresponding to the direction of rotation.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates its
correct direction of rotation.
Storing wheels
319
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
Store wheels in a cool, dry and preferably dark
place if they are not being used. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Move the front wheels to the straight-ahead
position.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage first
or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove the
key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function
or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
The vehicle electronics now have status 0.
This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function
or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock (Y page 133).
X If included in the vehicle equipment, remove
the tyre-change tool kit from the vehicle.
X In addition, safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 155).
i Apart from some country-specific variants,
vehicles are not equipped with a tyre-change
tool kit. Some tools for changing a tyre are
specific to the vehicle. For more information
on which tools are required to perform a
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock, it
can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 294).
The folding wheel chock is an additional securing measure to secure the vehicle against rolling
away, e.g. when changing a wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Insert the lugs on the lower plate fully into the
openings in base plate =.
X
Place chocks or other suitable items under
the front and rear of the wheel that is diagonally opposite the wheel you wish to change.
Z
Wheels and tyres
X
320
Changing a wheel
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
Vehicles with steel wheels: the hub cap covers the wheel bolts. Before you can unscrew the
wheel bolts, you must remove the wheel trim.
Observe the following when raising the vehicle:
Wheels and tyres
Ronly
use the vehicle-specific jack that has
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
to raise the vehicle. If the jack is used incorrectly, it could tip over while the vehicle is
raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise the vehicle
for a short time while a wheel is being
changed. It is not permissible to use it to perform maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, safeguard it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake and
positioning wheel chocks. Do not release the
parking brake while the vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a large,
flat load-bearing underlay must be used. On a
slippery surface, a non-slip underlay must be
used, e.g. use a rubber mat on tiles.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar objects
as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the jack will not
be able to achieve its load-bearing capacity
due to the restricted height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the raised vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rdo not open or close a door or the boot lid
when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in the
vehicle when raising the vehicle.
X
Using both hands, carefully reach into two
wheel trim openings and remove the wheel
trim.
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Jacking points
The jacking points are located just behind the
front wheel arches and just in front of the rear
wheel arches (arrows).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles with
AMG equipment: to protect the vehicle body,
Changing a wheel
the vehicle has covers fitted next to the jacking
points on the outer sills.
321
Turn ratchet ring spanner A until jack ? sits
completely on jacking point = and the base
of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn ratchet ring spanner A until the tyre is
raised a maximum of 3 cm from the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt. The
X
Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: fold cover ;
upwards.
Take ratchet ring spanner A out of the vehicle tool kit and place it on the hexagon nut of
jack ? so that the letters AUF are visible.
X Position jack ? at jacking point =.
X
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
It is imperative to observe the instructions and
safety notes on "Changing a wheel"
(Y page 318).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the respective
wheel.
X
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Covers, front (example: vehicles with AMG equipment)
threads of the wheel bolts and wheel hubs
could otherwise be damaged when the bolts
are tightened.
X Unscrew the wheel bolts.
X Remove the wheel.
Changing a wheel
322
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact surfaces.
X Place the new wheel on the wheel hub and
push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are fingertight.
X
Wheels and tyres
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
Place the ratchet ring spanner onto the hexagon nut of the jack so that the letters AB are
visible.
X Turn the ratchet ring spanner until the vehicle
is once again standing firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise
pattern in the sequence indicated (: to A).
The tightening torque must be 130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle tools
in the vehicle again.
X Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: use the cover of the
outer sill.
X Check the tyre pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust if necessary.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 313).
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning system or the tyre pressure monitor cannot function reliably. Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor only once
the defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: all fitted
wheels must be equipped with functioning sensors.
X
Emergency spare wheel
General notes
You can ask for information regarding permitted
wheel/tyre combinations at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 313).
The value on the wheel is valid.
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recom-
mends that you only use tyres and wheels
which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz
specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only certain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres may
only be used on wheels that have been specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested
and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain
characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle noise
emissions or fuel consumption, may otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when
driving with a load, tyre dimension variations
could cause the tyres to come into contact
with the bodywork and axle components. This
could result in damage to the tyres or the
vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for damage resulting from the use of tyres, wheels or
accessories other than those tested and
approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres and
approved combinations can be obtained from
any qualified specialist workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous damage cannot always be detected on
retreaded tyres. As a result, Mercedes-Benz
cannot guarantee vehicle safety if retreaded
tyres are fitted. Do not fit used tyres if you
have no information about their previous
usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort
and suspension comfort are reduced and the
risk of damage to the wheels and tyres as a
result of driving over obstacles increases.
The recommended tyre pressures for various
operating conditions can be found in the tyre
pressure table on the fuel filler flap. Further
information on tyre pressure (Y page 313).
Check tyre pressures regularly and only when
the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit the
vehicle:
Rwith tyres of the same size across an axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyre (summer tyres,
MOExtended tyres, winter tyres)
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 295).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Emergency spare wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
RAdapt
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Wheel and tyre combinations
323
324
Emergency spare wheel
ROnly
use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
Removing the emergency spare wheel
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
When using an emergency spare wheel or spare
wheel of a different size, you must not exceed
the vehicle's maximum design speed of
80 km/h.
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 313).
The value on the wheel is valid.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
Wheels and tyres
General notes
You can ask for information regarding permitted
emergency spare wheels at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed limitation specified on the emergency spare wheel.
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning system or the tyre pressure monitor cannot function reliably. Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor only once
the defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: after an
emergency spare wheel has been fitted, the system may still display the tyre pressure of the
removed wheel for a few minutes. The value displayed for the position where the emergency
spare wheel is fitted is not the same as the current tyre pressure of the emergency spare
wheel.
Vehicles with the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel:
The "Minispare" emergency spare wheel is
secured in emergency spare wheel bag : in the
boot.
X Open the boot lid.
X Release securing straps ; on emergency
spare wheel bag :.
X Remove emergency spare wheel bag : with
the "Minispare" emergency spare wheel.
X Open emergency spare wheel bag : and
remove the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in the
"Changing a wheel" section (Y page 319).
Vehicle electronics
i The technical data were determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data apply
to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data
may therefore differ for vehicles with optional
equipment. You can obtain further information from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such as
control units, sensors, actuating components
and connector leads, at a qualified specialist
workshop. Vehicle components may otherwise wear more quickly and the vehicle's
operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the operational safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating RF transmitters in the vehicle, always
connect them to the low-reflection exterior
aerial.
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of RF
transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must be
complied with:
Ronly approved wavebands may be used.
Robserve the maximum permissible output
in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk posed
by electromagnetic fields.
Observe the notes on operating mobile phones
(Y page 277).
The following aerial positions may be used for
the correct installation of RF transmitters:
Technical data
Information on technical data
If you operate RF transmitters incorrectly in
the vehicle, the electromagnetic radiation
could interfere with the vehicle electronics,
e.g.:
Approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
; Rear roof area
= Rear wings
? Boot lid
Rif the RF transmitter is not connected to an
i On vehicles with a panorama sliding sun-
exterior aerial
Rthe exterior aerial has been fitted incorrectly or is not a low-reflection type
This could jeopardise the operating safety of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
325
roof, fitting an aerial to the front or rear roof
area is not permitted.
On the rear wings, it is recommended that you
position the aerial on the side of the vehicle
closest to the centre of the road.
Z
326
Identification plates
Technical data
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for installation of aftermarket radio frequency transmitting
equipment") when retrofitting RF transmitters.
Comply with the legal requirements for add-on
parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial connections intended for use with the basic fittings.
Be sure to observe the manufacturer's additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at the
base of the aerial must not exceed the following
values:
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3–54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74–88 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144–174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380–460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400–460 MHz
35 W
Mobile communications
(2G/3G/4G)
10 W
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
RTrunked radio/Tetra
R70 cm waveband
R2G/3G/4G
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
X
The following can be used in the vehicle without
restrictions:
RRF transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
RRF transmitters with transmitter frequencies
in the 380 - 410 MHz waveband and a maximum transmission output of up to 2 W
(trunked radio/Tetra)
RMobile phones (2G/3G/4G)
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see the vehicle identification
plate :.
Vehicle identification plate (example: vehicles with
a trailer tow hitch)
: Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
; EU type approval number (for certain coun-
tries only)
= VIN
? Maximum gross vehicle weight (kg)
A Maximum gross vehicle weight of vehicle
combination (kg) (for specific countries
only)
B Permissible front axle load (kg)
Service products and filling capacities
C Permissible rear axle load (kg)
D Paint code
327
Engine number
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. You can obtain further information from
any qualified specialist workshop.
Service products and filling capacities
Important safety notes
i The data shown on the vehicle identification
plate is sample data. This data is different for
every vehicle and may differ from the data
shown here. You can find the data applicable
to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification
plate.
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
Rlubricants
Rcoolant
Rbrake
(e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
fluid
Rwindscreen
washer fluid
control system refrigerant
Components and service products must be
matched. Only use products recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Damage caused by the use of
products that have not been recommended is
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz warranty or
goodwill gestures. They are listed in this
Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved by
Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on
the container:
RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB-Approval (e.g. MB-Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g. MB
Rclimate
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost
position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
VIN ; can be seen.
X
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 326).
For certain countries only: the VIN can also be
found at the lower edge of the windscreen.
Z
Technical data
Vehicle identification plate (example: Kuwait)
: Vehicle manufacturer
; Place of manufacture
= Date of manufacture
? Vehicle model
A VIN
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
328
Service products and filling capacities
229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Other designations, for example:
R0 W-30
R5 W-30
R5 W-40
i You can obtain further information at any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Technical data
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Tank capacity
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Model
Total capacity
CLA 180 d BlueEFFICIENCY
Edition
40 l
or
50.0 l
CLA 250 Sport
Models with 4MATIC
56.0 l
All other models
50.0 l
Model
Of which
reserve fuel
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Approx. 8.0 l
All other models
Approx. 6.0 l
Petrol
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition if
you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel.
Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel system.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel can
result in damage to the fuel system and the
engine. Notify a qualified specialist workshop
and have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
! Only refuel using unleaded petrol with at
least 95 RON, which conforms to the European standard EN 228 or E DIN or an equivalent specification.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol. Your vehicle is suitable for use
with E10 fuel. You may refuel your vehicle
using E10 fuel.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 can lead
to increased wear as well as damage to the
fuel system, engine and exhaust system.
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operating
the vehicle with other fuels can lead to damage to the fuel system, engine and exhaust
system.
Service products and filling capacities
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
(100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
Rpetrol with additives containing metal
Rdiesel
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle.
You will usually find information about the fuel
grade on the pump. If you cannot find the label
on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
CLA 200, CLA 250, CLA 250 4MATIC,
CLA 250 Sport, CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC: as a
temporary measure, if the recommended fuel is
not available, you may also use regular unleaded
petrol with an octane rating of 93 RON.
All other models: as a temporary measure, if
the recommended fuel is not available, you may
also use regular unleaded petrol with an octane
rating of 91 RON. This may reduce engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid
driving at full throttle and sudden acceleration.
Never refuel using fuel with a lower RON.
RE100
i In some countries, the available petrol may
not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This fuel can
temporarily produce unpleasant odours,
especially on short journeys. As soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content < 10 ppm) is
used for refuelling, the odours are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 153).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol with
at least 98 ROZ, that conforms to European
standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol. Your vehicle is suitable for use
with E10 fuel. You may refuel your vehicle
using E10 fuel.
! As a temporary measure, if the recommended fuel is not available, you may also use
unleaded petrol with an octane rating of
95 RON. This may reduce engine perform-
ance and increase fuel consumption. As much
as possible, avoid driving at full throttle.
! As a temporary measure, if the recommen-
ded fuel is not available, you may also use
unleaded petrol in emergencies with an
octane rating of 91 RON.
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel consumption, and the engine power output is
noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full throttle.
If no fuel other than petrol with 91 RON or a
lower grade is available, you should have the
vehicle adapted to run on this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.
CLA 250 (only for certain countries).
! Only refuel using sulphur-free unleaded pet-
rol with at least 95 ROZ, that conforms to the
European standard EN 228 or E DIN or an
equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output or
damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol may
not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This fuel can
temporarily produce unpleasant odours,
especially on short journeys. As soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content < 10 ppm) is
used for refuelling, the odours are reduced.
Additives
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
added later can lead to engine failure. Do not
mix fuel additives with fuel. This does not
include additives for the removal and prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must only be
mixed with additives recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for
use in the product description. More information about recommended additives can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use fuel
brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could build
up in the fuel injection system as a result. In this
case, in consultation with a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, the petrol should be mixed with the
cleaning additive recommended by MercedesBenz. Always observe the notes and mixing
ratios specified on the container.
Z
Technical data
! Do not use the following:
329
330
Service products and filling capacities
Diesel
Fuel grade
G WARNING
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590 or
is of equivalent quality. Fuel that does not
conform to EN 590 can lead to increased wear
as well as damage to the engine and exhaust
system.
! Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix such fuels with diesel fuel and do
not use any special additives. Otherwise,
engine damage may occur.
Low outside temperatures
In winter months, diesel fuel with an improved
cold flow quality is available. In Europe, the
EN 590 standard defines various climatedependent temperature categories. Malfunctions can be avoided by refuelling with diesel
fuel that corresponds to the climatic specifications outlined in EN 590. At unusually low outside temperatures, it is possible that the flow
characteristics of the diesel fuel could be insufficient. Accordingly, diesel fuel from warmer
areas may not be suitable for operation in colder
climatic conditions.
i Further information on country-specific fuel
properties and fuel types with low-temperature resistance can be obtained from oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Engine oil
General notes
Technical data
Rheating
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur
Euro diesel with a sulphur content of under
50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission control system could be damaged.
! Vehicles without a diesel particle filter:
in countries where only diesel fuel with a high
sulphur content is available, you will need to
carry out your vehicle's oil change at shorter
intervals. More information about the interval
for oil change can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop.
Usually you will find information about the fuel
grade on the pump. If you cannot find the label
on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
Information on refuelling (Y page 153).
When handling engine oil, observe the important
safety notes on service products (Y page 327).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz-approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any MercedesBenz Service Centre. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the oil change carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz approval is indicated on the oil container
by the inscription "MB-Freigabe" or "MB-
Service products and filling capacities
Petrol engines
All models
MB-Freigabe or
MB-Approval
229.5
Diesel engines
MB-Freigabe or
MB-Approval
CLA 180 d
CLA 180 d BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
226.51, 229.31,
229.51, 229.52
All other models
228.51, 229.31,
229.51, 229.52
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils
for Mercedes-AMG vehicles.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may top up with the following
engine oils until the next oil change:
RPetrol engines: MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 229.3 or ACEA A3/B3
RDiesel engines: MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 229.3, 229.5 or ACEA C3
It may be used only once and the topping-up
quantity must not exceed 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Model
Replacement
amount
CLA 180
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
CLA 200
5.8 l
CLA 180 d
CLA 180 d BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
4.5 l
CLA 200 d
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
CLA 220 d
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
6.5 l
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
5.5 l
All other models
5.6 l
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine oil.
This could damage the engine.
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
When handling brake fluid, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 327).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found in
the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval
331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can be
obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or
on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Z
Technical data
Approval" and the corresponding designation,
e.g. MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved engine
oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering
the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
Petrol engines: in certain countries, different
engine oils can be used, provided that the maintenance intervals are reduced. For more information, please contact a qualified specialist
workshop.
331
332
Service products and filling capacities
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the replacement confirmed in the Service Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be found
in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products, MB Specifications for Service
Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. Or contact
a qualified specialist workshop.
Technical data
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture, even
in countries where high temperatures prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the replacement confirmed in the Service Booklet.
Comply with the important safety precautions
for service products when handling coolant
(Y page 327).
The coolant is a mixture of water and corrosion
inhibitor/antifreeze concentrate. It is responsible for the following:
Ranti-corrosion protection
Rantifreeze protection
Rraising the boiling point
If corrosion inhibitor/antifreeze concentrate is
present in the correct concentration, the boiling
point of the coolant during operation will be
approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze concentrate/corrosion inhibitor
concentration in the engine cooling system
should:
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection down
to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be dissipated as effectively.
Mercedes-Benz recommends a coolant or corrosion inhibitor/antifreeze concentrate in
accordance with
MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled
with a coolant mixture that ensures adequate
antifreeze and corrosion protection.
i The coolant is checked at every mainte-
nance interval at a qualified specialist workshop.
Windscreen washer system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and Win-
terFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the spraying
nozzles could become blocked.
Do not use distilled or de-ionised water. Otherwise, the level sensor may give a false reading.
When handling washer fluid, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 327).
At temperatures above freezing:
X Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture of
water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
X Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture of
water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
Vehicle data
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB Sum-
merFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer fluid all
year round.
Vehicle data
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle data:
heights specified may vary as a result of:
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 326)
Rfor certain countries only: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle
Rthe
Dimensions and weights
Missing values were not available at the time of
going to print.
Model
CLA 180
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
CLA 180 d
CLA 180 d BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
:
Height when
opened
1744 mm
CLA 220 (117.345)
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
CLA 250 Sport
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
1749 mm
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
1727 mm
All other models
1745 mm
Missing values were not available at the time of
going to print.
CLA 220 (117.345)
Vehicle length
Vehicle height
Technical data
For the correct mixing ratio, refer to the information on the antifreeze reservoir.
333
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
Wheelbase
Maximum roof load
Maximum boot load
All other models
Vehicle width including exterior mirrors
2032 mm
Vehicle width excluding exterior mirrors
1777 mm
Wheelbase
2699 mm
Z
334
Trailer tow hitch
Model
Vehicle length
Model
Vehicle height
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
4691 mm
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
1416 mm
All other models
4640 mm
All other models
1432 mm
Model
Vehicle height
CLA 180
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
CLA 180 d
CLA 180 d BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
1431 mm
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
CLA 250 Sport
CLA 250 Sport
4MATIC
1436 mm
Model
Maximum roof
load
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
100 kg
All sports models
100 kg
All other models
Model
Maximum boot
load
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
100 kg
All sports models
100 kg
All other models
Trailer tow hitch
Technical data
Trailer loads
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 8%
from a standstill)
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 196).
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Model
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 180
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 180 d
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 200
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 200 d
CLA 250
Model
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
Manual transmission
1500 kg
Trailer tow hitch
335
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Model
Automatic transmission
CLA 220
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
CLA 220 4MATIC
CLA 220 d
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
CLA 250 4MATIC
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12%
from a standstill)
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 196).
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 180
1200 kg
1200 kg
CLA 180 d
1200 kg
1200 kg
CLA 200
1400 kg
1400 kg
CLA 200 d
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 250
1500 kg
1500 kg
Model
Manual transmission
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
1200 kg
Model
Technical data
Model
Automatic transmission
CLA 220
1500 kg
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
1500 kg
CLA 220 4MATIC
1500 kg
CLA 220 d
1500 kg
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
1500 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
1500 kg
Permissible trailer load, unbraked
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 196).
Model
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 180
695 kg
715 kg
CLA 180 d
720 kg
730 kg
Z
336
Trailer tow hitch
Model
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 200
695 kg
715 kg
CLA 200 d
750 kg
750 kg
CLA 250
720 kg
735 kg
Model
Manual transmission
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
695 kg
Model
Automatic transmission
CLA 220
730 kg
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
750 kg
CLA 220 4MATIC
750 kg
CLA 220 d
750 kg
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
750 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
750 kg
Maximum drawbar load
Technical data
! Use a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum permissible noseweight. Do not
use a noseweight of less than 50kg, otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Note that the payload and the rear axle load are reduced by the actual payload.
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 196).
The drawbar load is not included in the trailer load.
Model
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 180
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 180 d
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 200
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 200 d
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 250
75 kg
75 kg
Model
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
Model
Manual transmission
75 kg
Automatic transmission
CLA 220
75 kg
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
75 kg
Trailer tow hitch
Model
337
Automatic transmission
CLA 220 4MATIC
75 kg
CLA 220 d
75 kg
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
75 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
75 kg
The actual drawbar load may not be higher than the specified value. The value can be found on the
trailer tow hitch or trailer identification plates. The lowest weight applies.
You can attach carrier systems, e.g. bicycle racks or load-bearing implements, on the ball coupling.
The maximum payload of 75 kg applies when using carrier systems on the ball coupling.
Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 196).
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 180
995 kg
995 kg
CLA 180 d
1000 kg
995 kg
CLA 200
995 kg
995 kg
CLA 200 d
1000 kg
995 kg
CLA 250
1010 kg
1010 kg
Model
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
Model
Manual transmission
985 kg
Technical data
Model
Automatic transmission
CLA 220
1005 kg
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
1045 kg
CLA 220 4MATIC
1055 kg
CLA 220 d
995 kg
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
1045 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
1055 kg
Z
338
339
340